rtos: add support for RIOT
[openocd.git] / doc / openocd.texi
1 \input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
2 @c %**start of header
3 @setfilename openocd.info
4 @settitle OpenOCD User's Guide
5 @dircategory Development
6 @direntry
7 * OpenOCD: (openocd). OpenOCD User's Guide
8 @end direntry
9 @paragraphindent 0
10 @c %**end of header
11
12 @include version.texi
13
14 @copying
15
16 This User's Guide documents
17 release @value{VERSION},
18 dated @value{UPDATED},
19 of the Open On-Chip Debugger (OpenOCD).
20
21 @itemize @bullet
22 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2008 The OpenOCD Project
23 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2007-2008 Spencer Oliver @email{spen@@spen-soft.co.uk}
24 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2008-2010 Oyvind Harboe @email{oyvind.harboe@@zylin.com}
25 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2008 Duane Ellis @email{openocd@@duaneellis.com}
26 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2009-2010 David Brownell
27 @end itemize
28
29 @quotation
30 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
31 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.2 or
32 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with no
33 Invariant Sections, with no Front-Cover Texts, and with no Back-Cover
34 Texts. A copy of the license is included in the section entitled ``GNU
35 Free Documentation License''.
36 @end quotation
37 @end copying
38
39 @titlepage
40 @titlefont{@emph{Open On-Chip Debugger:}}
41 @sp 1
42 @title OpenOCD User's Guide
43 @subtitle for release @value{VERSION}
44 @subtitle @value{UPDATED}
45
46 @page
47 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
48 @insertcopying
49 @end titlepage
50
51 @summarycontents
52 @contents
53
54 @ifnottex
55 @node Top
56 @top OpenOCD User's Guide
57
58 @insertcopying
59 @end ifnottex
60
61 @menu
62 * About:: About OpenOCD
63 * Developers:: OpenOCD Developer Resources
64 * Debug Adapter Hardware:: Debug Adapter Hardware
65 * About Jim-Tcl:: About Jim-Tcl
66 * Running:: Running OpenOCD
67 * OpenOCD Project Setup:: OpenOCD Project Setup
68 * Config File Guidelines:: Config File Guidelines
69 * Server Configuration:: Server Configuration
70 * Debug Adapter Configuration:: Debug Adapter Configuration
71 * Reset Configuration:: Reset Configuration
72 * TAP Declaration:: TAP Declaration
73 * CPU Configuration:: CPU Configuration
74 * Flash Commands:: Flash Commands
75 * Flash Programming:: Flash Programming
76 * PLD/FPGA Commands:: PLD/FPGA Commands
77 * General Commands:: General Commands
78 * Architecture and Core Commands:: Architecture and Core Commands
79 * JTAG Commands:: JTAG Commands
80 * Boundary Scan Commands:: Boundary Scan Commands
81 * Utility Commands:: Utility Commands
82 * TFTP:: TFTP
83 * GDB and OpenOCD:: Using GDB and OpenOCD
84 * Tcl Scripting API:: Tcl Scripting API
85 * FAQ:: Frequently Asked Questions
86 * Tcl Crash Course:: Tcl Crash Course
87 * License:: GNU Free Documentation License
88
89 @comment DO NOT use the plain word ``Index'', reason: CYGWIN filename
90 @comment case issue with ``Index.html'' and ``index.html''
91 @comment Occurs when creating ``--html --no-split'' output
92 @comment This fix is based on: http://sourceware.org/ml/binutils/2006-05/msg00215.html
93 * OpenOCD Concept Index:: Concept Index
94 * Command and Driver Index:: Command and Driver Index
95 @end menu
96
97 @node About
98 @unnumbered About
99 @cindex about
100
101 OpenOCD was created by Dominic Rath as part of a 2005 diploma thesis written
102 at the University of Applied Sciences Augsburg (@uref{http://www.hs-augsburg.de}).
103 Since that time, the project has grown into an active open-source project,
104 supported by a diverse community of software and hardware developers from
105 around the world.
106
107 @section What is OpenOCD?
108 @cindex TAP
109 @cindex JTAG
110
111 The Open On-Chip Debugger (OpenOCD) aims to provide debugging,
112 in-system programming and boundary-scan testing for embedded target
113 devices.
114
115 It does so with the assistance of a @dfn{debug adapter}, which is
116 a small hardware module which helps provide the right kind of
117 electrical signaling to the target being debugged. These are
118 required since the debug host (on which OpenOCD runs) won't
119 usually have native support for such signaling, or the connector
120 needed to hook up to the target.
121
122 Such debug adapters support one or more @dfn{transport} protocols,
123 each of which involves different electrical signaling (and uses
124 different messaging protocols on top of that signaling). There
125 are many types of debug adapter, and little uniformity in what
126 they are called. (There are also product naming differences.)
127
128 These adapters are sometimes packaged as discrete dongles, which
129 may generically be called @dfn{hardware interface dongles}.
130 Some development boards also integrate them directly, which may
131 let the development board connect directly to the debug
132 host over USB (and sometimes also to power it over USB).
133
134 For example, a @dfn{JTAG Adapter} supports JTAG
135 signaling, and is used to communicate
136 with JTAG (IEEE 1149.1) compliant TAPs on your target board.
137 A @dfn{TAP} is a ``Test Access Port'', a module which processes
138 special instructions and data. TAPs are daisy-chained within and
139 between chips and boards. JTAG supports debugging and boundary
140 scan operations.
141
142 There are also @dfn{SWD Adapters} that support Serial Wire Debug (SWD)
143 signaling to communicate with some newer ARM cores, as well as debug
144 adapters which support both JTAG and SWD transports. SWD supports only
145 debugging, whereas JTAG also supports boundary scan operations.
146
147 For some chips, there are also @dfn{Programming Adapters} supporting
148 special transports used only to write code to flash memory, without
149 support for on-chip debugging or boundary scan.
150 (At this writing, OpenOCD does not support such non-debug adapters.)
151
152
153 @b{Dongles:} OpenOCD currently supports many types of hardware dongles:
154 USB-based, parallel port-based, and other standalone boxes that run
155 OpenOCD internally. @xref{Debug Adapter Hardware}.
156
157 @b{GDB Debug:} It allows ARM7 (ARM7TDMI and ARM720t), ARM9 (ARM920T,
158 ARM922T, ARM926EJ--S, ARM966E--S), XScale (PXA25x, IXP42x), Cortex-M3
159 (Stellaris LM3, STMicroelectronics STM32 and Energy Micro EFM32) and
160 Intel Quark (x10xx) based cores to be debugged via the GDB protocol.
161
162 @b{Flash Programming:} Flash writing is supported for external
163 CFI-compatible NOR flashes (Intel and AMD/Spansion command set) and several
164 internal flashes (LPC1700, LPC1800, LPC2000, LPC4300, AT91SAM7, AT91SAM3U,
165 STR7x, STR9x, LM3, STM32x and EFM32). Preliminary support for various NAND flash
166 controllers (LPC3180, Orion, S3C24xx, more) is included.
167
168 @section OpenOCD Web Site
169
170 The OpenOCD web site provides the latest public news from the community:
171
172 @uref{http://openocd.org/}
173
174 @section Latest User's Guide:
175
176 The user's guide you are now reading may not be the latest one
177 available. A version for more recent code may be available.
178 Its HTML form is published regularly at:
179
180 @uref{http://openocd.org/doc/html/index.html}
181
182 PDF form is likewise published at:
183
184 @uref{http://openocd.org/doc/pdf/openocd.pdf}
185
186 @section OpenOCD User's Forum
187
188 There is an OpenOCD forum (phpBB) hosted by SparkFun,
189 which might be helpful to you. Note that if you want
190 anything to come to the attention of developers, you
191 should post it to the OpenOCD Developer Mailing List
192 instead of this forum.
193
194 @uref{http://forum.sparkfun.com/viewforum.php?f=18}
195
196 @section OpenOCD User's Mailing List
197
198 The OpenOCD User Mailing List provides the primary means of
199 communication between users:
200
201 @uref{https://lists.sourceforge.net/mailman/listinfo/openocd-user}
202
203 @section OpenOCD IRC
204
205 Support can also be found on irc:
206 @uref{irc://irc.freenode.net/openocd}
207
208 @node Developers
209 @chapter OpenOCD Developer Resources
210 @cindex developers
211
212 If you are interested in improving the state of OpenOCD's debugging and
213 testing support, new contributions will be welcome. Motivated developers
214 can produce new target, flash or interface drivers, improve the
215 documentation, as well as more conventional bug fixes and enhancements.
216
217 The resources in this chapter are available for developers wishing to explore
218 or expand the OpenOCD source code.
219
220 @section OpenOCD Git Repository
221
222 During the 0.3.x release cycle, OpenOCD switched from Subversion to
223 a Git repository hosted at SourceForge. The repository URL is:
224
225 @uref{git://git.code.sf.net/p/openocd/code}
226
227 or via http
228
229 @uref{http://git.code.sf.net/p/openocd/code}
230
231 You may prefer to use a mirror and the HTTP protocol:
232
233 @uref{http://repo.or.cz/r/openocd.git}
234
235 With standard Git tools, use @command{git clone} to initialize
236 a local repository, and @command{git pull} to update it.
237 There are also gitweb pages letting you browse the repository
238 with a web browser, or download arbitrary snapshots without
239 needing a Git client:
240
241 @uref{http://repo.or.cz/w/openocd.git}
242
243 The @file{README} file contains the instructions for building the project
244 from the repository or a snapshot.
245
246 Developers that want to contribute patches to the OpenOCD system are
247 @b{strongly} encouraged to work against mainline.
248 Patches created against older versions may require additional
249 work from their submitter in order to be updated for newer releases.
250
251 @section Doxygen Developer Manual
252
253 During the 0.2.x release cycle, the OpenOCD project began
254 providing a Doxygen reference manual. This document contains more
255 technical information about the software internals, development
256 processes, and similar documentation:
257
258 @uref{http://openocd.org/doc/doxygen/html/index.html}
259
260 This document is a work-in-progress, but contributions would be welcome
261 to fill in the gaps. All of the source files are provided in-tree,
262 listed in the Doxyfile configuration at the top of the source tree.
263
264 @section Gerrit Review System
265
266 All changes in the OpenOCD Git repository go through the web-based Gerrit
267 Code Review System:
268
269 @uref{http://openocd.zylin.com/}
270
271 After a one-time registration and repository setup, anyone can push commits
272 from their local Git repository directly into Gerrit.
273 All users and developers are encouraged to review, test, discuss and vote
274 for changes in Gerrit. The feedback provides the basis for a maintainer to
275 eventually submit the change to the main Git repository.
276
277 The @file{HACKING} file, also available as the Patch Guide in the Doxygen
278 Developer Manual, contains basic information about how to connect a
279 repository to Gerrit, prepare and push patches. Patch authors are expected to
280 maintain their changes while they're in Gerrit, respond to feedback and if
281 necessary rework and push improved versions of the change.
282
283 @section OpenOCD Developer Mailing List
284
285 The OpenOCD Developer Mailing List provides the primary means of
286 communication between developers:
287
288 @uref{https://lists.sourceforge.net/mailman/listinfo/openocd-devel}
289
290 @section OpenOCD Bug Tracker
291
292 The OpenOCD Bug Tracker is hosted on SourceForge:
293
294 @uref{http://bugs.openocd.org/}
295
296
297 @node Debug Adapter Hardware
298 @chapter Debug Adapter Hardware
299 @cindex dongles
300 @cindex FTDI
301 @cindex wiggler
302 @cindex zy1000
303 @cindex printer port
304 @cindex USB Adapter
305 @cindex RTCK
306
307 Defined: @b{dongle}: A small device that plugs into a computer and serves as
308 an adapter .... [snip]
309
310 In the OpenOCD case, this generally refers to @b{a small adapter} that
311 attaches to your computer via USB or the parallel port. One
312 exception is the Ultimate Solutions ZY1000, packaged as a small box you
313 attach via an ethernet cable. The ZY1000 has the advantage that it does not
314 require any drivers to be installed on the developer PC. It also has
315 a built in web interface. It supports RTCK/RCLK or adaptive clocking
316 and has a built-in relay to power cycle targets remotely.
317
318
319 @section Choosing a Dongle
320
321 There are several things you should keep in mind when choosing a dongle.
322
323 @enumerate
324 @item @b{Transport} Does it support the kind of communication that you need?
325 OpenOCD focusses mostly on JTAG. Your version may also support
326 other ways to communicate with target devices.
327 @item @b{Voltage} What voltage is your target - 1.8, 2.8, 3.3, or 5V?
328 Does your dongle support it? You might need a level converter.
329 @item @b{Pinout} What pinout does your target board use?
330 Does your dongle support it? You may be able to use jumper
331 wires, or an "octopus" connector, to convert pinouts.
332 @item @b{Connection} Does your computer have the USB, parallel, or
333 Ethernet port needed?
334 @item @b{RTCK} Do you expect to use it with ARM chips and boards with
335 RTCK support (also known as ``adaptive clocking'')?
336 @end enumerate
337
338 @section Stand-alone JTAG Probe
339
340 The ZY1000 from Ultimate Solutions is technically not a dongle but a
341 stand-alone JTAG probe that, unlike most dongles, doesn't require any drivers
342 running on the developer's host computer.
343 Once installed on a network using DHCP or a static IP assignment, users can
344 access the ZY1000 probe locally or remotely from any host with access to the
345 IP address assigned to the probe.
346 The ZY1000 provides an intuitive web interface with direct access to the
347 OpenOCD debugger.
348 Users may also run a GDBSERVER directly on the ZY1000 to take full advantage
349 of GCC & GDB to debug any distribution of embedded Linux or NetBSD running on
350 the target.
351 The ZY1000 supports RTCK & RCLK or adaptive clocking and has a built-in relay
352 to power cycle the target remotely.
353
354 For more information, visit:
355
356 @b{ZY1000} See: @url{http://www.ultsol.com/index.php/component/content/article/8/210-zylin-zy1000-main}
357
358 @section USB FT2232 Based
359
360 There are many USB JTAG dongles on the market, many of them based
361 on a chip from ``Future Technology Devices International'' (FTDI)
362 known as the FTDI FT2232; this is a USB full speed (12 Mbps) chip.
363 See: @url{http://www.ftdichip.com} for more information.
364 In summer 2009, USB high speed (480 Mbps) versions of these FTDI
365 chips started to become available in JTAG adapters. Around 2012, a new
366 variant appeared - FT232H - this is a single-channel version of FT2232H.
367 (Adapters using those high speed FT2232H or FT232H chips may support adaptive
368 clocking.)
369
370 The FT2232 chips are flexible enough to support some other
371 transport options, such as SWD or the SPI variants used to
372 program some chips. They have two communications channels,
373 and one can be used for a UART adapter at the same time the
374 other one is used to provide a debug adapter.
375
376 Also, some development boards integrate an FT2232 chip to serve as
377 a built-in low-cost debug adapter and USB-to-serial solution.
378
379 @itemize @bullet
380 @item @b{usbjtag}
381 @* Link @url{http://elk.informatik.fh-augsburg.de/hhweb/doc/openocd/usbjtag/usbjtag.html}
382 @item @b{jtagkey}
383 @* See: @url{http://www.amontec.com/jtagkey.shtml}
384 @item @b{jtagkey2}
385 @* See: @url{http://www.amontec.com/jtagkey2.shtml}
386 @item @b{oocdlink}
387 @* See: @url{http://www.oocdlink.com} By Joern Kaipf
388 @item @b{signalyzer}
389 @* See: @url{http://www.signalyzer.com}
390 @item @b{Stellaris Eval Boards}
391 @* See: @url{http://www.ti.com} - The Stellaris eval boards
392 bundle FT2232-based JTAG and SWD support, which can be used to debug
393 the Stellaris chips. Using separate JTAG adapters is optional.
394 These boards can also be used in a "pass through" mode as JTAG adapters
395 to other target boards, disabling the Stellaris chip.
396 @item @b{TI/Luminary ICDI}
397 @* See: @url{http://www.ti.com} - TI/Luminary In-Circuit Debug
398 Interface (ICDI) Boards are included in Stellaris LM3S9B9x
399 Evaluation Kits. Like the non-detachable FT2232 support on the other
400 Stellaris eval boards, they can be used to debug other target boards.
401 @item @b{olimex-jtag}
402 @* See: @url{http://www.olimex.com}
403 @item @b{Flyswatter/Flyswatter2}
404 @* See: @url{http://www.tincantools.com}
405 @item @b{turtelizer2}
406 @* See:
407 @uref{http://www.ethernut.de/en/hardware/turtelizer/index.html, Turtelizer 2}, or
408 @url{http://www.ethernut.de}
409 @item @b{comstick}
410 @* Link: @url{http://www.hitex.com/index.php?id=383}
411 @item @b{stm32stick}
412 @* Link @url{http://www.hitex.com/stm32-stick}
413 @item @b{axm0432_jtag}
414 @* Axiom AXM-0432 Link @url{http://www.axman.com} - NOTE: This JTAG does not appear
415 to be available anymore as of April 2012.
416 @item @b{cortino}
417 @* Link @url{http://www.hitex.com/index.php?id=cortino}
418 @item @b{dlp-usb1232h}
419 @* Link @url{http://www.dlpdesign.com/usb/usb1232h.shtml}
420 @item @b{digilent-hs1}
421 @* Link @url{http://www.digilentinc.com/Products/Detail.cfm?Prod=JTAG-HS1}
422 @item @b{opendous}
423 @* Link @url{http://code.google.com/p/opendous/wiki/JTAG} FT2232H-based
424 (OpenHardware).
425 @item @b{JTAG-lock-pick Tiny 2}
426 @* Link @url{http://www.distortec.com/jtag-lock-pick-tiny-2} FT232H-based
427
428 @item @b{GW16042}
429 @* Link: @url{http://shop.gateworks.com/index.php?route=product/product&path=70_80&product_id=64}
430 FT2232H-based
431
432 @end itemize
433 @section USB-JTAG / Altera USB-Blaster compatibles
434
435 These devices also show up as FTDI devices, but are not
436 protocol-compatible with the FT2232 devices. They are, however,
437 protocol-compatible among themselves. USB-JTAG devices typically consist
438 of a FT245 followed by a CPLD that understands a particular protocol,
439 or emulates this protocol using some other hardware.
440
441 They may appear under different USB VID/PID depending on the particular
442 product. The driver can be configured to search for any VID/PID pair
443 (see the section on driver commands).
444
445 @itemize
446 @item @b{USB-JTAG} Kolja Waschk's USB Blaster-compatible adapter
447 @* Link: @url{http://ixo-jtag.sourceforge.net/}
448 @item @b{Altera USB-Blaster}
449 @* Link: @url{http://www.altera.com/literature/ug/ug_usb_blstr.pdf}
450 @end itemize
451
452 @section USB J-Link based
453 There are several OEM versions of the SEGGER @b{J-Link} adapter. It is
454 an example of a microcontroller based JTAG adapter, it uses an
455 AT91SAM764 internally.
456
457 @itemize @bullet
458 @item @b{SEGGER J-Link}
459 @* Link: @url{http://www.segger.com/jlink.html}
460 @item @b{Atmel SAM-ICE} (Only works with Atmel chips!)
461 @* Link: @url{http://www.atmel.com/tools/atmelsam-ice.aspx}
462 @item @b{IAR J-Link}
463 @end itemize
464
465 @section USB RLINK based
466 Raisonance has an adapter called @b{RLink}. It exists in a stripped-down form on the STM32 Primer,
467 permanently attached to the JTAG lines. It also exists on the STM32 Primer2, but that is wired for
468 SWD and not JTAG, thus not supported.
469
470 @itemize @bullet
471 @item @b{Raisonance RLink}
472 @* Link: @url{http://www.mcu-raisonance.com/~rlink-debugger-programmer__@/microcontrollers__tool~tool__T018:4cn9ziz4bnx6.html}
473 @item @b{STM32 Primer}
474 @* Link: @url{http://www.stm32circle.com/resources/stm32primer.php}
475 @item @b{STM32 Primer2}
476 @* Link: @url{http://www.stm32circle.com/resources/stm32primer2.php}
477 @end itemize
478
479 @section USB ST-LINK based
480 STMicroelectronics has an adapter called @b{ST-LINK}.
481 They only work with STMicroelectronics chips, notably STM32 and STM8.
482
483 @itemize @bullet
484 @item @b{ST-LINK}
485 @* This is available standalone and as part of some kits, eg. STM32VLDISCOVERY.
486 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/internet/evalboard/product/219866.jsp}
487 @item @b{ST-LINK/V2}
488 @* This is available standalone and as part of some kits, eg. STM32F4DISCOVERY.
489 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/internet/evalboard/product/251168.jsp}
490 @item @b{STLINK-V3}
491 @* This is available standalone and as part of some kits.
492 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/stlink-v3}
493 @end itemize
494
495 For info the original ST-LINK enumerates using the mass storage usb class; however,
496 its implementation is completely broken. The result is this causes issues under Linux.
497 The simplest solution is to get Linux to ignore the ST-LINK using one of the following methods:
498 @itemize @bullet
499 @item modprobe -r usb-storage && modprobe usb-storage quirks=483:3744:i
500 @item add "options usb-storage quirks=483:3744:i" to /etc/modprobe.conf
501 @end itemize
502
503 @section USB TI/Stellaris ICDI based
504 Texas Instruments has an adapter called @b{ICDI}.
505 It is not to be confused with the FTDI based adapters that were originally fitted to their
506 evaluation boards. This is the adapter fitted to the Stellaris LaunchPad.
507
508 @section USB CMSIS-DAP based
509 ARM has released a interface standard called CMSIS-DAP that simplifies connecting
510 debuggers to ARM Cortex based targets @url{http://www.keil.com/support/man/docs/dapdebug/dapdebug_introduction.htm}.
511
512 @section USB Other
513 @itemize @bullet
514 @item @b{USBprog}
515 @* Link: @url{http://shop.embedded-projects.net/} - which uses an Atmel MEGA32 and a UBN9604
516
517 @item @b{USB - Presto}
518 @* Link: @url{http://tools.asix.net/prg_presto.htm}
519
520 @item @b{Versaloon-Link}
521 @* Link: @url{http://www.versaloon.com}
522
523 @item @b{ARM-JTAG-EW}
524 @* Link: @url{http://www.olimex.com/dev/arm-jtag-ew.html}
525
526 @item @b{Buspirate}
527 @* Link: @url{http://dangerousprototypes.com/bus-pirate-manual/}
528
529 @item @b{opendous}
530 @* Link: @url{http://code.google.com/p/opendous-jtag/} - which uses an AT90USB162
531
532 @item @b{estick}
533 @* Link: @url{http://code.google.com/p/estick-jtag/}
534
535 @item @b{Keil ULINK v1}
536 @* Link: @url{http://www.keil.com/ulink1/}
537
538 @item @b{TI XDS110 Debug Probe}
539 @* Link: @url{https://software-dl.ti.com/ccs/esd/documents/xdsdebugprobes/emu_xds110.html}
540 @* Link: @url{https://software-dl.ti.com/ccs/esd/documents/xdsdebugprobes/emu_xds_software_package_download.html#xds110-support-utilities}
541 @end itemize
542
543 @section IBM PC Parallel Printer Port Based
544
545 The two well-known ``JTAG Parallel Ports'' cables are the Xilinx DLC5
546 and the Macraigor Wiggler. There are many clones and variations of
547 these on the market.
548
549 Note that parallel ports are becoming much less common, so if you
550 have the choice you should probably avoid these adapters in favor
551 of USB-based ones.
552
553 @itemize @bullet
554
555 @item @b{Wiggler} - There are many clones of this.
556 @* Link: @url{http://www.macraigor.com/wiggler.htm}
557
558 @item @b{DLC5} - From XILINX - There are many clones of this
559 @* Link: Search the web for: ``XILINX DLC5'' - it is no longer
560 produced, PDF schematics are easily found and it is easy to make.
561
562 @item @b{Amontec - JTAG Accelerator}
563 @* Link: @url{http://www.amontec.com/jtag_accelerator.shtml}
564
565 @item @b{Wiggler2}
566 @* Link: @url{http://www.ccac.rwth-aachen.de/~michaels/index.php/hardware/armjtag}
567
568 @item @b{Wiggler_ntrst_inverted}
569 @* Yet another variation - See the source code, src/jtag/parport.c
570
571 @item @b{old_amt_wiggler}
572 @* Unknown - probably not on the market today
573
574 @item @b{arm-jtag}
575 @* Link: Most likely @url{http://www.olimex.com/dev/arm-jtag.html} [another wiggler clone]
576
577 @item @b{chameleon}
578 @* Link: @url{http://www.amontec.com/chameleon.shtml}
579
580 @item @b{Triton}
581 @* Unknown.
582
583 @item @b{Lattice}
584 @* ispDownload from Lattice Semiconductor
585 @url{http://www.latticesemi.com/lit/docs/@/devtools/dlcable.pdf}
586
587 @item @b{flashlink}
588 @* From STMicroelectronics;
589 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/internet/com/TECHNICAL_RESOURCES/TECHNICAL_LITERATURE/DATA_BRIEF/DM00039500.pdf}
590
591 @end itemize
592
593 @section Other...
594 @itemize @bullet
595
596 @item @b{ep93xx}
597 @* An EP93xx based Linux machine using the GPIO pins directly.
598
599 @item @b{at91rm9200}
600 @* Like the EP93xx - but an ATMEL AT91RM9200 based solution using the GPIO pins on the chip.
601
602 @item @b{bcm2835gpio}
603 @* A BCM2835-based board (e.g. Raspberry Pi) using the GPIO pins of the expansion header.
604
605 @item @b{imx_gpio}
606 @* A NXP i.MX-based board (e.g. Wandboard) using the GPIO pins (should work on any i.MX processor).
607
608 @item @b{jtag_vpi}
609 @* A JTAG driver acting as a client for the JTAG VPI server interface.
610 @* Link: @url{http://github.com/fjullien/jtag_vpi}
611
612 @item @b{xlnx_pcie_xvc}
613 @* A JTAG driver exposing Xilinx Virtual Cable over PCI Express to OpenOCD as JTAG/SWD interface.
614
615 @end itemize
616
617 @node About Jim-Tcl
618 @chapter About Jim-Tcl
619 @cindex Jim-Tcl
620 @cindex tcl
621
622 OpenOCD uses a small ``Tcl Interpreter'' known as Jim-Tcl.
623 This programming language provides a simple and extensible
624 command interpreter.
625
626 All commands presented in this Guide are extensions to Jim-Tcl.
627 You can use them as simple commands, without needing to learn
628 much of anything about Tcl.
629 Alternatively, you can write Tcl programs with them.
630
631 You can learn more about Jim at its website, @url{http://jim.tcl.tk}.
632 There is an active and responsive community, get on the mailing list
633 if you have any questions. Jim-Tcl maintainers also lurk on the
634 OpenOCD mailing list.
635
636 @itemize @bullet
637 @item @b{Jim vs. Tcl}
638 @* Jim-Tcl is a stripped down version of the well known Tcl language,
639 which can be found here: @url{http://www.tcl.tk}. Jim-Tcl has far
640 fewer features. Jim-Tcl is several dozens of .C files and .H files and
641 implements the basic Tcl command set. In contrast: Tcl 8.6 is a
642 4.2 MB .zip file containing 1540 files.
643
644 @item @b{Missing Features}
645 @* Our practice has been: Add/clone the real Tcl feature if/when
646 needed. We welcome Jim-Tcl improvements, not bloat. Also there
647 are a large number of optional Jim-Tcl features that are not
648 enabled in OpenOCD.
649
650 @item @b{Scripts}
651 @* OpenOCD configuration scripts are Jim-Tcl Scripts. OpenOCD's
652 command interpreter today is a mixture of (newer)
653 Jim-Tcl commands, and the (older) original command interpreter.
654
655 @item @b{Commands}
656 @* At the OpenOCD telnet command line (or via the GDB monitor command) one
657 can type a Tcl for() loop, set variables, etc.
658 Some of the commands documented in this guide are implemented
659 as Tcl scripts, from a @file{startup.tcl} file internal to the server.
660
661 @item @b{Historical Note}
662 @* Jim-Tcl was introduced to OpenOCD in spring 2008. Fall 2010,
663 before OpenOCD 0.5 release, OpenOCD switched to using Jim-Tcl
664 as a Git submodule, which greatly simplified upgrading Jim-Tcl
665 to benefit from new features and bugfixes in Jim-Tcl.
666
667 @item @b{Need a crash course in Tcl?}
668 @*@xref{Tcl Crash Course}.
669 @end itemize
670
671 @node Running
672 @chapter Running
673 @cindex command line options
674 @cindex logfile
675 @cindex directory search
676
677 Properly installing OpenOCD sets up your operating system to grant it access
678 to the debug adapters. On Linux, this usually involves installing a file
679 in @file{/etc/udev/rules.d,} so OpenOCD has permissions. An example rules file
680 that works for many common adapters is shipped with OpenOCD in the
681 @file{contrib} directory. MS-Windows needs
682 complex and confusing driver configuration for every peripheral. Such issues
683 are unique to each operating system, and are not detailed in this User's Guide.
684
685 Then later you will invoke the OpenOCD server, with various options to
686 tell it how each debug session should work.
687 The @option{--help} option shows:
688 @verbatim
689 bash$ openocd --help
690
691 --help | -h display this help
692 --version | -v display OpenOCD version
693 --file | -f use configuration file <name>
694 --search | -s dir to search for config files and scripts
695 --debug | -d set debug level to 3
696 | -d<n> set debug level to <level>
697 --log_output | -l redirect log output to file <name>
698 --command | -c run <command>
699 @end verbatim
700
701 If you don't give any @option{-f} or @option{-c} options,
702 OpenOCD tries to read the configuration file @file{openocd.cfg}.
703 To specify one or more different
704 configuration files, use @option{-f} options. For example:
705
706 @example
707 openocd -f config1.cfg -f config2.cfg -f config3.cfg
708 @end example
709
710 Configuration files and scripts are searched for in
711 @enumerate
712 @item the current directory,
713 @item any search dir specified on the command line using the @option{-s} option,
714 @item any search dir specified using the @command{add_script_search_dir} command,
715 @item @file{$HOME/.openocd} (not on Windows),
716 @item a directory in the @env{OPENOCD_SCRIPTS} environment variable (if set),
717 @item the site wide script library @file{$pkgdatadir/site} and
718 @item the OpenOCD-supplied script library @file{$pkgdatadir/scripts}.
719 @end enumerate
720 The first found file with a matching file name will be used.
721
722 @quotation Note
723 Don't try to use configuration script names or paths which
724 include the "#" character. That character begins Tcl comments.
725 @end quotation
726
727 @section Simple setup, no customization
728
729 In the best case, you can use two scripts from one of the script
730 libraries, hook up your JTAG adapter, and start the server ... and
731 your JTAG setup will just work "out of the box". Always try to
732 start by reusing those scripts, but assume you'll need more
733 customization even if this works. @xref{OpenOCD Project Setup}.
734
735 If you find a script for your JTAG adapter, and for your board or
736 target, you may be able to hook up your JTAG adapter then start
737 the server with some variation of one of the following:
738
739 @example
740 openocd -f interface/ADAPTER.cfg -f board/MYBOARD.cfg
741 openocd -f interface/ftdi/ADAPTER.cfg -f board/MYBOARD.cfg
742 @end example
743
744 You might also need to configure which reset signals are present,
745 using @option{-c 'reset_config trst_and_srst'} or something similar.
746 If all goes well you'll see output something like
747
748 @example
749 Open On-Chip Debugger 0.4.0 (2010-01-14-15:06)
750 For bug reports, read
751 http://openocd.org/doc/doxygen/bugs.html
752 Info : JTAG tap: lm3s.cpu tap/device found: 0x3ba00477
753 (mfg: 0x23b, part: 0xba00, ver: 0x3)
754 @end example
755
756 Seeing that "tap/device found" message, and no warnings, means
757 the JTAG communication is working. That's a key milestone, but
758 you'll probably need more project-specific setup.
759
760 @section What OpenOCD does as it starts
761
762 OpenOCD starts by processing the configuration commands provided
763 on the command line or, if there were no @option{-c command} or
764 @option{-f file.cfg} options given, in @file{openocd.cfg}.
765 @xref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage}.
766 At the end of the configuration stage it verifies the JTAG scan
767 chain defined using those commands; your configuration should
768 ensure that this always succeeds.
769 Normally, OpenOCD then starts running as a server.
770 Alternatively, commands may be used to terminate the configuration
771 stage early, perform work (such as updating some flash memory),
772 and then shut down without acting as a server.
773
774 Once OpenOCD starts running as a server, it waits for connections from
775 clients (Telnet, GDB, RPC) and processes the commands issued through
776 those channels.
777
778 If you are having problems, you can enable internal debug messages via
779 the @option{-d} option.
780
781 Also it is possible to interleave Jim-Tcl commands w/config scripts using the
782 @option{-c} command line switch.
783
784 To enable debug output (when reporting problems or working on OpenOCD
785 itself), use the @option{-d} command line switch. This sets the
786 @option{debug_level} to "3", outputting the most information,
787 including debug messages. The default setting is "2", outputting only
788 informational messages, warnings and errors. You can also change this
789 setting from within a telnet or gdb session using @command{debug_level<n>}
790 (@pxref{debuglevel,,debug_level}).
791
792 You can redirect all output from the server to a file using the
793 @option{-l <logfile>} switch.
794
795 Note! OpenOCD will launch the GDB & telnet server even if it can not
796 establish a connection with the target. In general, it is possible for
797 the JTAG controller to be unresponsive until the target is set up
798 correctly via e.g. GDB monitor commands in a GDB init script.
799
800 @node OpenOCD Project Setup
801 @chapter OpenOCD Project Setup
802
803 To use OpenOCD with your development projects, you need to do more than
804 just connect the JTAG adapter hardware (dongle) to your development board
805 and start the OpenOCD server.
806 You also need to configure your OpenOCD server so that it knows
807 about your adapter and board, and helps your work.
808 You may also want to connect OpenOCD to GDB, possibly
809 using Eclipse or some other GUI.
810
811 @section Hooking up the JTAG Adapter
812
813 Today's most common case is a dongle with a JTAG cable on one side
814 (such as a ribbon cable with a 10-pin or 20-pin IDC connector)
815 and a USB cable on the other.
816 Instead of USB, some cables use Ethernet;
817 older ones may use a PC parallel port, or even a serial port.
818
819 @enumerate
820 @item @emph{Start with power to your target board turned off},
821 and nothing connected to your JTAG adapter.
822 If you're particularly paranoid, unplug power to the board.
823 It's important to have the ground signal properly set up,
824 unless you are using a JTAG adapter which provides
825 galvanic isolation between the target board and the
826 debugging host.
827
828 @item @emph{Be sure it's the right kind of JTAG connector.}
829 If your dongle has a 20-pin ARM connector, you need some kind
830 of adapter (or octopus, see below) to hook it up to
831 boards using 14-pin or 10-pin connectors ... or to 20-pin
832 connectors which don't use ARM's pinout.
833
834 In the same vein, make sure the voltage levels are compatible.
835 Not all JTAG adapters have the level shifters needed to work
836 with 1.2 Volt boards.
837
838 @item @emph{Be certain the cable is properly oriented} or you might
839 damage your board. In most cases there are only two possible
840 ways to connect the cable.
841 Connect the JTAG cable from your adapter to the board.
842 Be sure it's firmly connected.
843
844 In the best case, the connector is keyed to physically
845 prevent you from inserting it wrong.
846 This is most often done using a slot on the board's male connector
847 housing, which must match a key on the JTAG cable's female connector.
848 If there's no housing, then you must look carefully and
849 make sure pin 1 on the cable hooks up to pin 1 on the board.
850 Ribbon cables are frequently all grey except for a wire on one
851 edge, which is red. The red wire is pin 1.
852
853 Sometimes dongles provide cables where one end is an ``octopus'' of
854 color coded single-wire connectors, instead of a connector block.
855 These are great when converting from one JTAG pinout to another,
856 but are tedious to set up.
857 Use these with connector pinout diagrams to help you match up the
858 adapter signals to the right board pins.
859
860 @item @emph{Connect the adapter's other end} once the JTAG cable is connected.
861 A USB, parallel, or serial port connector will go to the host which
862 you are using to run OpenOCD.
863 For Ethernet, consult the documentation and your network administrator.
864
865 For USB-based JTAG adapters you have an easy sanity check at this point:
866 does the host operating system see the JTAG adapter? If you're running
867 Linux, try the @command{lsusb} command. If that host is an
868 MS-Windows host, you'll need to install a driver before OpenOCD works.
869
870 @item @emph{Connect the adapter's power supply, if needed.}
871 This step is primarily for non-USB adapters,
872 but sometimes USB adapters need extra power.
873
874 @item @emph{Power up the target board.}
875 Unless you just let the magic smoke escape,
876 you're now ready to set up the OpenOCD server
877 so you can use JTAG to work with that board.
878
879 @end enumerate
880
881 Talk with the OpenOCD server using
882 telnet (@code{telnet localhost 4444} on many systems) or GDB.
883 @xref{GDB and OpenOCD}.
884
885 @section Project Directory
886
887 There are many ways you can configure OpenOCD and start it up.
888
889 A simple way to organize them all involves keeping a
890 single directory for your work with a given board.
891 When you start OpenOCD from that directory,
892 it searches there first for configuration files, scripts,
893 files accessed through semihosting,
894 and for code you upload to the target board.
895 It is also the natural place to write files,
896 such as log files and data you download from the board.
897
898 @section Configuration Basics
899
900 There are two basic ways of configuring OpenOCD, and
901 a variety of ways you can mix them.
902 Think of the difference as just being how you start the server:
903
904 @itemize
905 @item Many @option{-f file} or @option{-c command} options on the command line
906 @item No options, but a @dfn{user config file}
907 in the current directory named @file{openocd.cfg}
908 @end itemize
909
910 Here is an example @file{openocd.cfg} file for a setup
911 using a Signalyzer FT2232-based JTAG adapter to talk to
912 a board with an Atmel AT91SAM7X256 microcontroller:
913
914 @example
915 source [find interface/ftdi/signalyzer.cfg]
916
917 # GDB can also flash my flash!
918 gdb_memory_map enable
919 gdb_flash_program enable
920
921 source [find target/sam7x256.cfg]
922 @end example
923
924 Here is the command line equivalent of that configuration:
925
926 @example
927 openocd -f interface/ftdi/signalyzer.cfg \
928 -c "gdb_memory_map enable" \
929 -c "gdb_flash_program enable" \
930 -f target/sam7x256.cfg
931 @end example
932
933 You could wrap such long command lines in shell scripts,
934 each supporting a different development task.
935 One might re-flash the board with a specific firmware version.
936 Another might set up a particular debugging or run-time environment.
937
938 @quotation Important
939 At this writing (October 2009) the command line method has
940 problems with how it treats variables.
941 For example, after @option{-c "set VAR value"}, or doing the
942 same in a script, the variable @var{VAR} will have no value
943 that can be tested in a later script.
944 @end quotation
945
946 Here we will focus on the simpler solution: one user config
947 file, including basic configuration plus any TCL procedures
948 to simplify your work.
949
950 @section User Config Files
951 @cindex config file, user
952 @cindex user config file
953 @cindex config file, overview
954
955 A user configuration file ties together all the parts of a project
956 in one place.
957 One of the following will match your situation best:
958
959 @itemize
960 @item Ideally almost everything comes from configuration files
961 provided by someone else.
962 For example, OpenOCD distributes a @file{scripts} directory
963 (probably in @file{/usr/share/openocd/scripts} on Linux).
964 Board and tool vendors can provide these too, as can individual
965 user sites; the @option{-s} command line option lets you say
966 where to find these files. (@xref{Running}.)
967 The AT91SAM7X256 example above works this way.
968
969 Three main types of non-user configuration file each have their
970 own subdirectory in the @file{scripts} directory:
971
972 @enumerate
973 @item @b{interface} -- one for each different debug adapter;
974 @item @b{board} -- one for each different board
975 @item @b{target} -- the chips which integrate CPUs and other JTAG TAPs
976 @end enumerate
977
978 Best case: include just two files, and they handle everything else.
979 The first is an interface config file.
980 The second is board-specific, and it sets up the JTAG TAPs and
981 their GDB targets (by deferring to some @file{target.cfg} file),
982 declares all flash memory, and leaves you nothing to do except
983 meet your deadline:
984
985 @example
986 source [find interface/olimex-jtag-tiny.cfg]
987 source [find board/csb337.cfg]
988 @end example
989
990 Boards with a single microcontroller often won't need more
991 than the target config file, as in the AT91SAM7X256 example.
992 That's because there is no external memory (flash, DDR RAM), and
993 the board differences are encapsulated by application code.
994
995 @item Maybe you don't know yet what your board looks like to JTAG.
996 Once you know the @file{interface.cfg} file to use, you may
997 need help from OpenOCD to discover what's on the board.
998 Once you find the JTAG TAPs, you can just search for appropriate
999 target and board
1000 configuration files ... or write your own, from the bottom up.
1001 @xref{autoprobing,,Autoprobing}.
1002
1003 @item You can often reuse some standard config files but
1004 need to write a few new ones, probably a @file{board.cfg} file.
1005 You will be using commands described later in this User's Guide,
1006 and working with the guidelines in the next chapter.
1007
1008 For example, there may be configuration files for your JTAG adapter
1009 and target chip, but you need a new board-specific config file
1010 giving access to your particular flash chips.
1011 Or you might need to write another target chip configuration file
1012 for a new chip built around the Cortex-M3 core.
1013
1014 @quotation Note
1015 When you write new configuration files, please submit
1016 them for inclusion in the next OpenOCD release.
1017 For example, a @file{board/newboard.cfg} file will help the
1018 next users of that board, and a @file{target/newcpu.cfg}
1019 will help support users of any board using that chip.
1020 @end quotation
1021
1022 @item
1023 You may need to write some C code.
1024 It may be as simple as supporting a new FT2232 or parport
1025 based adapter; a bit more involved, like a NAND or NOR flash
1026 controller driver; or a big piece of work like supporting
1027 a new chip architecture.
1028 @end itemize
1029
1030 Reuse the existing config files when you can.
1031 Look first in the @file{scripts/boards} area, then @file{scripts/targets}.
1032 You may find a board configuration that's a good example to follow.
1033
1034 When you write config files, separate the reusable parts
1035 (things every user of that interface, chip, or board needs)
1036 from ones specific to your environment and debugging approach.
1037 @itemize
1038
1039 @item
1040 For example, a @code{gdb-attach} event handler that invokes
1041 the @command{reset init} command will interfere with debugging
1042 early boot code, which performs some of the same actions
1043 that the @code{reset-init} event handler does.
1044
1045 @item
1046 Likewise, the @command{arm9 vector_catch} command (or
1047 @cindex vector_catch
1048 its siblings @command{xscale vector_catch}
1049 and @command{cortex_m vector_catch}) can be a time-saver
1050 during some debug sessions, but don't make everyone use that either.
1051 Keep those kinds of debugging aids in your user config file,
1052 along with messaging and tracing setup.
1053 (@xref{softwaredebugmessagesandtracing,,Software Debug Messages and Tracing}.)
1054
1055 @item
1056 You might need to override some defaults.
1057 For example, you might need to move, shrink, or back up the target's
1058 work area if your application needs much SRAM.
1059
1060 @item
1061 TCP/IP port configuration is another example of something which
1062 is environment-specific, and should only appear in
1063 a user config file. @xref{tcpipports,,TCP/IP Ports}.
1064 @end itemize
1065
1066 @section Project-Specific Utilities
1067
1068 A few project-specific utility
1069 routines may well speed up your work.
1070 Write them, and keep them in your project's user config file.
1071
1072 For example, if you are making a boot loader work on a
1073 board, it's nice to be able to debug the ``after it's
1074 loaded to RAM'' parts separately from the finicky early
1075 code which sets up the DDR RAM controller and clocks.
1076 A script like this one, or a more GDB-aware sibling,
1077 may help:
1078
1079 @example
1080 proc ramboot @{ @} @{
1081 # Reset, running the target's "reset-init" scripts
1082 # to initialize clocks and the DDR RAM controller.
1083 # Leave the CPU halted.
1084 reset init
1085
1086 # Load CONFIG_SKIP_LOWLEVEL_INIT version into DDR RAM.
1087 load_image u-boot.bin 0x20000000
1088
1089 # Start running.
1090 resume 0x20000000
1091 @}
1092 @end example
1093
1094 Then once that code is working you will need to make it
1095 boot from NOR flash; a different utility would help.
1096 Alternatively, some developers write to flash using GDB.
1097 (You might use a similar script if you're working with a flash
1098 based microcontroller application instead of a boot loader.)
1099
1100 @example
1101 proc newboot @{ @} @{
1102 # Reset, leaving the CPU halted. The "reset-init" event
1103 # proc gives faster access to the CPU and to NOR flash;
1104 # "reset halt" would be slower.
1105 reset init
1106
1107 # Write standard version of U-Boot into the first two
1108 # sectors of NOR flash ... the standard version should
1109 # do the same lowlevel init as "reset-init".
1110 flash protect 0 0 1 off
1111 flash erase_sector 0 0 1
1112 flash write_bank 0 u-boot.bin 0x0
1113 flash protect 0 0 1 on
1114
1115 # Reboot from scratch using that new boot loader.
1116 reset run
1117 @}
1118 @end example
1119
1120 You may need more complicated utility procedures when booting
1121 from NAND.
1122 That often involves an extra bootloader stage,
1123 running from on-chip SRAM to perform DDR RAM setup so it can load
1124 the main bootloader code (which won't fit into that SRAM).
1125
1126 Other helper scripts might be used to write production system images,
1127 involving considerably more than just a three stage bootloader.
1128
1129 @section Target Software Changes
1130
1131 Sometimes you may want to make some small changes to the software
1132 you're developing, to help make JTAG debugging work better.
1133 For example, in C or assembly language code you might
1134 use @code{#ifdef JTAG_DEBUG} (or its converse) around code
1135 handling issues like:
1136
1137 @itemize @bullet
1138
1139 @item @b{Watchdog Timers}...
1140 Watchdog timers are typically used to automatically reset systems if
1141 some application task doesn't periodically reset the timer. (The
1142 assumption is that the system has locked up if the task can't run.)
1143 When a JTAG debugger halts the system, that task won't be able to run
1144 and reset the timer ... potentially causing resets in the middle of
1145 your debug sessions.
1146
1147 It's rarely a good idea to disable such watchdogs, since their usage
1148 needs to be debugged just like all other parts of your firmware.
1149 That might however be your only option.
1150
1151 Look instead for chip-specific ways to stop the watchdog from counting
1152 while the system is in a debug halt state. It may be simplest to set
1153 that non-counting mode in your debugger startup scripts. You may however
1154 need a different approach when, for example, a motor could be physically
1155 damaged by firmware remaining inactive in a debug halt state. That might
1156 involve a type of firmware mode where that "non-counting" mode is disabled
1157 at the beginning then re-enabled at the end; a watchdog reset might fire
1158 and complicate the debug session, but hardware (or people) would be
1159 protected.@footnote{Note that many systems support a "monitor mode" debug
1160 that is a somewhat cleaner way to address such issues. You can think of
1161 it as only halting part of the system, maybe just one task,
1162 instead of the whole thing.
1163 At this writing, January 2010, OpenOCD based debugging does not support
1164 monitor mode debug, only "halt mode" debug.}
1165
1166 @item @b{ARM Semihosting}...
1167 @cindex ARM semihosting
1168 When linked with a special runtime library provided with many
1169 toolchains@footnote{See chapter 8 "Semihosting" in
1170 @uref{http://infocenter.arm.com/help/topic/com.arm.doc.dui0203i/DUI0203I_rvct_developer_guide.pdf,
1171 ARM DUI 0203I}, the "RealView Compilation Tools Developer Guide".
1172 The CodeSourcery EABI toolchain also includes a semihosting library.},
1173 your target code can use I/O facilities on the debug host. That library
1174 provides a small set of system calls which are handled by OpenOCD.
1175 It can let the debugger provide your system console and a file system,
1176 helping with early debugging or providing a more capable environment
1177 for sometimes-complex tasks like installing system firmware onto
1178 NAND or SPI flash.
1179
1180 @item @b{ARM Wait-For-Interrupt}...
1181 Many ARM chips synchronize the JTAG clock using the core clock.
1182 Low power states which stop that core clock thus prevent JTAG access.
1183 Idle loops in tasking environments often enter those low power states
1184 via the @code{WFI} instruction (or its coprocessor equivalent, before ARMv7).
1185
1186 You may want to @emph{disable that instruction} in source code,
1187 or otherwise prevent using that state,
1188 to ensure you can get JTAG access at any time.@footnote{As a more
1189 polite alternative, some processors have special debug-oriented
1190 registers which can be used to change various features including
1191 how the low power states are clocked while debugging.
1192 The STM32 DBGMCU_CR register is an example; at the cost of extra
1193 power consumption, JTAG can be used during low power states.}
1194 For example, the OpenOCD @command{halt} command may not
1195 work for an idle processor otherwise.
1196
1197 @item @b{Delay after reset}...
1198 Not all chips have good support for debugger access
1199 right after reset; many LPC2xxx chips have issues here.
1200 Similarly, applications that reconfigure pins used for
1201 JTAG access as they start will also block debugger access.
1202
1203 To work with boards like this, @emph{enable a short delay loop}
1204 the first thing after reset, before "real" startup activities.
1205 For example, one second's delay is usually more than enough
1206 time for a JTAG debugger to attach, so that
1207 early code execution can be debugged
1208 or firmware can be replaced.
1209
1210 @item @b{Debug Communications Channel (DCC)}...
1211 Some processors include mechanisms to send messages over JTAG.
1212 Many ARM cores support these, as do some cores from other vendors.
1213 (OpenOCD may be able to use this DCC internally, speeding up some
1214 operations like writing to memory.)
1215
1216 Your application may want to deliver various debugging messages
1217 over JTAG, by @emph{linking with a small library of code}
1218 provided with OpenOCD and using the utilities there to send
1219 various kinds of message.
1220 @xref{softwaredebugmessagesandtracing,,Software Debug Messages and Tracing}.
1221
1222 @end itemize
1223
1224 @section Target Hardware Setup
1225
1226 Chip vendors often provide software development boards which
1227 are highly configurable, so that they can support all options
1228 that product boards may require. @emph{Make sure that any
1229 jumpers or switches match the system configuration you are
1230 working with.}
1231
1232 Common issues include:
1233
1234 @itemize @bullet
1235
1236 @item @b{JTAG setup} ...
1237 Boards may support more than one JTAG configuration.
1238 Examples include jumpers controlling pullups versus pulldowns
1239 on the nTRST and/or nSRST signals, and choice of connectors
1240 (e.g. which of two headers on the base board,
1241 or one from a daughtercard).
1242 For some Texas Instruments boards, you may need to jumper the
1243 EMU0 and EMU1 signals (which OpenOCD won't currently control).
1244
1245 @item @b{Boot Modes} ...
1246 Complex chips often support multiple boot modes, controlled
1247 by external jumpers. Make sure this is set up correctly.
1248 For example many i.MX boards from NXP need to be jumpered
1249 to "ATX mode" to start booting using the on-chip ROM, when
1250 using second stage bootloader code stored in a NAND flash chip.
1251
1252 Such explicit configuration is common, and not limited to
1253 booting from NAND. You might also need to set jumpers to
1254 start booting using code loaded from an MMC/SD card; external
1255 SPI flash; Ethernet, UART, or USB links; NOR flash; OneNAND
1256 flash; some external host; or various other sources.
1257
1258
1259 @item @b{Memory Addressing} ...
1260 Boards which support multiple boot modes may also have jumpers
1261 to configure memory addressing. One board, for example, jumpers
1262 external chipselect 0 (used for booting) to address either
1263 a large SRAM (which must be pre-loaded via JTAG), NOR flash,
1264 or NAND flash. When it's jumpered to address NAND flash, that
1265 board must also be told to start booting from on-chip ROM.
1266
1267 Your @file{board.cfg} file may also need to be told this jumper
1268 configuration, so that it can know whether to declare NOR flash
1269 using @command{flash bank} or instead declare NAND flash with
1270 @command{nand device}; and likewise which probe to perform in
1271 its @code{reset-init} handler.
1272
1273 A closely related issue is bus width. Jumpers might need to
1274 distinguish between 8 bit or 16 bit bus access for the flash
1275 used to start booting.
1276
1277 @item @b{Peripheral Access} ...
1278 Development boards generally provide access to every peripheral
1279 on the chip, sometimes in multiple modes (such as by providing
1280 multiple audio codec chips).
1281 This interacts with software
1282 configuration of pin multiplexing, where for example a
1283 given pin may be routed either to the MMC/SD controller
1284 or the GPIO controller. It also often interacts with
1285 configuration jumpers. One jumper may be used to route
1286 signals to an MMC/SD card slot or an expansion bus (which
1287 might in turn affect booting); others might control which
1288 audio or video codecs are used.
1289
1290 @end itemize
1291
1292 Plus you should of course have @code{reset-init} event handlers
1293 which set up the hardware to match that jumper configuration.
1294 That includes in particular any oscillator or PLL used to clock
1295 the CPU, and any memory controllers needed to access external
1296 memory and peripherals. Without such handlers, you won't be
1297 able to access those resources without working target firmware
1298 which can do that setup ... this can be awkward when you're
1299 trying to debug that target firmware. Even if there's a ROM
1300 bootloader which handles a few issues, it rarely provides full
1301 access to all board-specific capabilities.
1302
1303
1304 @node Config File Guidelines
1305 @chapter Config File Guidelines
1306
1307 This chapter is aimed at any user who needs to write a config file,
1308 including developers and integrators of OpenOCD and any user who
1309 needs to get a new board working smoothly.
1310 It provides guidelines for creating those files.
1311
1312 You should find the following directories under
1313 @t{$(INSTALLDIR)/scripts}, with config files maintained upstream. Use
1314 them as-is where you can; or as models for new files.
1315 @itemize @bullet
1316 @item @file{interface} ...
1317 These are for debug adapters. Files that specify configuration to use
1318 specific JTAG, SWD and other adapters go here.
1319 @item @file{board} ...
1320 Think Circuit Board, PWA, PCB, they go by many names. Board files
1321 contain initialization items that are specific to a board.
1322
1323 They reuse target configuration files, since the same
1324 microprocessor chips are used on many boards,
1325 but support for external parts varies widely. For
1326 example, the SDRAM initialization sequence for the board, or the type
1327 of external flash and what address it uses. Any initialization
1328 sequence to enable that external flash or SDRAM should be found in the
1329 board file. Boards may also contain multiple targets: two CPUs; or
1330 a CPU and an FPGA.
1331 @item @file{target} ...
1332 Think chip. The ``target'' directory represents the JTAG TAPs
1333 on a chip
1334 which OpenOCD should control, not a board. Two common types of targets
1335 are ARM chips and FPGA or CPLD chips.
1336 When a chip has multiple TAPs (maybe it has both ARM and DSP cores),
1337 the target config file defines all of them.
1338 @item @emph{more} ... browse for other library files which may be useful.
1339 For example, there are various generic and CPU-specific utilities.
1340 @end itemize
1341
1342 The @file{openocd.cfg} user config
1343 file may override features in any of the above files by
1344 setting variables before sourcing the target file, or by adding
1345 commands specific to their situation.
1346
1347 @section Interface Config Files
1348
1349 The user config file
1350 should be able to source one of these files with a command like this:
1351
1352 @example
1353 source [find interface/FOOBAR.cfg]
1354 @end example
1355
1356 A preconfigured interface file should exist for every debug adapter
1357 in use today with OpenOCD.
1358 That said, perhaps some of these config files
1359 have only been used by the developer who created it.
1360
1361 A separate chapter gives information about how to set these up.
1362 @xref{Debug Adapter Configuration}.
1363 Read the OpenOCD source code (and Developer's Guide)
1364 if you have a new kind of hardware interface
1365 and need to provide a driver for it.
1366
1367 @section Board Config Files
1368 @cindex config file, board
1369 @cindex board config file
1370
1371 The user config file
1372 should be able to source one of these files with a command like this:
1373
1374 @example
1375 source [find board/FOOBAR.cfg]
1376 @end example
1377
1378 The point of a board config file is to package everything
1379 about a given board that user config files need to know.
1380 In summary the board files should contain (if present)
1381
1382 @enumerate
1383 @item One or more @command{source [find target/...cfg]} statements
1384 @item NOR flash configuration (@pxref{norconfiguration,,NOR Configuration})
1385 @item NAND flash configuration (@pxref{nandconfiguration,,NAND Configuration})
1386 @item Target @code{reset} handlers for SDRAM and I/O configuration
1387 @item JTAG adapter reset configuration (@pxref{Reset Configuration})
1388 @item All things that are not ``inside a chip''
1389 @end enumerate
1390
1391 Generic things inside target chips belong in target config files,
1392 not board config files. So for example a @code{reset-init} event
1393 handler should know board-specific oscillator and PLL parameters,
1394 which it passes to target-specific utility code.
1395
1396 The most complex task of a board config file is creating such a
1397 @code{reset-init} event handler.
1398 Define those handlers last, after you verify the rest of the board
1399 configuration works.
1400
1401 @subsection Communication Between Config files
1402
1403 In addition to target-specific utility code, another way that
1404 board and target config files communicate is by following a
1405 convention on how to use certain variables.
1406
1407 The full Tcl/Tk language supports ``namespaces'', but Jim-Tcl does not.
1408 Thus the rule we follow in OpenOCD is this: Variables that begin with
1409 a leading underscore are temporary in nature, and can be modified and
1410 used at will within a target configuration file.
1411
1412 Complex board config files can do the things like this,
1413 for a board with three chips:
1414
1415 @example
1416 # Chip #1: PXA270 for network side, big endian
1417 set CHIPNAME network
1418 set ENDIAN big
1419 source [find target/pxa270.cfg]
1420 # on return: _TARGETNAME = network.cpu
1421 # other commands can refer to the "network.cpu" target.
1422 $_TARGETNAME configure .... events for this CPU..
1423
1424 # Chip #2: PXA270 for video side, little endian
1425 set CHIPNAME video
1426 set ENDIAN little
1427 source [find target/pxa270.cfg]
1428 # on return: _TARGETNAME = video.cpu
1429 # other commands can refer to the "video.cpu" target.
1430 $_TARGETNAME configure .... events for this CPU..
1431
1432 # Chip #3: Xilinx FPGA for glue logic
1433 set CHIPNAME xilinx
1434 unset ENDIAN
1435 source [find target/spartan3.cfg]
1436 @end example
1437
1438 That example is oversimplified because it doesn't show any flash memory,
1439 or the @code{reset-init} event handlers to initialize external DRAM
1440 or (assuming it needs it) load a configuration into the FPGA.
1441 Such features are usually needed for low-level work with many boards,
1442 where ``low level'' implies that the board initialization software may
1443 not be working. (That's a common reason to need JTAG tools. Another
1444 is to enable working with microcontroller-based systems, which often
1445 have no debugging support except a JTAG connector.)
1446
1447 Target config files may also export utility functions to board and user
1448 config files. Such functions should use name prefixes, to help avoid
1449 naming collisions.
1450
1451 Board files could also accept input variables from user config files.
1452 For example, there might be a @code{J4_JUMPER} setting used to identify
1453 what kind of flash memory a development board is using, or how to set
1454 up other clocks and peripherals.
1455
1456 @subsection Variable Naming Convention
1457 @cindex variable names
1458
1459 Most boards have only one instance of a chip.
1460 However, it should be easy to create a board with more than
1461 one such chip (as shown above).
1462 Accordingly, we encourage these conventions for naming
1463 variables associated with different @file{target.cfg} files,
1464 to promote consistency and
1465 so that board files can override target defaults.
1466
1467 Inputs to target config files include:
1468
1469 @itemize @bullet
1470 @item @code{CHIPNAME} ...
1471 This gives a name to the overall chip, and is used as part of
1472 tap identifier dotted names.
1473 While the default is normally provided by the chip manufacturer,
1474 board files may need to distinguish between instances of a chip.
1475 @item @code{ENDIAN} ...
1476 By default @option{little} - although chips may hard-wire @option{big}.
1477 Chips that can't change endianness don't need to use this variable.
1478 @item @code{CPUTAPID} ...
1479 When OpenOCD examines the JTAG chain, it can be told verify the
1480 chips against the JTAG IDCODE register.
1481 The target file will hold one or more defaults, but sometimes the
1482 chip in a board will use a different ID (perhaps a newer revision).
1483 @end itemize
1484
1485 Outputs from target config files include:
1486
1487 @itemize @bullet
1488 @item @code{_TARGETNAME} ...
1489 By convention, this variable is created by the target configuration
1490 script. The board configuration file may make use of this variable to
1491 configure things like a ``reset init'' script, or other things
1492 specific to that board and that target.
1493 If the chip has 2 targets, the names are @code{_TARGETNAME0},
1494 @code{_TARGETNAME1}, ... etc.
1495 @end itemize
1496
1497 @subsection The reset-init Event Handler
1498 @cindex event, reset-init
1499 @cindex reset-init handler
1500
1501 Board config files run in the OpenOCD configuration stage;
1502 they can't use TAPs or targets, since they haven't been
1503 fully set up yet.
1504 This means you can't write memory or access chip registers;
1505 you can't even verify that a flash chip is present.
1506 That's done later in event handlers, of which the target @code{reset-init}
1507 handler is one of the most important.
1508
1509 Except on microcontrollers, the basic job of @code{reset-init} event
1510 handlers is setting up flash and DRAM, as normally handled by boot loaders.
1511 Microcontrollers rarely use boot loaders; they run right out of their
1512 on-chip flash and SRAM memory. But they may want to use one of these
1513 handlers too, if just for developer convenience.
1514
1515 @quotation Note
1516 Because this is so very board-specific, and chip-specific, no examples
1517 are included here.
1518 Instead, look at the board config files distributed with OpenOCD.
1519 If you have a boot loader, its source code will help; so will
1520 configuration files for other JTAG tools
1521 (@pxref{translatingconfigurationfiles,,Translating Configuration Files}).
1522 @end quotation
1523
1524 Some of this code could probably be shared between different boards.
1525 For example, setting up a DRAM controller often doesn't differ by
1526 much except the bus width (16 bits or 32?) and memory timings, so a
1527 reusable TCL procedure loaded by the @file{target.cfg} file might take
1528 those as parameters.
1529 Similarly with oscillator, PLL, and clock setup;
1530 and disabling the watchdog.
1531 Structure the code cleanly, and provide comments to help
1532 the next developer doing such work.
1533 (@emph{You might be that next person} trying to reuse init code!)
1534
1535 The last thing normally done in a @code{reset-init} handler is probing
1536 whatever flash memory was configured. For most chips that needs to be
1537 done while the associated target is halted, either because JTAG memory
1538 access uses the CPU or to prevent conflicting CPU access.
1539
1540 @subsection JTAG Clock Rate
1541
1542 Before your @code{reset-init} handler has set up
1543 the PLLs and clocking, you may need to run with
1544 a low JTAG clock rate.
1545 @xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}.
1546 Then you'd increase that rate after your handler has
1547 made it possible to use the faster JTAG clock.
1548 When the initial low speed is board-specific, for example
1549 because it depends on a board-specific oscillator speed, then
1550 you should probably set it up in the board config file;
1551 if it's target-specific, it belongs in the target config file.
1552
1553 For most ARM-based processors the fastest JTAG clock@footnote{A FAQ
1554 @uref{http://www.arm.com/support/faqdev/4170.html} gives details.}
1555 is one sixth of the CPU clock; or one eighth for ARM11 cores.
1556 Consult chip documentation to determine the peak JTAG clock rate,
1557 which might be less than that.
1558
1559 @quotation Warning
1560 On most ARMs, JTAG clock detection is coupled to the core clock, so
1561 software using a @option{wait for interrupt} operation blocks JTAG access.
1562 Adaptive clocking provides a partial workaround, but a more complete
1563 solution just avoids using that instruction with JTAG debuggers.
1564 @end quotation
1565
1566 If both the chip and the board support adaptive clocking,
1567 use the @command{jtag_rclk}
1568 command, in case your board is used with JTAG adapter which
1569 also supports it. Otherwise use @command{adapter speed}.
1570 Set the slow rate at the beginning of the reset sequence,
1571 and the faster rate as soon as the clocks are at full speed.
1572
1573 @anchor{theinitboardprocedure}
1574 @subsection The init_board procedure
1575 @cindex init_board procedure
1576
1577 The concept of @code{init_board} procedure is very similar to @code{init_targets}
1578 (@xref{theinittargetsprocedure,,The init_targets procedure}.) - it's a replacement of ``linear''
1579 configuration scripts. This procedure is meant to be executed when OpenOCD enters run stage
1580 (@xref{enteringtherunstage,,Entering the Run Stage},) after @code{init_targets}. The idea to have
1581 separate @code{init_targets} and @code{init_board} procedures is to allow the first one to configure
1582 everything target specific (internal flash, internal RAM, etc.) and the second one to configure
1583 everything board specific (reset signals, chip frequency, reset-init event handler, external memory, etc.).
1584 Additionally ``linear'' board config file will most likely fail when target config file uses
1585 @code{init_targets} scheme (``linear'' script is executed before @code{init} and @code{init_targets} - after),
1586 so separating these two configuration stages is very convenient, as the easiest way to overcome this
1587 problem is to convert board config file to use @code{init_board} procedure. Board config scripts don't
1588 need to override @code{init_targets} defined in target config files when they only need to add some specifics.
1589
1590 Just as @code{init_targets}, the @code{init_board} procedure can be overridden by ``next level'' script (which sources
1591 the original), allowing greater code reuse.
1592
1593 @example
1594 ### board_file.cfg ###
1595
1596 # source target file that does most of the config in init_targets
1597 source [find target/target.cfg]
1598
1599 proc enable_fast_clock @{@} @{
1600 # enables fast on-board clock source
1601 # configures the chip to use it
1602 @}
1603
1604 # initialize only board specifics - reset, clock, adapter frequency
1605 proc init_board @{@} @{
1606 reset_config trst_and_srst trst_pulls_srst
1607
1608 $_TARGETNAME configure -event reset-start @{
1609 adapter speed 100
1610 @}
1611
1612 $_TARGETNAME configure -event reset-init @{
1613 enable_fast_clock
1614 adapter speed 10000
1615 @}
1616 @}
1617 @end example
1618
1619 @section Target Config Files
1620 @cindex config file, target
1621 @cindex target config file
1622
1623 Board config files communicate with target config files using
1624 naming conventions as described above, and may source one or
1625 more target config files like this:
1626
1627 @example
1628 source [find target/FOOBAR.cfg]
1629 @end example
1630
1631 The point of a target config file is to package everything
1632 about a given chip that board config files need to know.
1633 In summary the target files should contain
1634
1635 @enumerate
1636 @item Set defaults
1637 @item Add TAPs to the scan chain
1638 @item Add CPU targets (includes GDB support)
1639 @item CPU/Chip/CPU-Core specific features
1640 @item On-Chip flash
1641 @end enumerate
1642
1643 As a rule of thumb, a target file sets up only one chip.
1644 For a microcontroller, that will often include a single TAP,
1645 which is a CPU needing a GDB target, and its on-chip flash.
1646
1647 More complex chips may include multiple TAPs, and the target
1648 config file may need to define them all before OpenOCD
1649 can talk to the chip.
1650 For example, some phone chips have JTAG scan chains that include
1651 an ARM core for operating system use, a DSP,
1652 another ARM core embedded in an image processing engine,
1653 and other processing engines.
1654
1655 @subsection Default Value Boiler Plate Code
1656
1657 All target configuration files should start with code like this,
1658 letting board config files express environment-specific
1659 differences in how things should be set up.
1660
1661 @example
1662 # Boards may override chip names, perhaps based on role,
1663 # but the default should match what the vendor uses
1664 if @{ [info exists CHIPNAME] @} @{
1665 set _CHIPNAME $CHIPNAME
1666 @} else @{
1667 set _CHIPNAME sam7x256
1668 @}
1669
1670 # ONLY use ENDIAN with targets that can change it.
1671 if @{ [info exists ENDIAN] @} @{
1672 set _ENDIAN $ENDIAN
1673 @} else @{
1674 set _ENDIAN little
1675 @}
1676
1677 # TAP identifiers may change as chips mature, for example with
1678 # new revision fields (the "3" here). Pick a good default; you
1679 # can pass several such identifiers to the "jtag newtap" command.
1680 if @{ [info exists CPUTAPID ] @} @{
1681 set _CPUTAPID $CPUTAPID
1682 @} else @{
1683 set _CPUTAPID 0x3f0f0f0f
1684 @}
1685 @end example
1686 @c but 0x3f0f0f0f is for an str73x part ...
1687
1688 @emph{Remember:} Board config files may include multiple target
1689 config files, or the same target file multiple times
1690 (changing at least @code{CHIPNAME}).
1691
1692 Likewise, the target configuration file should define
1693 @code{_TARGETNAME} (or @code{_TARGETNAME0} etc) and
1694 use it later on when defining debug targets:
1695
1696 @example
1697 set _TARGETNAME $_CHIPNAME.cpu
1698 target create $_TARGETNAME arm7tdmi -chain-position $_TARGETNAME
1699 @end example
1700
1701 @subsection Adding TAPs to the Scan Chain
1702 After the ``defaults'' are set up,
1703 add the TAPs on each chip to the JTAG scan chain.
1704 @xref{TAP Declaration}, and the naming convention
1705 for taps.
1706
1707 In the simplest case the chip has only one TAP,
1708 probably for a CPU or FPGA.
1709 The config file for the Atmel AT91SAM7X256
1710 looks (in part) like this:
1711
1712 @example
1713 jtag newtap $_CHIPNAME cpu -irlen 4 -expected-id $_CPUTAPID
1714 @end example
1715
1716 A board with two such at91sam7 chips would be able
1717 to source such a config file twice, with different
1718 values for @code{CHIPNAME}, so
1719 it adds a different TAP each time.
1720
1721 If there are nonzero @option{-expected-id} values,
1722 OpenOCD attempts to verify the actual tap id against those values.
1723 It will issue error messages if there is mismatch, which
1724 can help to pinpoint problems in OpenOCD configurations.
1725
1726 @example
1727 JTAG tap: sam7x256.cpu tap/device found: 0x3f0f0f0f
1728 (Manufacturer: 0x787, Part: 0xf0f0, Version: 0x3)
1729 ERROR: Tap: sam7x256.cpu - Expected id: 0x12345678, Got: 0x3f0f0f0f
1730 ERROR: expected: mfg: 0x33c, part: 0x2345, ver: 0x1
1731 ERROR: got: mfg: 0x787, part: 0xf0f0, ver: 0x3
1732 @end example
1733
1734 There are more complex examples too, with chips that have
1735 multiple TAPs. Ones worth looking at include:
1736
1737 @itemize
1738 @item @file{target/omap3530.cfg} -- with disabled ARM and DSP,
1739 plus a JRC to enable them
1740 @item @file{target/str912.cfg} -- with flash, CPU, and boundary scan
1741 @item @file{target/ti_dm355.cfg} -- with ETM, ARM, and JRC (this JRC
1742 is not currently used)
1743 @end itemize
1744
1745 @subsection Add CPU targets
1746
1747 After adding a TAP for a CPU, you should set it up so that
1748 GDB and other commands can use it.
1749 @xref{CPU Configuration}.
1750 For the at91sam7 example above, the command can look like this;
1751 note that @code{$_ENDIAN} is not needed, since OpenOCD defaults
1752 to little endian, and this chip doesn't support changing that.
1753
1754 @example
1755 set _TARGETNAME $_CHIPNAME.cpu
1756 target create $_TARGETNAME arm7tdmi -chain-position $_TARGETNAME
1757 @end example
1758
1759 Work areas are small RAM areas associated with CPU targets.
1760 They are used by OpenOCD to speed up downloads,
1761 and to download small snippets of code to program flash chips.
1762 If the chip includes a form of ``on-chip-ram'' - and many do - define
1763 a work area if you can.
1764 Again using the at91sam7 as an example, this can look like:
1765
1766 @example
1767 $_TARGETNAME configure -work-area-phys 0x00200000 \
1768 -work-area-size 0x4000 -work-area-backup 0
1769 @end example
1770
1771 @anchor{definecputargetsworkinginsmp}
1772 @subsection Define CPU targets working in SMP
1773 @cindex SMP
1774 After setting targets, you can define a list of targets working in SMP.
1775
1776 @example
1777 set _TARGETNAME_1 $_CHIPNAME.cpu1
1778 set _TARGETNAME_2 $_CHIPNAME.cpu2
1779 target create $_TARGETNAME_1 cortex_a -chain-position $_CHIPNAME.dap \
1780 -coreid 0 -dbgbase $_DAP_DBG1
1781 target create $_TARGETNAME_2 cortex_a -chain-position $_CHIPNAME.dap \
1782 -coreid 1 -dbgbase $_DAP_DBG2
1783 #define 2 targets working in smp.
1784 target smp $_CHIPNAME.cpu2 $_CHIPNAME.cpu1
1785 @end example
1786 In the above example on cortex_a, 2 cpus are working in SMP.
1787 In SMP only one GDB instance is created and :
1788 @itemize @bullet
1789 @item a set of hardware breakpoint sets the same breakpoint on all targets in the list.
1790 @item halt command triggers the halt of all targets in the list.
1791 @item resume command triggers the write context and the restart of all targets in the list.
1792 @item following a breakpoint: the target stopped by the breakpoint is displayed to the GDB session.
1793 @item dedicated GDB serial protocol packets are implemented for switching/retrieving the target
1794 displayed by the GDB session @pxref{usingopenocdsmpwithgdb,,Using OpenOCD SMP with GDB}.
1795 @end itemize
1796
1797 The SMP behaviour can be disabled/enabled dynamically. On cortex_a following
1798 command have been implemented.
1799 @itemize @bullet
1800 @item cortex_a smp on : enable SMP mode, behaviour is as described above.
1801 @item cortex_a smp off : disable SMP mode, the current target is the one
1802 displayed in the GDB session, only this target is now controlled by GDB
1803 session. This behaviour is useful during system boot up.
1804 @item cortex_a smp : display current SMP mode.
1805 @item cortex_a smp_gdb : display/fix the core id displayed in GDB session see
1806 following example.
1807 @end itemize
1808
1809 @example
1810 >cortex_a smp_gdb
1811 gdb coreid 0 -> -1
1812 #0 : coreid 0 is displayed to GDB ,
1813 #-> -1 : next resume triggers a real resume
1814 > cortex_a smp_gdb 1
1815 gdb coreid 0 -> 1
1816 #0 :coreid 0 is displayed to GDB ,
1817 #->1 : next resume displays coreid 1 to GDB
1818 > resume
1819 > cortex_a smp_gdb
1820 gdb coreid 1 -> 1
1821 #1 :coreid 1 is displayed to GDB ,
1822 #->1 : next resume displays coreid 1 to GDB
1823 > cortex_a smp_gdb -1
1824 gdb coreid 1 -> -1
1825 #1 :coreid 1 is displayed to GDB,
1826 #->-1 : next resume triggers a real resume
1827 @end example
1828
1829
1830 @subsection Chip Reset Setup
1831
1832 As a rule, you should put the @command{reset_config} command
1833 into the board file. Most things you think you know about a
1834 chip can be tweaked by the board.
1835
1836 Some chips have specific ways the TRST and SRST signals are
1837 managed. In the unusual case that these are @emph{chip specific}
1838 and can never be changed by board wiring, they could go here.
1839 For example, some chips can't support JTAG debugging without
1840 both signals.
1841
1842 Provide a @code{reset-assert} event handler if you can.
1843 Such a handler uses JTAG operations to reset the target,
1844 letting this target config be used in systems which don't
1845 provide the optional SRST signal, or on systems where you
1846 don't want to reset all targets at once.
1847 Such a handler might write to chip registers to force a reset,
1848 use a JRC to do that (preferable -- the target may be wedged!),
1849 or force a watchdog timer to trigger.
1850 (For Cortex-M targets, this is not necessary. The target
1851 driver knows how to use trigger an NVIC reset when SRST is
1852 not available.)
1853
1854 Some chips need special attention during reset handling if
1855 they're going to be used with JTAG.
1856 An example might be needing to send some commands right
1857 after the target's TAP has been reset, providing a
1858 @code{reset-deassert-post} event handler that writes a chip
1859 register to report that JTAG debugging is being done.
1860 Another would be reconfiguring the watchdog so that it stops
1861 counting while the core is halted in the debugger.
1862
1863 JTAG clocking constraints often change during reset, and in
1864 some cases target config files (rather than board config files)
1865 are the right places to handle some of those issues.
1866 For example, immediately after reset most chips run using a
1867 slower clock than they will use later.
1868 That means that after reset (and potentially, as OpenOCD
1869 first starts up) they must use a slower JTAG clock rate
1870 than they will use later.
1871 @xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}.
1872
1873 @quotation Important
1874 When you are debugging code that runs right after chip
1875 reset, getting these issues right is critical.
1876 In particular, if you see intermittent failures when
1877 OpenOCD verifies the scan chain after reset,
1878 look at how you are setting up JTAG clocking.
1879 @end quotation
1880
1881 @anchor{theinittargetsprocedure}
1882 @subsection The init_targets procedure
1883 @cindex init_targets procedure
1884
1885 Target config files can either be ``linear'' (script executed line-by-line when parsed in
1886 configuration stage, @xref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage},) or they can contain a special
1887 procedure called @code{init_targets}, which will be executed when entering run stage
1888 (after parsing all config files or after @code{init} command, @xref{enteringtherunstage,,Entering the Run Stage}.)
1889 Such procedure can be overridden by ``next level'' script (which sources the original).
1890 This concept facilitates code reuse when basic target config files provide generic configuration
1891 procedures and @code{init_targets} procedure, which can then be sourced and enhanced or changed in
1892 a ``more specific'' target config file. This is not possible with ``linear'' config scripts,
1893 because sourcing them executes every initialization commands they provide.
1894
1895 @example
1896 ### generic_file.cfg ###
1897
1898 proc setup_my_chip @{chip_name flash_size ram_size@} @{
1899 # basic initialization procedure ...
1900 @}
1901
1902 proc init_targets @{@} @{
1903 # initializes generic chip with 4kB of flash and 1kB of RAM
1904 setup_my_chip MY_GENERIC_CHIP 4096 1024
1905 @}
1906
1907 ### specific_file.cfg ###
1908
1909 source [find target/generic_file.cfg]
1910
1911 proc init_targets @{@} @{
1912 # initializes specific chip with 128kB of flash and 64kB of RAM
1913 setup_my_chip MY_CHIP_WITH_128K_FLASH_64KB_RAM 131072 65536
1914 @}
1915 @end example
1916
1917 The easiest way to convert ``linear'' config files to @code{init_targets} version is to
1918 enclose every line of ``code'' (i.e. not @code{source} commands, procedures, etc.) in this procedure.
1919
1920 For an example of this scheme see LPC2000 target config files.
1921
1922 The @code{init_boards} procedure is a similar concept concerning board config files
1923 (@xref{theinitboardprocedure,,The init_board procedure}.)
1924
1925 @anchor{theinittargeteventsprocedure}
1926 @subsection The init_target_events procedure
1927 @cindex init_target_events procedure
1928
1929 A special procedure called @code{init_target_events} is run just after
1930 @code{init_targets} (@xref{theinittargetsprocedure,,The init_targets
1931 procedure}.) and before @code{init_board}
1932 (@xref{theinitboardprocedure,,The init_board procedure}.) It is used
1933 to set up default target events for the targets that do not have those
1934 events already assigned.
1935
1936 @subsection ARM Core Specific Hacks
1937
1938 If the chip has a DCC, enable it. If the chip is an ARM9 with some
1939 special high speed download features - enable it.
1940
1941 If present, the MMU, the MPU and the CACHE should be disabled.
1942
1943 Some ARM cores are equipped with trace support, which permits
1944 examination of the instruction and data bus activity. Trace
1945 activity is controlled through an ``Embedded Trace Module'' (ETM)
1946 on one of the core's scan chains. The ETM emits voluminous data
1947 through a ``trace port''. (@xref{armhardwaretracing,,ARM Hardware Tracing}.)
1948 If you are using an external trace port,
1949 configure it in your board config file.
1950 If you are using an on-chip ``Embedded Trace Buffer'' (ETB),
1951 configure it in your target config file.
1952
1953 @example
1954 etm config $_TARGETNAME 16 normal full etb
1955 etb config $_TARGETNAME $_CHIPNAME.etb
1956 @end example
1957
1958 @subsection Internal Flash Configuration
1959
1960 This applies @b{ONLY TO MICROCONTROLLERS} that have flash built in.
1961
1962 @b{Never ever} in the ``target configuration file'' define any type of
1963 flash that is external to the chip. (For example a BOOT flash on
1964 Chip Select 0.) Such flash information goes in a board file - not
1965 the TARGET (chip) file.
1966
1967 Examples:
1968 @itemize @bullet
1969 @item at91sam7x256 - has 256K flash YES enable it.
1970 @item str912 - has flash internal YES enable it.
1971 @item imx27 - uses boot flash on CS0 - it goes in the board file.
1972 @item pxa270 - again - CS0 flash - it goes in the board file.
1973 @end itemize
1974
1975 @anchor{translatingconfigurationfiles}
1976 @section Translating Configuration Files
1977 @cindex translation
1978 If you have a configuration file for another hardware debugger
1979 or toolset (Abatron, BDI2000, BDI3000, CCS,
1980 Lauterbach, SEGGER, Macraigor, etc.), translating
1981 it into OpenOCD syntax is often quite straightforward. The most tricky
1982 part of creating a configuration script is oftentimes the reset init
1983 sequence where e.g. PLLs, DRAM and the like is set up.
1984
1985 One trick that you can use when translating is to write small
1986 Tcl procedures to translate the syntax into OpenOCD syntax. This
1987 can avoid manual translation errors and make it easier to
1988 convert other scripts later on.
1989
1990 Example of transforming quirky arguments to a simple search and
1991 replace job:
1992
1993 @example
1994 # Lauterbach syntax(?)
1995 #
1996 # Data.Set c15:0x042f %long 0x40000015
1997 #
1998 # OpenOCD syntax when using procedure below.
1999 #
2000 # setc15 0x01 0x00050078
2001
2002 proc setc15 @{regs value@} @{
2003 global TARGETNAME
2004
2005 echo [format "set p15 0x%04x, 0x%08x" $regs $value]
2006
2007 arm mcr 15 [expr ($regs>>12)&0x7] \
2008 [expr ($regs>>0)&0xf] [expr ($regs>>4)&0xf] \
2009 [expr ($regs>>8)&0x7] $value
2010 @}
2011 @end example
2012
2013
2014
2015 @node Server Configuration
2016 @chapter Server Configuration
2017 @cindex initialization
2018 The commands here are commonly found in the openocd.cfg file and are
2019 used to specify what TCP/IP ports are used, and how GDB should be
2020 supported.
2021
2022 @anchor{configurationstage}
2023 @section Configuration Stage
2024 @cindex configuration stage
2025 @cindex config command
2026
2027 When the OpenOCD server process starts up, it enters a
2028 @emph{configuration stage} which is the only time that
2029 certain commands, @emph{configuration commands}, may be issued.
2030 Normally, configuration commands are only available
2031 inside startup scripts.
2032
2033 In this manual, the definition of a configuration command is
2034 presented as a @emph{Config Command}, not as a @emph{Command}
2035 which may be issued interactively.
2036 The runtime @command{help} command also highlights configuration
2037 commands, and those which may be issued at any time.
2038
2039 Those configuration commands include declaration of TAPs,
2040 flash banks,
2041 the interface used for JTAG communication,
2042 and other basic setup.
2043 The server must leave the configuration stage before it
2044 may access or activate TAPs.
2045 After it leaves this stage, configuration commands may no
2046 longer be issued.
2047
2048 @anchor{enteringtherunstage}
2049 @section Entering the Run Stage
2050
2051 The first thing OpenOCD does after leaving the configuration
2052 stage is to verify that it can talk to the scan chain
2053 (list of TAPs) which has been configured.
2054 It will warn if it doesn't find TAPs it expects to find,
2055 or finds TAPs that aren't supposed to be there.
2056 You should see no errors at this point.
2057 If you see errors, resolve them by correcting the
2058 commands you used to configure the server.
2059 Common errors include using an initial JTAG speed that's too
2060 fast, and not providing the right IDCODE values for the TAPs
2061 on the scan chain.
2062
2063 Once OpenOCD has entered the run stage, a number of commands
2064 become available.
2065 A number of these relate to the debug targets you may have declared.
2066 For example, the @command{mww} command will not be available until
2067 a target has been successfully instantiated.
2068 If you want to use those commands, you may need to force
2069 entry to the run stage.
2070
2071 @deffn {Config Command} init
2072 This command terminates the configuration stage and
2073 enters the run stage. This helps when you need to have
2074 the startup scripts manage tasks such as resetting the target,
2075 programming flash, etc. To reset the CPU upon startup, add "init" and
2076 "reset" at the end of the config script or at the end of the OpenOCD
2077 command line using the @option{-c} command line switch.
2078
2079 If this command does not appear in any startup/configuration file
2080 OpenOCD executes the command for you after processing all
2081 configuration files and/or command line options.
2082
2083 @b{NOTE:} This command normally occurs at or near the end of your
2084 openocd.cfg file to force OpenOCD to ``initialize'' and make the
2085 targets ready. For example: If your openocd.cfg file needs to
2086 read/write memory on your target, @command{init} must occur before
2087 the memory read/write commands. This includes @command{nand probe}.
2088 @end deffn
2089
2090 @deffn {Overridable Procedure} jtag_init
2091 This is invoked at server startup to verify that it can talk
2092 to the scan chain (list of TAPs) which has been configured.
2093
2094 The default implementation first tries @command{jtag arp_init},
2095 which uses only a lightweight JTAG reset before examining the
2096 scan chain.
2097 If that fails, it tries again, using a harder reset
2098 from the overridable procedure @command{init_reset}.
2099
2100 Implementations must have verified the JTAG scan chain before
2101 they return.
2102 This is done by calling @command{jtag arp_init}
2103 (or @command{jtag arp_init-reset}).
2104 @end deffn
2105
2106 @anchor{tcpipports}
2107 @section TCP/IP Ports
2108 @cindex TCP port
2109 @cindex server
2110 @cindex port
2111 @cindex security
2112 The OpenOCD server accepts remote commands in several syntaxes.
2113 Each syntax uses a different TCP/IP port, which you may specify
2114 only during configuration (before those ports are opened).
2115
2116 For reasons including security, you may wish to prevent remote
2117 access using one or more of these ports.
2118 In such cases, just specify the relevant port number as "disabled".
2119 If you disable all access through TCP/IP, you will need to
2120 use the command line @option{-pipe} option.
2121
2122 @anchor{gdb_port}
2123 @deffn {Command} gdb_port [number]
2124 @cindex GDB server
2125 Normally gdb listens to a TCP/IP port, but GDB can also
2126 communicate via pipes(stdin/out or named pipes). The name
2127 "gdb_port" stuck because it covers probably more than 90% of
2128 the normal use cases.
2129
2130 No arguments reports GDB port. "pipe" means listen to stdin
2131 output to stdout, an integer is base port number, "disabled"
2132 disables the gdb server.
2133
2134 When using "pipe", also use log_output to redirect the log
2135 output to a file so as not to flood the stdin/out pipes.
2136
2137 The -p/--pipe option is deprecated and a warning is printed
2138 as it is equivalent to passing in -c "gdb_port pipe; log_output openocd.log".
2139
2140 Any other string is interpreted as named pipe to listen to.
2141 Output pipe is the same name as input pipe, but with 'o' appended,
2142 e.g. /var/gdb, /var/gdbo.
2143
2144 The GDB port for the first target will be the base port, the
2145 second target will listen on gdb_port + 1, and so on.
2146 When not specified during the configuration stage,
2147 the port @var{number} defaults to 3333.
2148 When @var{number} is not a numeric value, incrementing it to compute
2149 the next port number does not work. In this case, specify the proper
2150 @var{number} for each target by using the option @code{-gdb-port} of the
2151 commands @command{target create} or @command{$target_name configure}.
2152 @xref{gdbportoverride,,option -gdb-port}.
2153
2154 Note: when using "gdb_port pipe", increasing the default remote timeout in
2155 gdb (with 'set remotetimeout') is recommended. An insufficient timeout may
2156 cause initialization to fail with "Unknown remote qXfer reply: OK".
2157 @end deffn
2158
2159 @deffn {Command} tcl_port [number]
2160 Specify or query the port used for a simplified RPC
2161 connection that can be used by clients to issue TCL commands and get the
2162 output from the Tcl engine.
2163 Intended as a machine interface.
2164 When not specified during the configuration stage,
2165 the port @var{number} defaults to 6666.
2166 When specified as "disabled", this service is not activated.
2167 @end deffn
2168
2169 @deffn {Command} telnet_port [number]
2170 Specify or query the
2171 port on which to listen for incoming telnet connections.
2172 This port is intended for interaction with one human through TCL commands.
2173 When not specified during the configuration stage,
2174 the port @var{number} defaults to 4444.
2175 When specified as "disabled", this service is not activated.
2176 @end deffn
2177
2178 @anchor{gdbconfiguration}
2179 @section GDB Configuration
2180 @cindex GDB
2181 @cindex GDB configuration
2182 You can reconfigure some GDB behaviors if needed.
2183 The ones listed here are static and global.
2184 @xref{targetconfiguration,,Target Configuration}, about configuring individual targets.
2185 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}, about configuring target-specific event handling.
2186
2187 @anchor{gdbbreakpointoverride}
2188 @deffn {Command} gdb_breakpoint_override [@option{hard}|@option{soft}|@option{disable}]
2189 Force breakpoint type for gdb @command{break} commands.
2190 This option supports GDB GUIs which don't
2191 distinguish hard versus soft breakpoints, if the default OpenOCD and
2192 GDB behaviour is not sufficient. GDB normally uses hardware
2193 breakpoints if the memory map has been set up for flash regions.
2194 @end deffn
2195
2196 @anchor{gdbflashprogram}
2197 @deffn {Config Command} gdb_flash_program (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2198 Set to @option{enable} to cause OpenOCD to program the flash memory when a
2199 vFlash packet is received.
2200 The default behaviour is @option{enable}.
2201 @end deffn
2202
2203 @deffn {Config Command} gdb_memory_map (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2204 Set to @option{enable} to cause OpenOCD to send the memory configuration to GDB when
2205 requested. GDB will then know when to set hardware breakpoints, and program flash
2206 using the GDB load command. @command{gdb_flash_program enable} must also be enabled
2207 for flash programming to work.
2208 Default behaviour is @option{enable}.
2209 @xref{gdbflashprogram,,gdb_flash_program}.
2210 @end deffn
2211
2212 @deffn {Config Command} gdb_report_data_abort (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2213 Specifies whether data aborts cause an error to be reported
2214 by GDB memory read packets.
2215 The default behaviour is @option{disable};
2216 use @option{enable} see these errors reported.
2217 @end deffn
2218
2219 @deffn {Config Command} gdb_report_register_access_error (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2220 Specifies whether register accesses requested by GDB register read/write
2221 packets report errors or not.
2222 The default behaviour is @option{disable};
2223 use @option{enable} see these errors reported.
2224 @end deffn
2225
2226 @deffn {Config Command} gdb_target_description (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2227 Set to @option{enable} to cause OpenOCD to send the target descriptions to gdb via qXfer:features:read packet.
2228 The default behaviour is @option{enable}.
2229 @end deffn
2230
2231 @deffn {Command} gdb_save_tdesc
2232 Saves the target description file to the local file system.
2233
2234 The file name is @i{target_name}.xml.
2235 @end deffn
2236
2237 @anchor{eventpolling}
2238 @section Event Polling
2239
2240 Hardware debuggers are parts of asynchronous systems,
2241 where significant events can happen at any time.
2242 The OpenOCD server needs to detect some of these events,
2243 so it can report them to through TCL command line
2244 or to GDB.
2245
2246 Examples of such events include:
2247
2248 @itemize
2249 @item One of the targets can stop running ... maybe it triggers
2250 a code breakpoint or data watchpoint, or halts itself.
2251 @item Messages may be sent over ``debug message'' channels ... many
2252 targets support such messages sent over JTAG,
2253 for receipt by the person debugging or tools.
2254 @item Loss of power ... some adapters can detect these events.
2255 @item Resets not issued through JTAG ... such reset sources
2256 can include button presses or other system hardware, sometimes
2257 including the target itself (perhaps through a watchdog).
2258 @item Debug instrumentation sometimes supports event triggering
2259 such as ``trace buffer full'' (so it can quickly be emptied)
2260 or other signals (to correlate with code behavior).
2261 @end itemize
2262
2263 None of those events are signaled through standard JTAG signals.
2264 However, most conventions for JTAG connectors include voltage
2265 level and system reset (SRST) signal detection.
2266 Some connectors also include instrumentation signals, which
2267 can imply events when those signals are inputs.
2268
2269 In general, OpenOCD needs to periodically check for those events,
2270 either by looking at the status of signals on the JTAG connector
2271 or by sending synchronous ``tell me your status'' JTAG requests
2272 to the various active targets.
2273 There is a command to manage and monitor that polling,
2274 which is normally done in the background.
2275
2276 @deffn Command poll [@option{on}|@option{off}]
2277 Poll the current target for its current state.
2278 (Also, @pxref{targetcurstate,,target curstate}.)
2279 If that target is in debug mode, architecture
2280 specific information about the current state is printed.
2281 An optional parameter
2282 allows background polling to be enabled and disabled.
2283
2284 You could use this from the TCL command shell, or
2285 from GDB using @command{monitor poll} command.
2286 Leave background polling enabled while you're using GDB.
2287 @example
2288 > poll
2289 background polling: on
2290 target state: halted
2291 target halted in ARM state due to debug-request, \
2292 current mode: Supervisor
2293 cpsr: 0x800000d3 pc: 0x11081bfc
2294 MMU: disabled, D-Cache: disabled, I-Cache: enabled
2295 >
2296 @end example
2297 @end deffn
2298
2299 @node Debug Adapter Configuration
2300 @chapter Debug Adapter Configuration
2301 @cindex config file, interface
2302 @cindex interface config file
2303
2304 Correctly installing OpenOCD includes making your operating system give
2305 OpenOCD access to debug adapters. Once that has been done, Tcl commands
2306 are used to select which one is used, and to configure how it is used.
2307
2308 @quotation Note
2309 Because OpenOCD started out with a focus purely on JTAG, you may find
2310 places where it wrongly presumes JTAG is the only transport protocol
2311 in use. Be aware that recent versions of OpenOCD are removing that
2312 limitation. JTAG remains more functional than most other transports.
2313 Other transports do not support boundary scan operations, or may be
2314 specific to a given chip vendor. Some might be usable only for
2315 programming flash memory, instead of also for debugging.
2316 @end quotation
2317
2318 Debug Adapters/Interfaces/Dongles are normally configured
2319 through commands in an interface configuration
2320 file which is sourced by your @file{openocd.cfg} file, or
2321 through a command line @option{-f interface/....cfg} option.
2322
2323 @example
2324 source [find interface/olimex-jtag-tiny.cfg]
2325 @end example
2326
2327 These commands tell
2328 OpenOCD what type of JTAG adapter you have, and how to talk to it.
2329 A few cases are so simple that you only need to say what driver to use:
2330
2331 @example
2332 # jlink interface
2333 adapter driver jlink
2334 @end example
2335
2336 Most adapters need a bit more configuration than that.
2337
2338
2339 @section Adapter Configuration
2340
2341 The @command{adapter driver} command tells OpenOCD what type of debug adapter you are
2342 using. Depending on the type of adapter, you may need to use one or
2343 more additional commands to further identify or configure the adapter.
2344
2345 @deffn {Config Command} {adapter driver} name
2346 Use the adapter driver @var{name} to connect to the
2347 target.
2348 @end deffn
2349
2350 @deffn Command {adapter list}
2351 List the debug adapter drivers that have been built into
2352 the running copy of OpenOCD.
2353 @end deffn
2354 @deffn Command {adapter transports} transport_name+
2355 Specifies the transports supported by this debug adapter.
2356 The adapter driver builds-in similar knowledge; use this only
2357 when external configuration (such as jumpering) changes what
2358 the hardware can support.
2359 @end deffn
2360
2361
2362
2363 @deffn Command {adapter name}
2364 Returns the name of the debug adapter driver being used.
2365 @end deffn
2366
2367 @anchor{adapter_usb_location}
2368 @deffn Command {adapter usb location} [<bus>-<port>[.<port>]...]
2369 Displays or specifies the physical USB port of the adapter to use. The path
2370 roots at @var{bus} and walks down the physical ports, with each
2371 @var{port} option specifying a deeper level in the bus topology, the last
2372 @var{port} denoting where the target adapter is actually plugged.
2373 The USB bus topology can be queried with the command @emph{lsusb -t} or @emph{dmesg}.
2374
2375 This command is only available if your libusb1 is at least version 1.0.16.
2376 @end deffn
2377
2378 @section Interface Drivers
2379
2380 Each of the interface drivers listed here must be explicitly
2381 enabled when OpenOCD is configured, in order to be made
2382 available at run time.
2383
2384 @deffn {Interface Driver} {amt_jtagaccel}
2385 Amontec Chameleon in its JTAG Accelerator configuration,
2386 connected to a PC's EPP mode parallel port.
2387 This defines some driver-specific commands:
2388
2389 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_port} number
2390 Specifies either the address of the I/O port (default: 0x378 for LPT1) or
2391 the number of the @file{/dev/parport} device.
2392 @end deffn
2393
2394 @deffn {Config Command} rtck [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
2395 Displays status of RTCK option.
2396 Optionally sets that option first.
2397 @end deffn
2398 @end deffn
2399
2400 @deffn {Interface Driver} {arm-jtag-ew}
2401 Olimex ARM-JTAG-EW USB adapter
2402 This has one driver-specific command:
2403
2404 @deffn Command {armjtagew_info}
2405 Logs some status
2406 @end deffn
2407 @end deffn
2408
2409 @deffn {Interface Driver} {at91rm9200}
2410 Supports bitbanged JTAG from the local system,
2411 presuming that system is an Atmel AT91rm9200
2412 and a specific set of GPIOs is used.
2413 @c command: at91rm9200_device NAME
2414 @c chooses among list of bit configs ... only one option
2415 @end deffn
2416
2417 @deffn {Interface Driver} {cmsis-dap}
2418 ARM CMSIS-DAP compliant based adapter.
2419
2420 @deffn {Config Command} {cmsis_dap_vid_pid} [vid pid]+
2421 The vendor ID and product ID of the CMSIS-DAP device. If not specified
2422 the driver will attempt to auto detect the CMSIS-DAP device.
2423 Currently, up to eight [@var{vid}, @var{pid}] pairs may be given, e.g.
2424 @example
2425 cmsis_dap_vid_pid 0xc251 0xf001 0x0d28 0x0204
2426 @end example
2427 @end deffn
2428
2429 @deffn {Config Command} {cmsis_dap_serial} [serial]
2430 Specifies the @var{serial} of the CMSIS-DAP device to use.
2431 If not specified, serial numbers are not considered.
2432 @end deffn
2433
2434 @deffn {Command} {cmsis-dap info}
2435 Display various device information, like hardware version, firmware version, current bus status.
2436 @end deffn
2437 @end deffn
2438
2439 @deffn {Interface Driver} {dummy}
2440 A dummy software-only driver for debugging.
2441 @end deffn
2442
2443 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ep93xx}
2444 Cirrus Logic EP93xx based single-board computer bit-banging (in development)
2445 @end deffn
2446
2447 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ftdi}
2448 This driver is for adapters using the MPSSE (Multi-Protocol Synchronous Serial
2449 Engine) mode built into many FTDI chips, such as the FT2232, FT4232 and FT232H.
2450
2451 The driver is using libusb-1.0 in asynchronous mode to talk to the FTDI device,
2452 bypassing intermediate libraries like libftdi or D2XX.
2453
2454 Support for new FTDI based adapters can be added completely through
2455 configuration files, without the need to patch and rebuild OpenOCD.
2456
2457 The driver uses a signal abstraction to enable Tcl configuration files to
2458 define outputs for one or several FTDI GPIO. These outputs can then be
2459 controlled using the @command{ftdi_set_signal} command. Special signal names
2460 are reserved for nTRST, nSRST and LED (for blink) so that they, if defined,
2461 will be used for their customary purpose. Inputs can be read using the
2462 @command{ftdi_get_signal} command.
2463
2464 To support SWD, a signal named SWD_EN must be defined. It is set to 1 when the
2465 SWD protocol is selected. When set, the adapter should route the SWDIO pin to
2466 the data input. An SWDIO_OE signal, if defined, will be set to 1 or 0 as
2467 required by the protocol, to tell the adapter to drive the data output onto
2468 the SWDIO pin or keep the SWDIO pin Hi-Z, respectively.
2469
2470 Depending on the type of buffer attached to the FTDI GPIO, the outputs have to
2471 be controlled differently. In order to support tristateable signals such as
2472 nSRST, both a data GPIO and an output-enable GPIO can be specified for each
2473 signal. The following output buffer configurations are supported:
2474
2475 @itemize @minus
2476 @item Push-pull with one FTDI output as (non-)inverted data line
2477 @item Open drain with one FTDI output as (non-)inverted output-enable
2478 @item Tristate with one FTDI output as (non-)inverted data line and another
2479 FTDI output as (non-)inverted output-enable
2480 @item Unbuffered, using the FTDI GPIO as a tristate output directly by
2481 switching data and direction as necessary
2482 @end itemize
2483
2484 These interfaces have several commands, used to configure the driver
2485 before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2486
2487 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_vid_pid} [vid pid]+
2488 The vendor ID and product ID of the adapter. Up to eight
2489 [@var{vid}, @var{pid}] pairs may be given, e.g.
2490 @example
2491 ftdi_vid_pid 0x0403 0xcff8 0x15ba 0x0003
2492 @end example
2493 @end deffn
2494
2495 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_device_desc} description
2496 Provides the USB device description (the @emph{iProduct string})
2497 of the adapter. If not specified, the device description is ignored
2498 during device selection.
2499 @end deffn
2500
2501 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_serial} serial-number
2502 Specifies the @var{serial-number} of the adapter to use,
2503 in case the vendor provides unique IDs and more than one adapter
2504 is connected to the host.
2505 If not specified, serial numbers are not considered.
2506 (Note that USB serial numbers can be arbitrary Unicode strings,
2507 and are not restricted to containing only decimal digits.)
2508 @end deffn
2509
2510 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_location} <bus>-<port>[.<port>]...
2511 @emph{DEPRECATED -- avoid using this.
2512 Use the command @ref{adapter_usb_location,,adapter usb location} instead.}
2513
2514 Specifies the physical USB port of the adapter to use. The path
2515 roots at @var{bus} and walks down the physical ports, with each
2516 @var{port} option specifying a deeper level in the bus topology, the last
2517 @var{port} denoting where the target adapter is actually plugged.
2518 The USB bus topology can be queried with the command @emph{lsusb -t}.
2519
2520 This command is only available if your libusb1 is at least version 1.0.16.
2521 @end deffn
2522
2523 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_channel} channel
2524 Selects the channel of the FTDI device to use for MPSSE operations. Most
2525 adapters use the default, channel 0, but there are exceptions.
2526 @end deffn
2527
2528 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_layout_init} data direction
2529 Specifies the initial values of the FTDI GPIO data and direction registers.
2530 Each value is a 16-bit number corresponding to the concatenation of the high
2531 and low FTDI GPIO registers. The values should be selected based on the
2532 schematics of the adapter, such that all signals are set to safe levels with
2533 minimal impact on the target system. Avoid floating inputs, conflicting outputs
2534 and initially asserted reset signals.
2535 @end deffn
2536
2537 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_layout_signal} name [@option{-data}|@option{-ndata} data_mask] [@option{-input}|@option{-ninput} input_mask] [@option{-oe}|@option{-noe} oe_mask] [@option{-alias}|@option{-nalias} name]
2538 Creates a signal with the specified @var{name}, controlled by one or more FTDI
2539 GPIO pins via a range of possible buffer connections. The masks are FTDI GPIO
2540 register bitmasks to tell the driver the connection and type of the output
2541 buffer driving the respective signal. @var{data_mask} is the bitmask for the
2542 pin(s) connected to the data input of the output buffer. @option{-ndata} is
2543 used with inverting data inputs and @option{-data} with non-inverting inputs.
2544 The @option{-oe} (or @option{-noe}) option tells where the output-enable (or
2545 not-output-enable) input to the output buffer is connected. The options
2546 @option{-input} and @option{-ninput} specify the bitmask for pins to be read
2547 with the method @command{ftdi_get_signal}.
2548
2549 Both @var{data_mask} and @var{oe_mask} need not be specified. For example, a
2550 simple open-collector transistor driver would be specified with @option{-oe}
2551 only. In that case the signal can only be set to drive low or to Hi-Z and the
2552 driver will complain if the signal is set to drive high. Which means that if
2553 it's a reset signal, @command{reset_config} must be specified as
2554 @option{srst_open_drain}, not @option{srst_push_pull}.
2555
2556 A special case is provided when @option{-data} and @option{-oe} is set to the
2557 same bitmask. Then the FTDI pin is considered being connected straight to the
2558 target without any buffer. The FTDI pin is then switched between output and
2559 input as necessary to provide the full set of low, high and Hi-Z
2560 characteristics. In all other cases, the pins specified in a signal definition
2561 are always driven by the FTDI.
2562
2563 If @option{-alias} or @option{-nalias} is used, the signal is created
2564 identical (or with data inverted) to an already specified signal
2565 @var{name}.
2566 @end deffn
2567
2568 @deffn {Command} {ftdi_set_signal} name @option{0}|@option{1}|@option{z}
2569 Set a previously defined signal to the specified level.
2570 @itemize @minus
2571 @item @option{0}, drive low
2572 @item @option{1}, drive high
2573 @item @option{z}, set to high-impedance
2574 @end itemize
2575 @end deffn
2576
2577 @deffn {Command} {ftdi_get_signal} name
2578 Get the value of a previously defined signal.
2579 @end deffn
2580
2581 @deffn {Command} {ftdi_tdo_sample_edge} @option{rising}|@option{falling}
2582 Configure TCK edge at which the adapter samples the value of the TDO signal
2583
2584 Due to signal propagation delays, sampling TDO on rising TCK can become quite
2585 peculiar at high JTAG clock speeds. However, FTDI chips offer a possibility to sample
2586 TDO on falling edge of TCK. With some board/adapter configurations, this may increase
2587 stability at higher JTAG clocks.
2588 @itemize @minus
2589 @item @option{rising}, sample TDO on rising edge of TCK - this is the default
2590 @item @option{falling}, sample TDO on falling edge of TCK
2591 @end itemize
2592 @end deffn
2593
2594 For example adapter definitions, see the configuration files shipped in the
2595 @file{interface/ftdi} directory.
2596
2597 @end deffn
2598
2599 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ft232r}
2600 This driver is implementing synchronous bitbang mode of an FTDI FT232R,
2601 FT230X, FT231X and similar USB UART bridge ICs by reusing RS232 signals as GPIO.
2602 It currently doesn't support using CBUS pins as GPIO.
2603
2604 List of connections (default physical pin numbers for FT232R in 28-pin SSOP package):
2605 @itemize @minus
2606 @item RXD(5) - TDI
2607 @item TXD(1) - TCK
2608 @item RTS(3) - TDO
2609 @item CTS(11) - TMS
2610 @item DTR(2) - TRST
2611 @item DCD(10) - SRST
2612 @end itemize
2613
2614 User can change default pinout by supplying configuration
2615 commands with GPIO numbers or RS232 signal names.
2616 GPIO numbers correspond to bit numbers in FTDI GPIO register.
2617 They differ from physical pin numbers.
2618 For details see actual FTDI chip datasheets.
2619 Every JTAG line must be configured to unique GPIO number
2620 different than any other JTAG line, even those lines
2621 that are sometimes not used like TRST or SRST.
2622
2623 FT232R
2624 @itemize @minus
2625 @item bit 7 - RI
2626 @item bit 6 - DCD
2627 @item bit 5 - DSR
2628 @item bit 4 - DTR
2629 @item bit 3 - CTS
2630 @item bit 2 - RTS
2631 @item bit 1 - RXD
2632 @item bit 0 - TXD
2633 @end itemize
2634
2635 These interfaces have several commands, used to configure the driver
2636 before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2637
2638 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_vid_pid} @var{vid} @var{pid}
2639 The vendor ID and product ID of the adapter. If not specified, default
2640 0x0403:0x6001 is used.
2641 @end deffn
2642
2643 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_serial_desc} @var{serial}
2644 Specifies the @var{serial} of the adapter to use, in case the
2645 vendor provides unique IDs and more than one adapter is connected to
2646 the host. If not specified, serial numbers are not considered.
2647 @end deffn
2648
2649 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_jtag_nums} @var{tck} @var{tms} @var{tdi} @var{tdo}
2650 Set four JTAG GPIO numbers at once.
2651 If not specified, default 0 3 1 2 or TXD CTS RXD RTS is used.
2652 @end deffn
2653
2654 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_tck_num} @var{tck}
2655 Set TCK GPIO number. If not specified, default 0 or TXD is used.
2656 @end deffn
2657
2658 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_tms_num} @var{tms}
2659 Set TMS GPIO number. If not specified, default 3 or CTS is used.
2660 @end deffn
2661
2662 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_tdi_num} @var{tdi}
2663 Set TDI GPIO number. If not specified, default 1 or RXD is used.
2664 @end deffn
2665
2666 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_tdo_num} @var{tdo}
2667 Set TDO GPIO number. If not specified, default 2 or RTS is used.
2668 @end deffn
2669
2670 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_trst_num} @var{trst}
2671 Set TRST GPIO number. If not specified, default 4 or DTR is used.
2672 @end deffn
2673
2674 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_srst_num} @var{srst}
2675 Set SRST GPIO number. If not specified, default 6 or DCD is used.
2676 @end deffn
2677
2678 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_restore_serial} @var{word}
2679 Restore serial port after JTAG. This USB bitmode control word
2680 (16-bit) will be sent before quit. Lower byte should
2681 set GPIO direction register to a "sane" state:
2682 0x15 for TXD RTS DTR as outputs (1), others as inputs (0). Higher
2683 byte is usually 0 to disable bitbang mode.
2684 When kernel driver reattaches, serial port should continue to work.
2685 Value 0xFFFF disables sending control word and serial port,
2686 then kernel driver will not reattach.
2687 If not specified, default 0xFFFF is used.
2688 @end deffn
2689
2690 @end deffn
2691
2692 @deffn {Interface Driver} {remote_bitbang}
2693 Drive JTAG from a remote process. This sets up a UNIX or TCP socket connection
2694 with a remote process and sends ASCII encoded bitbang requests to that process
2695 instead of directly driving JTAG.
2696
2697 The remote_bitbang driver is useful for debugging software running on
2698 processors which are being simulated.
2699
2700 @deffn {Config Command} {remote_bitbang_port} number
2701 Specifies the TCP port of the remote process to connect to or 0 to use UNIX
2702 sockets instead of TCP.
2703 @end deffn
2704
2705 @deffn {Config Command} {remote_bitbang_host} hostname
2706 Specifies the hostname of the remote process to connect to using TCP, or the
2707 name of the UNIX socket to use if remote_bitbang_port is 0.
2708 @end deffn
2709
2710 For example, to connect remotely via TCP to the host foobar you might have
2711 something like:
2712
2713 @example
2714 adapter driver remote_bitbang
2715 remote_bitbang_port 3335
2716 remote_bitbang_host foobar
2717 @end example
2718
2719 To connect to another process running locally via UNIX sockets with socket
2720 named mysocket:
2721
2722 @example
2723 adapter driver remote_bitbang
2724 remote_bitbang_port 0
2725 remote_bitbang_host mysocket
2726 @end example
2727 @end deffn
2728
2729 @deffn {Interface Driver} {usb_blaster}
2730 USB JTAG/USB-Blaster compatibles over one of the userspace libraries
2731 for FTDI chips. These interfaces have several commands, used to
2732 configure the driver before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2733
2734 @deffn {Config Command} {usb_blaster_device_desc} description
2735 Provides the USB device description (the @emph{iProduct string})
2736 of the FTDI FT245 device. If not
2737 specified, the FTDI default value is used. This setting is only valid
2738 if compiled with FTD2XX support.
2739 @end deffn
2740
2741 @deffn {Config Command} {usb_blaster_vid_pid} vid pid
2742 The vendor ID and product ID of the FTDI FT245 device. If not specified,
2743 default values are used.
2744 Currently, only one @var{vid}, @var{pid} pair may be given, e.g. for
2745 Altera USB-Blaster (default):
2746 @example
2747 usb_blaster_vid_pid 0x09FB 0x6001
2748 @end example
2749 The following VID/PID is for Kolja Waschk's USB JTAG:
2750 @example
2751 usb_blaster_vid_pid 0x16C0 0x06AD
2752 @end example
2753 @end deffn
2754
2755 @deffn {Command} {usb_blaster_pin} (@option{pin6}|@option{pin8}) (@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{s}|@option{t})
2756 Sets the state or function of the unused GPIO pins on USB-Blasters
2757 (pins 6 and 8 on the female JTAG header). These pins can be used as
2758 SRST and/or TRST provided the appropriate connections are made on the
2759 target board.
2760
2761 For example, to use pin 6 as SRST:
2762 @example
2763 usb_blaster_pin pin6 s
2764 reset_config srst_only
2765 @end example
2766 @end deffn
2767
2768 @deffn {Command} {usb_blaster_lowlevel_driver} (@option{ftdi}|@option{ublast2})
2769 Chooses the low level access method for the adapter. If not specified,
2770 @option{ftdi} is selected unless it wasn't enabled during the
2771 configure stage. USB-Blaster II needs @option{ublast2}.
2772 @end deffn
2773
2774 @deffn {Command} {usb_blaster_firmware} @var{path}
2775 This command specifies @var{path} to access USB-Blaster II firmware
2776 image. To be used with USB-Blaster II only.
2777 @end deffn
2778
2779 @end deffn
2780
2781 @deffn {Interface Driver} {gw16012}
2782 Gateworks GW16012 JTAG programmer.
2783 This has one driver-specific command:
2784
2785 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_port} [port_number]
2786 Display either the address of the I/O port
2787 (default: 0x378 for LPT1) or the number of the @file{/dev/parport} device.
2788 If a parameter is provided, first switch to use that port.
2789 This is a write-once setting.
2790 @end deffn
2791 @end deffn
2792
2793 @deffn {Interface Driver} {jlink}
2794 SEGGER J-Link family of USB adapters. It currently supports JTAG and SWD
2795 transports.
2796
2797 @quotation Compatibility Note
2798 SEGGER released many firmware versions for the many hardware versions they
2799 produced. OpenOCD was extensively tested and intended to run on all of them,
2800 but some combinations were reported as incompatible. As a general
2801 recommendation, it is advisable to use the latest firmware version
2802 available for each hardware version. However the current V8 is a moving
2803 target, and SEGGER firmware versions released after the OpenOCD was
2804 released may not be compatible. In such cases it is recommended to
2805 revert to the last known functional version. For 0.5.0, this is from
2806 "Feb 8 2012 14:30:39", packed with 4.42c. For 0.6.0, the last known
2807 version is from "May 3 2012 18:36:22", packed with 4.46f.
2808 @end quotation
2809
2810 @deffn {Command} {jlink hwstatus}
2811 Display various hardware related information, for example target voltage and pin
2812 states.
2813 @end deffn
2814 @deffn {Command} {jlink freemem}
2815 Display free device internal memory.
2816 @end deffn
2817 @deffn {Command} {jlink jtag} [@option{2}|@option{3}]
2818 Set the JTAG command version to be used. Without argument, show the actual JTAG
2819 command version.
2820 @end deffn
2821 @deffn {Command} {jlink config}
2822 Display the device configuration.
2823 @end deffn
2824 @deffn {Command} {jlink config targetpower} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
2825 Set the target power state on JTAG-pin 19. Without argument, show the target
2826 power state.
2827 @end deffn
2828 @deffn {Command} {jlink config mac} [@option{ff:ff:ff:ff:ff:ff}]
2829 Set the MAC address of the device. Without argument, show the MAC address.
2830 @end deffn
2831 @deffn {Command} {jlink config ip} [@option{A.B.C.D}(@option{/E}|@option{F.G.H.I})]
2832 Set the IP configuration of the device, where A.B.C.D is the IP address, E the
2833 bit of the subnet mask and F.G.H.I the subnet mask. Without arguments, show the
2834 IP configuration.
2835 @end deffn
2836 @deffn {Command} {jlink config usb} [@option{0} to @option{3}]
2837 Set the USB address of the device. This will also change the USB Product ID
2838 (PID) of the device. Without argument, show the USB address.
2839 @end deffn
2840 @deffn {Command} {jlink config reset}
2841 Reset the current configuration.
2842 @end deffn
2843 @deffn {Command} {jlink config write}
2844 Write the current configuration to the internal persistent storage.
2845 @end deffn
2846 @deffn {Command} {jlink emucom write <channel> <data>}
2847 Write data to an EMUCOM channel. The data needs to be encoded as hexadecimal
2848 pairs.
2849
2850 The following example shows how to write the three bytes 0xaa, 0x0b and 0x23 to
2851 the EMUCOM channel 0x10:
2852 @example
2853 > jlink emucom write 0x10 aa0b23
2854 @end example
2855 @end deffn
2856 @deffn {Command} {jlink emucom read <channel> <length>}
2857 Read data from an EMUCOM channel. The read data is encoded as hexadecimal
2858 pairs.
2859
2860 The following example shows how to read 4 bytes from the EMUCOM channel 0x0:
2861 @example
2862 > jlink emucom read 0x0 4
2863 77a90000
2864 @end example
2865 @end deffn
2866 @deffn {Config} {jlink usb} <@option{0} to @option{3}>
2867 Set the USB address of the interface, in case more than one adapter is connected
2868 to the host. If not specified, USB addresses are not considered. Device
2869 selection via USB address is deprecated and the serial number should be used
2870 instead.
2871
2872 As a configuration command, it can be used only before 'init'.
2873 @end deffn
2874 @deffn {Config} {jlink serial} <serial number>
2875 Set the serial number of the interface, in case more than one adapter is
2876 connected to the host. If not specified, serial numbers are not considered.
2877
2878 As a configuration command, it can be used only before 'init'.
2879 @end deffn
2880 @end deffn
2881
2882 @deffn {Interface Driver} {kitprog}
2883 This driver is for Cypress Semiconductor's KitProg adapters. The KitProg is an
2884 SWD-only adapter that is designed to be used with Cypress's PSoC and PRoC device
2885 families, but it is possible to use it with some other devices. If you are using
2886 this adapter with a PSoC or a PRoC, you may need to add
2887 @command{kitprog_init_acquire_psoc} or @command{kitprog acquire_psoc} to your
2888 configuration script.
2889
2890 Note that this driver is for the proprietary KitProg protocol, not the CMSIS-DAP
2891 mode introduced in firmware 2.14. If the KitProg is in CMSIS-DAP mode, it cannot
2892 be used with this driver, and must either be used with the cmsis-dap driver or
2893 switched back to KitProg mode. See the Cypress KitProg User Guide for
2894 instructions on how to switch KitProg modes.
2895
2896 Known limitations:
2897 @itemize @bullet
2898 @item The frequency of SWCLK cannot be configured, and varies between 1.6 MHz
2899 and 2.7 MHz.
2900 @item For firmware versions below 2.14, "JTAG to SWD" sequences are replaced by
2901 "SWD line reset" in the driver. This is for two reasons. First, the KitProg does
2902 not support sending arbitrary SWD sequences, and only firmware 2.14 and later
2903 implement both "JTAG to SWD" and "SWD line reset" in firmware. Earlier firmware
2904 versions only implement "SWD line reset". Second, due to a firmware quirk, an
2905 SWD sequence must be sent after every target reset in order to re-establish
2906 communications with the target.
2907 @item Due in part to the limitation above, KitProg devices with firmware below
2908 version 2.14 will need to use @command{kitprog_init_acquire_psoc} in order to
2909 communicate with PSoC 5LP devices. This is because, assuming debug is not
2910 disabled on the PSoC, the PSoC 5LP needs its JTAG interface switched to SWD
2911 mode before communication can begin, but prior to firmware 2.14, "JTAG to SWD"
2912 could only be sent with an acquisition sequence.
2913 @end itemize
2914
2915 @deffn {Config Command} {kitprog_init_acquire_psoc}
2916 Indicate that a PSoC acquisition sequence needs to be run during adapter init.
2917 Please be aware that the acquisition sequence hard-resets the target.
2918 @end deffn
2919
2920 @deffn {Config Command} {kitprog_serial} serial
2921 Select a KitProg device by its @var{serial}. If left unspecified, the first
2922 device detected by OpenOCD will be used.
2923 @end deffn
2924
2925 @deffn {Command} {kitprog acquire_psoc}
2926 Run a PSoC acquisition sequence immediately. Typically, this should not be used
2927 outside of the target-specific configuration scripts since it hard-resets the
2928 target as a side-effect.
2929 This is necessary for "reset halt" on some PSoC 4 series devices.
2930 @end deffn
2931
2932 @deffn {Command} {kitprog info}
2933 Display various adapter information, such as the hardware version, firmware
2934 version, and target voltage.
2935 @end deffn
2936 @end deffn
2937
2938 @deffn {Interface Driver} {parport}
2939 Supports PC parallel port bit-banging cables:
2940 Wigglers, PLD download cable, and more.
2941 These interfaces have several commands, used to configure the driver
2942 before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2943
2944 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_cable} name
2945 Set the layout of the parallel port cable used to connect to the target.
2946 This is a write-once setting.
2947 Currently valid cable @var{name} values include:
2948
2949 @itemize @minus
2950 @item @b{altium} Altium Universal JTAG cable.
2951 @item @b{arm-jtag} Same as original wiggler except SRST and
2952 TRST connections reversed and TRST is also inverted.
2953 @item @b{chameleon} The Amontec Chameleon's CPLD when operated
2954 in configuration mode. This is only used to
2955 program the Chameleon itself, not a connected target.
2956 @item @b{dlc5} The Xilinx Parallel cable III.
2957 @item @b{flashlink} The ST Parallel cable.
2958 @item @b{lattice} Lattice ispDOWNLOAD Cable
2959 @item @b{old_amt_wiggler} The Wiggler configuration that comes with
2960 some versions of
2961 Amontec's Chameleon Programmer. The new version available from
2962 the website uses the original Wiggler layout ('@var{wiggler}')
2963 @item @b{triton} The parallel port adapter found on the
2964 ``Karo Triton 1 Development Board''.
2965 This is also the layout used by the HollyGates design
2966 (see @uref{http://www.lartmaker.nl/projects/jtag/}).
2967 @item @b{wiggler} The original Wiggler layout, also supported by
2968 several clones, such as the Olimex ARM-JTAG
2969 @item @b{wiggler2} Same as original wiggler except an led is fitted on D5.
2970 @item @b{wiggler_ntrst_inverted} Same as original wiggler except TRST is inverted.
2971 @end itemize
2972 @end deffn
2973
2974 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_port} [port_number]
2975 Display either the address of the I/O port
2976 (default: 0x378 for LPT1) or the number of the @file{/dev/parport} device.
2977 If a parameter is provided, first switch to use that port.
2978 This is a write-once setting.
2979
2980 When using PPDEV to access the parallel port, use the number of the parallel port:
2981 @option{parport_port 0} (the default). If @option{parport_port 0x378} is specified
2982 you may encounter a problem.
2983 @end deffn
2984
2985 @deffn Command {parport_toggling_time} [nanoseconds]
2986 Displays how many nanoseconds the hardware needs to toggle TCK;
2987 the parport driver uses this value to obey the
2988 @command{adapter speed} configuration.
2989 When the optional @var{nanoseconds} parameter is given,
2990 that setting is changed before displaying the current value.
2991
2992 The default setting should work reasonably well on commodity PC hardware.
2993 However, you may want to calibrate for your specific hardware.
2994 @quotation Tip
2995 To measure the toggling time with a logic analyzer or a digital storage
2996 oscilloscope, follow the procedure below:
2997 @example
2998 > parport_toggling_time 1000
2999 > adapter speed 500
3000 @end example
3001 This sets the maximum JTAG clock speed of the hardware, but
3002 the actual speed probably deviates from the requested 500 kHz.
3003 Now, measure the time between the two closest spaced TCK transitions.
3004 You can use @command{runtest 1000} or something similar to generate a
3005 large set of samples.
3006 Update the setting to match your measurement:
3007 @example
3008 > parport_toggling_time <measured nanoseconds>
3009 @end example
3010 Now the clock speed will be a better match for @command{adapter speed}
3011 command given in OpenOCD scripts and event handlers.
3012
3013 You can do something similar with many digital multimeters, but note
3014 that you'll probably need to run the clock continuously for several
3015 seconds before it decides what clock rate to show. Adjust the
3016 toggling time up or down until the measured clock rate is a good
3017 match with the rate you specified in the @command{adapter speed} command;
3018 be conservative.
3019 @end quotation
3020 @end deffn
3021
3022 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_write_on_exit} (@option{on}|@option{off})
3023 This will configure the parallel driver to write a known
3024 cable-specific value to the parallel interface on exiting OpenOCD.
3025 @end deffn
3026
3027 For example, the interface configuration file for a
3028 classic ``Wiggler'' cable on LPT2 might look something like this:
3029
3030 @example
3031 adapter driver parport
3032 parport_port 0x278
3033 parport_cable wiggler
3034 @end example
3035 @end deffn
3036
3037 @deffn {Interface Driver} {presto}
3038 ASIX PRESTO USB JTAG programmer.
3039 @deffn {Config Command} {presto_serial} serial_string
3040 Configures the USB serial number of the Presto device to use.
3041 @end deffn
3042 @end deffn
3043
3044 @deffn {Interface Driver} {rlink}
3045 Raisonance RLink USB adapter
3046 @end deffn
3047
3048 @deffn {Interface Driver} {usbprog}
3049 usbprog is a freely programmable USB adapter.
3050 @end deffn
3051
3052 @deffn {Interface Driver} {vsllink}
3053 vsllink is part of Versaloon which is a versatile USB programmer.
3054
3055 @quotation Note
3056 This defines quite a few driver-specific commands,
3057 which are not currently documented here.
3058 @end quotation
3059 @end deffn
3060
3061 @anchor{hla_interface}
3062 @deffn {Interface Driver} {hla}
3063 This is a driver that supports multiple High Level Adapters.
3064 This type of adapter does not expose some of the lower level api's
3065 that OpenOCD would normally use to access the target.
3066
3067 Currently supported adapters include the STMicroelectronics ST-LINK and TI ICDI.
3068 ST-LINK firmware version >= V2.J21.S4 recommended due to issues with earlier
3069 versions of firmware where serial number is reset after first use. Suggest
3070 using ST firmware update utility to upgrade ST-LINK firmware even if current
3071 version reported is V2.J21.S4.
3072
3073 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_device_desc} description
3074 Currently Not Supported.
3075 @end deffn
3076
3077 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_serial} serial
3078 Specifies the serial number of the adapter.
3079 @end deffn
3080
3081 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_layout} (@option{stlink}|@option{icdi})
3082 Specifies the adapter layout to use.
3083 @end deffn
3084
3085 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_vid_pid} [vid pid]+
3086 Pairs of vendor IDs and product IDs of the device.
3087 @end deffn
3088
3089 @deffn {Command} {hla_command} command
3090 Execute a custom adapter-specific command. The @var{command} string is
3091 passed as is to the underlying adapter layout handler.
3092 @end deffn
3093 @end deffn
3094
3095 @anchor{st_link_dap_interface}
3096 @deffn {Interface Driver} {st-link}
3097 This is a driver that supports STMicroelectronics adapters ST-LINK/V2
3098 (from firmware V2J24) and STLINK-V3, thanks to a new API that provides
3099 directly access the arm ADIv5 DAP.
3100
3101 The new API provide access to multiple AP on the same DAP, but the
3102 maximum number of the AP port is limited by the specific firmware version
3103 (e.g. firmware V2J29 has 3 as maximum AP number, while V2J32 has 8).
3104 An error is returned for any AP number above the maximum allowed value.
3105
3106 @emph{Note:} Either these same adapters and their older versions are
3107 also supported by @ref{hla_interface, the hla interface driver}.
3108
3109 @deffn {Config Command} {st-link serial} serial
3110 Specifies the serial number of the adapter.
3111 @end deffn
3112
3113 @deffn {Config Command} {st-link vid_pid} [vid pid]+
3114 Pairs of vendor IDs and product IDs of the device.
3115 @end deffn
3116 @end deffn
3117
3118 @deffn {Interface Driver} {opendous}
3119 opendous-jtag is a freely programmable USB adapter.
3120 @end deffn
3121
3122 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ulink}
3123 This is the Keil ULINK v1 JTAG debugger.
3124 @end deffn
3125
3126 @deffn {Interface Driver} {xds110}
3127 The XDS110 is included as the embedded debug probe on many Texas Instruments
3128 LaunchPad evaluation boards. The XDS110 is also available as a stand-alone USB
3129 debug probe with the added capability to supply power to the target board. The
3130 following commands are supported by the XDS110 driver:
3131
3132 @deffn {Config Command} {xds110 serial} serial_string
3133 Specifies the serial number of which XDS110 probe to use. Otherwise, the first
3134 XDS110 found will be used.
3135 @end deffn
3136
3137 @deffn {Config Command} {xds110 supply} voltage_in_millivolts
3138 Available only on the XDS110 stand-alone probe. Sets the voltage level of the
3139 XDS110 power supply. A value of 0 leaves the supply off. Otherwise, the supply
3140 can be set to any value in the range 1800 to 3600 millivolts.
3141 @end deffn
3142
3143 @deffn {Command} {xds110 info}
3144 Displays information about the connected XDS110 debug probe (e.g. firmware
3145 version).
3146 @end deffn
3147 @end deffn
3148
3149 @deffn {Interface Driver} {xlnx_pcie_xvc}
3150 This driver supports the Xilinx Virtual Cable (XVC) over PCI Express.
3151 It is commonly found in Xilinx based PCI Express designs. It allows debugging
3152 fabric based JTAG/SWD devices such as Cortex-M1/M3 microcontrollers. Access to this is
3153 exposed via extended capability registers in the PCI Express configuration space.
3154
3155 For more information see Xilinx PG245 (Section on From_PCIE_to_JTAG mode).
3156
3157 @deffn {Config Command} {xlnx_pcie_xvc_config} device
3158 Specifies the PCI Express device via parameter @var{device} to use.
3159
3160 The correct value for @var{device} can be obtained by looking at the output
3161 of lscpi -D (first column) for the corresponding device.
3162
3163 The string will be of the format "DDDD:BB:SS.F" such as "0000:65:00.1".
3164
3165 @end deffn
3166 @end deffn
3167
3168 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ZY1000}
3169 This is the Zylin ZY1000 JTAG debugger.
3170 @end deffn
3171
3172 @quotation Note
3173 This defines some driver-specific commands,
3174 which are not currently documented here.
3175 @end quotation
3176
3177 @deffn Command power [@option{on}|@option{off}]
3178 Turn power switch to target on/off.
3179 No arguments: print status.
3180 @end deffn
3181
3182 @deffn {Interface Driver} {bcm2835gpio}
3183 This SoC is present in Raspberry Pi which is a cheap single-board computer
3184 exposing some GPIOs on its expansion header.
3185
3186 The driver accesses memory-mapped GPIO peripheral registers directly
3187 for maximum performance, but the only possible race condition is for
3188 the pins' modes/muxing (which is highly unlikely), so it should be
3189 able to coexist nicely with both sysfs bitbanging and various
3190 peripherals' kernel drivers. The driver restores the previous
3191 configuration on exit.
3192
3193 See @file{interface/raspberrypi-native.cfg} for a sample config and
3194 pinout.
3195
3196 @end deffn
3197
3198 @deffn {Interface Driver} {imx_gpio}
3199 i.MX SoC is present in many community boards. Wandboard is an example
3200 of the one which is most popular.
3201
3202 This driver is mostly the same as bcm2835gpio.
3203
3204 See @file{interface/imx-native.cfg} for a sample config and
3205 pinout.
3206
3207 @end deffn
3208
3209
3210 @deffn {Interface Driver} {openjtag}
3211 OpenJTAG compatible USB adapter.
3212 This defines some driver-specific commands:
3213
3214 @deffn {Config Command} {openjtag_variant} variant
3215 Specifies the variant of the OpenJTAG adapter (see @uref{http://www.openjtag.org/}).
3216 Currently valid @var{variant} values include:
3217
3218 @itemize @minus
3219 @item @b{standard} Standard variant (default).
3220 @item @b{cy7c65215} Cypress CY7C65215 Dual Channel USB-Serial Bridge Controller
3221 (see @uref{http://www.cypress.com/?rID=82870}).
3222 @end itemize
3223 @end deffn
3224
3225 @deffn {Config Command} {openjtag_device_desc} string
3226 The USB device description string of the adapter.
3227 This value is only used with the standard variant.
3228 @end deffn
3229 @end deffn
3230
3231 @section Transport Configuration
3232 @cindex Transport
3233 As noted earlier, depending on the version of OpenOCD you use,
3234 and the debug adapter you are using,
3235 several transports may be available to
3236 communicate with debug targets (or perhaps to program flash memory).
3237 @deffn Command {transport list}
3238 displays the names of the transports supported by this
3239 version of OpenOCD.
3240 @end deffn
3241
3242 @deffn Command {transport select} @option{transport_name}
3243 Select which of the supported transports to use in this OpenOCD session.
3244
3245 When invoked with @option{transport_name}, attempts to select the named
3246 transport. The transport must be supported by the debug adapter
3247 hardware and by the version of OpenOCD you are using (including the
3248 adapter's driver).
3249
3250 If no transport has been selected and no @option{transport_name} is
3251 provided, @command{transport select} auto-selects the first transport
3252 supported by the debug adapter.
3253
3254 @command{transport select} always returns the name of the session's selected
3255 transport, if any.
3256 @end deffn
3257
3258 @subsection JTAG Transport
3259 @cindex JTAG
3260 JTAG is the original transport supported by OpenOCD, and most
3261 of the OpenOCD commands support it.
3262 JTAG transports expose a chain of one or more Test Access Points (TAPs),
3263 each of which must be explicitly declared.
3264 JTAG supports both debugging and boundary scan testing.
3265 Flash programming support is built on top of debug support.
3266
3267 JTAG transport is selected with the command @command{transport select
3268 jtag}. Unless your adapter uses either @ref{hla_interface,the hla interface
3269 driver} (in which case the command is @command{transport select hla_jtag})
3270 or @ref{st_link_dap_interface,the st-link interface driver} (in which case
3271 the command is @command{transport select dapdirect_jtag}).
3272
3273 @subsection SWD Transport
3274 @cindex SWD
3275 @cindex Serial Wire Debug
3276 SWD (Serial Wire Debug) is an ARM-specific transport which exposes one
3277 Debug Access Point (DAP, which must be explicitly declared.
3278 (SWD uses fewer signal wires than JTAG.)
3279 SWD is debug-oriented, and does not support boundary scan testing.
3280 Flash programming support is built on top of debug support.
3281 (Some processors support both JTAG and SWD.)
3282
3283 SWD transport is selected with the command @command{transport select
3284 swd}. Unless your adapter uses either @ref{hla_interface,the hla interface
3285 driver} (in which case the command is @command{transport select hla_swd})
3286 or @ref{st_link_dap_interface,the st-link interface driver} (in which case
3287 the command is @command{transport select dapdirect_swd}).
3288
3289 @deffn Command {swd newdap} ...
3290 Declares a single DAP which uses SWD transport.
3291 Parameters are currently the same as "jtag newtap" but this is
3292 expected to change.
3293 @end deffn
3294 @deffn Command {swd wcr trn prescale}
3295 Updates TRN (turnaround delay) and prescaling.fields of the
3296 Wire Control Register (WCR).
3297 No parameters: displays current settings.
3298 @end deffn
3299
3300 @subsection SPI Transport
3301 @cindex SPI
3302 @cindex Serial Peripheral Interface
3303 The Serial Peripheral Interface (SPI) is a general purpose transport
3304 which uses four wire signaling. Some processors use it as part of a
3305 solution for flash programming.
3306
3307 @anchor{swimtransport}
3308 @subsection SWIM Transport
3309 @cindex SWIM
3310 @cindex Single Wire Interface Module
3311 The Single Wire Interface Module (SWIM) is a low-pin-count debug protocol used
3312 by the STMicroelectronics MCU family STM8 and documented in the
3313 @uref{https://www.st.com/resource/en/user_manual/cd00173911.pdf, User Manual UM470}.
3314
3315 SWIM does not support boundary scan testing nor multiple cores.
3316
3317 The SWIM transport is selected with the command @command{transport select swim}.
3318
3319 The concept of TAPs does not fit in the protocol since SWIM does not implement
3320 a scan chain. Nevertheless, the current SW model of OpenOCD requires defining a
3321 virtual SWIM TAP through the command @command{swim newtap basename tap_type}.
3322 The TAP definition must precede the target definition command
3323 @command{target create target_name stm8 -chain-position basename.tap_type}.
3324
3325 @anchor{jtagspeed}
3326 @section JTAG Speed
3327 JTAG clock setup is part of system setup.
3328 It @emph{does not belong with interface setup} since any interface
3329 only knows a few of the constraints for the JTAG clock speed.
3330 Sometimes the JTAG speed is
3331 changed during the target initialization process: (1) slow at
3332 reset, (2) program the CPU clocks, (3) run fast.
3333 Both the "slow" and "fast" clock rates are functions of the
3334 oscillators used, the chip, the board design, and sometimes
3335 power management software that may be active.
3336
3337 The speed used during reset, and the scan chain verification which
3338 follows reset, can be adjusted using a @code{reset-start}
3339 target event handler.
3340 It can then be reconfigured to a faster speed by a
3341 @code{reset-init} target event handler after it reprograms those
3342 CPU clocks, or manually (if something else, such as a boot loader,
3343 sets up those clocks).
3344 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
3345 When the initial low JTAG speed is a chip characteristic, perhaps
3346 because of a required oscillator speed, provide such a handler
3347 in the target config file.
3348 When that speed is a function of a board-specific characteristic
3349 such as which speed oscillator is used, it belongs in the board
3350 config file instead.
3351 In both cases it's safest to also set the initial JTAG clock rate
3352 to that same slow speed, so that OpenOCD never starts up using a
3353 clock speed that's faster than the scan chain can support.
3354
3355 @example
3356 jtag_rclk 3000
3357 $_TARGET.cpu configure -event reset-start @{ jtag_rclk 3000 @}
3358 @end example
3359
3360 If your system supports adaptive clocking (RTCK), configuring
3361 JTAG to use that is probably the most robust approach.
3362 However, it introduces delays to synchronize clocks; so it
3363 may not be the fastest solution.
3364
3365 @b{NOTE:} Script writers should consider using @command{jtag_rclk}
3366 instead of @command{adapter speed}, but only for (ARM) cores and boards
3367 which support adaptive clocking.
3368
3369 @deffn {Command} adapter speed max_speed_kHz
3370 A non-zero speed is in KHZ. Hence: 3000 is 3mhz.
3371 JTAG interfaces usually support a limited number of
3372 speeds. The speed actually used won't be faster
3373 than the speed specified.
3374
3375 Chip data sheets generally include a top JTAG clock rate.
3376 The actual rate is often a function of a CPU core clock,
3377 and is normally less than that peak rate.
3378 For example, most ARM cores accept at most one sixth of the CPU clock.
3379
3380 Speed 0 (khz) selects RTCK method.
3381 @xref{faqrtck,,FAQ RTCK}.
3382 If your system uses RTCK, you won't need to change the
3383 JTAG clocking after setup.
3384 Not all interfaces, boards, or targets support ``rtck''.
3385 If the interface device can not
3386 support it, an error is returned when you try to use RTCK.
3387 @end deffn
3388
3389 @defun jtag_rclk fallback_speed_kHz
3390 @cindex adaptive clocking
3391 @cindex RTCK
3392 This Tcl proc (defined in @file{startup.tcl}) attempts to enable RTCK/RCLK.
3393 If that fails (maybe the interface, board, or target doesn't
3394 support it), falls back to the specified frequency.
3395 @example
3396 # Fall back to 3mhz if RTCK is not supported
3397 jtag_rclk 3000
3398 @end example
3399 @end defun
3400
3401 @node Reset Configuration
3402 @chapter Reset Configuration
3403 @cindex Reset Configuration
3404
3405 Every system configuration may require a different reset
3406 configuration. This can also be quite confusing.
3407 Resets also interact with @var{reset-init} event handlers,
3408 which do things like setting up clocks and DRAM, and
3409 JTAG clock rates. (@xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}.)
3410 They can also interact with JTAG routers.
3411 Please see the various board files for examples.
3412
3413 @quotation Note
3414 To maintainers and integrators:
3415 Reset configuration touches several things at once.
3416 Normally the board configuration file
3417 should define it and assume that the JTAG adapter supports
3418 everything that's wired up to the board's JTAG connector.
3419
3420 However, the target configuration file could also make note
3421 of something the silicon vendor has done inside the chip,
3422 which will be true for most (or all) boards using that chip.
3423 And when the JTAG adapter doesn't support everything, the
3424 user configuration file will need to override parts of
3425 the reset configuration provided by other files.
3426 @end quotation
3427
3428 @section Types of Reset
3429
3430 There are many kinds of reset possible through JTAG, but
3431 they may not all work with a given board and adapter.
3432 That's part of why reset configuration can be error prone.
3433
3434 @itemize @bullet
3435 @item
3436 @emph{System Reset} ... the @emph{SRST} hardware signal
3437 resets all chips connected to the JTAG adapter, such as processors,
3438 power management chips, and I/O controllers. Normally resets triggered
3439 with this signal behave exactly like pressing a RESET button.
3440 @item
3441 @emph{JTAG TAP Reset} ... the @emph{TRST} hardware signal resets
3442 just the TAP controllers connected to the JTAG adapter.
3443 Such resets should not be visible to the rest of the system; resetting a
3444 device's TAP controller just puts that controller into a known state.
3445 @item
3446 @emph{Emulation Reset} ... many devices can be reset through JTAG
3447 commands. These resets are often distinguishable from system
3448 resets, either explicitly (a "reset reason" register says so)
3449 or implicitly (not all parts of the chip get reset).
3450 @item
3451 @emph{Other Resets} ... system-on-chip devices often support
3452 several other types of reset.
3453 You may need to arrange that a watchdog timer stops
3454 while debugging, preventing a watchdog reset.
3455 There may be individual module resets.
3456 @end itemize
3457
3458 In the best case, OpenOCD can hold SRST, then reset
3459 the TAPs via TRST and send commands through JTAG to halt the
3460 CPU at the reset vector before the 1st instruction is executed.
3461 Then when it finally releases the SRST signal, the system is
3462 halted under debugger control before any code has executed.
3463 This is the behavior required to support the @command{reset halt}
3464 and @command{reset init} commands; after @command{reset init} a
3465 board-specific script might do things like setting up DRAM.
3466 (@xref{resetcommand,,Reset Command}.)
3467
3468 @anchor{srstandtrstissues}
3469 @section SRST and TRST Issues
3470
3471 Because SRST and TRST are hardware signals, they can have a
3472 variety of system-specific constraints. Some of the most
3473 common issues are:
3474
3475 @itemize @bullet
3476
3477 @item @emph{Signal not available} ... Some boards don't wire
3478 SRST or TRST to the JTAG connector. Some JTAG adapters don't
3479 support such signals even if they are wired up.
3480 Use the @command{reset_config} @var{signals} options to say
3481 when either of those signals is not connected.
3482 When SRST is not available, your code might not be able to rely
3483 on controllers having been fully reset during code startup.
3484 Missing TRST is not a problem, since JTAG-level resets can
3485 be triggered using with TMS signaling.
3486
3487 @item @emph{Signals shorted} ... Sometimes a chip, board, or
3488 adapter will connect SRST to TRST, instead of keeping them separate.
3489 Use the @command{reset_config} @var{combination} options to say
3490 when those signals aren't properly independent.
3491
3492 @item @emph{Timing} ... Reset circuitry like a resistor/capacitor
3493 delay circuit, reset supervisor, or on-chip features can extend
3494 the effect of a JTAG adapter's reset for some time after the adapter
3495 stops issuing the reset. For example, there may be chip or board
3496 requirements that all reset pulses last for at least a
3497 certain amount of time; and reset buttons commonly have
3498 hardware debouncing.
3499 Use the @command{adapter srst delay} and @command{jtag_ntrst_delay}
3500 commands to say when extra delays are needed.
3501
3502 @item @emph{Drive type} ... Reset lines often have a pullup
3503 resistor, letting the JTAG interface treat them as open-drain
3504 signals. But that's not a requirement, so the adapter may need
3505 to use push/pull output drivers.
3506 Also, with weak pullups it may be advisable to drive
3507 signals to both levels (push/pull) to minimize rise times.
3508 Use the @command{reset_config} @var{trst_type} and
3509 @var{srst_type} parameters to say how to drive reset signals.
3510
3511 @item @emph{Special initialization} ... Targets sometimes need
3512 special JTAG initialization sequences to handle chip-specific
3513 issues (not limited to errata).
3514 For example, certain JTAG commands might need to be issued while
3515 the system as a whole is in a reset state (SRST active)
3516 but the JTAG scan chain is usable (TRST inactive).
3517 Many systems treat combined assertion of SRST and TRST as a
3518 trigger for a harder reset than SRST alone.
3519 Such custom reset handling is discussed later in this chapter.
3520 @end itemize
3521
3522 There can also be other issues.
3523 Some devices don't fully conform to the JTAG specifications.
3524 Trivial system-specific differences are common, such as
3525 SRST and TRST using slightly different names.
3526 There are also vendors who distribute key JTAG documentation for
3527 their chips only to developers who have signed a Non-Disclosure
3528 Agreement (NDA).
3529
3530 Sometimes there are chip-specific extensions like a requirement to use
3531 the normally-optional TRST signal (precluding use of JTAG adapters which
3532 don't pass TRST through), or needing extra steps to complete a TAP reset.
3533
3534 In short, SRST and especially TRST handling may be very finicky,
3535 needing to cope with both architecture and board specific constraints.
3536
3537 @section Commands for Handling Resets
3538
3539 @deffn {Command} adapter srst pulse_width milliseconds
3540 Minimum amount of time (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait
3541 after asserting nSRST (active-low system reset) before
3542 allowing it to be deasserted.
3543 @end deffn
3544
3545 @deffn {Command} adapter srst delay milliseconds
3546 How long (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait after deasserting
3547 nSRST (active-low system reset) before starting new JTAG operations.
3548 When a board has a reset button connected to SRST line it will
3549 probably have hardware debouncing, implying you should use this.
3550 @end deffn
3551
3552 @deffn {Command} jtag_ntrst_assert_width milliseconds
3553 Minimum amount of time (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait
3554 after asserting nTRST (active-low JTAG TAP reset) before
3555 allowing it to be deasserted.
3556 @end deffn
3557
3558 @deffn {Command} jtag_ntrst_delay milliseconds
3559 How long (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait after deasserting
3560 nTRST (active-low JTAG TAP reset) before starting new JTAG operations.
3561 @end deffn
3562
3563 @anchor{reset_config}
3564 @deffn {Command} reset_config mode_flag ...
3565 This command displays or modifies the reset configuration
3566 of your combination of JTAG board and target in target
3567 configuration scripts.
3568
3569 Information earlier in this section describes the kind of problems
3570 the command is intended to address (@pxref{srstandtrstissues,,SRST and TRST Issues}).
3571 As a rule this command belongs only in board config files,
3572 describing issues like @emph{board doesn't connect TRST};
3573 or in user config files, addressing limitations derived
3574 from a particular combination of interface and board.
3575 (An unlikely example would be using a TRST-only adapter
3576 with a board that only wires up SRST.)
3577
3578 The @var{mode_flag} options can be specified in any order, but only one
3579 of each type -- @var{signals}, @var{combination}, @var{gates},
3580 @var{trst_type}, @var{srst_type} and @var{connect_type}
3581 -- may be specified at a time.
3582 If you don't provide a new value for a given type, its previous
3583 value (perhaps the default) is unchanged.
3584 For example, this means that you don't need to say anything at all about
3585 TRST just to declare that if the JTAG adapter should want to drive SRST,
3586 it must explicitly be driven high (@option{srst_push_pull}).
3587
3588 @itemize
3589 @item
3590 @var{signals} can specify which of the reset signals are connected.
3591 For example, If the JTAG interface provides SRST, but the board doesn't
3592 connect that signal properly, then OpenOCD can't use it.
3593 Possible values are @option{none} (the default), @option{trst_only},
3594 @option{srst_only} and @option{trst_and_srst}.
3595
3596 @quotation Tip
3597 If your board provides SRST and/or TRST through the JTAG connector,
3598 you must declare that so those signals can be used.
3599 @end quotation
3600
3601 @item
3602 The @var{combination} is an optional value specifying broken reset
3603 signal implementations.
3604 The default behaviour if no option given is @option{separate},
3605 indicating everything behaves normally.
3606 @option{srst_pulls_trst} states that the
3607 test logic is reset together with the reset of the system (e.g. NXP
3608 LPC2000, "broken" board layout), @option{trst_pulls_srst} says that
3609 the system is reset together with the test logic (only hypothetical, I
3610 haven't seen hardware with such a bug, and can be worked around).
3611 @option{combined} implies both @option{srst_pulls_trst} and
3612 @option{trst_pulls_srst}.
3613
3614 @item
3615 The @var{gates} tokens control flags that describe some cases where
3616 JTAG may be unavailable during reset.
3617 @option{srst_gates_jtag} (default)
3618 indicates that asserting SRST gates the
3619 JTAG clock. This means that no communication can happen on JTAG
3620 while SRST is asserted.
3621 Its converse is @option{srst_nogate}, indicating that JTAG commands
3622 can safely be issued while SRST is active.
3623
3624 @item
3625 The @var{connect_type} tokens control flags that describe some cases where
3626 SRST is asserted while connecting to the target. @option{srst_nogate}
3627 is required to use this option.
3628 @option{connect_deassert_srst} (default)
3629 indicates that SRST will not be asserted while connecting to the target.
3630 Its converse is @option{connect_assert_srst}, indicating that SRST will
3631 be asserted before any target connection.
3632 Only some targets support this feature, STM32 and STR9 are examples.
3633 This feature is useful if you are unable to connect to your target due
3634 to incorrect options byte config or illegal program execution.
3635 @end itemize
3636
3637 The optional @var{trst_type} and @var{srst_type} parameters allow the
3638 driver mode of each reset line to be specified. These values only affect
3639 JTAG interfaces with support for different driver modes, like the Amontec
3640 JTAGkey and JTAG Accelerator. Also, they are necessarily ignored if the
3641 relevant signal (TRST or SRST) is not connected.
3642
3643 @itemize
3644 @item
3645 Possible @var{trst_type} driver modes for the test reset signal (TRST)
3646 are the default @option{trst_push_pull}, and @option{trst_open_drain}.
3647 Most boards connect this signal to a pulldown, so the JTAG TAPs
3648 never leave reset unless they are hooked up to a JTAG adapter.
3649
3650 @item
3651 Possible @var{srst_type} driver modes for the system reset signal (SRST)
3652 are the default @option{srst_open_drain}, and @option{srst_push_pull}.
3653 Most boards connect this signal to a pullup, and allow the
3654 signal to be pulled low by various events including system
3655 power-up and pressing a reset button.
3656 @end itemize
3657 @end deffn
3658
3659 @section Custom Reset Handling
3660 @cindex events
3661
3662 OpenOCD has several ways to help support the various reset
3663 mechanisms provided by chip and board vendors.
3664 The commands shown in the previous section give standard parameters.
3665 There are also @emph{event handlers} associated with TAPs or Targets.
3666 Those handlers are Tcl procedures you can provide, which are invoked
3667 at particular points in the reset sequence.
3668
3669 @emph{When SRST is not an option} you must set
3670 up a @code{reset-assert} event handler for your target.
3671 For example, some JTAG adapters don't include the SRST signal;
3672 and some boards have multiple targets, and you won't always
3673 want to reset everything at once.
3674
3675 After configuring those mechanisms, you might still
3676 find your board doesn't start up or reset correctly.
3677 For example, maybe it needs a slightly different sequence
3678 of SRST and/or TRST manipulations, because of quirks that
3679 the @command{reset_config} mechanism doesn't address;
3680 or asserting both might trigger a stronger reset, which
3681 needs special attention.
3682
3683 Experiment with lower level operations, such as
3684 @command{adapter assert}, @command{adapter deassert}
3685 and the @command{jtag arp_*} operations shown here,
3686 to find a sequence of operations that works.
3687 @xref{JTAG Commands}.
3688 When you find a working sequence, it can be used to override
3689 @command{jtag_init}, which fires during OpenOCD startup
3690 (@pxref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage});
3691 or @command{init_reset}, which fires during reset processing.
3692
3693 You might also want to provide some project-specific reset
3694 schemes. For example, on a multi-target board the standard
3695 @command{reset} command would reset all targets, but you
3696 may need the ability to reset only one target at time and
3697 thus want to avoid using the board-wide SRST signal.
3698
3699 @deffn {Overridable Procedure} init_reset mode
3700 This is invoked near the beginning of the @command{reset} command,
3701 usually to provide as much of a cold (power-up) reset as practical.
3702 By default it is also invoked from @command{jtag_init} if
3703 the scan chain does not respond to pure JTAG operations.
3704 The @var{mode} parameter is the parameter given to the
3705 low level reset command (@option{halt},
3706 @option{init}, or @option{run}), @option{setup},
3707 or potentially some other value.
3708
3709 The default implementation just invokes @command{jtag arp_init-reset}.
3710 Replacements will normally build on low level JTAG
3711 operations such as @command{adapter assert} and @command{adapter deassert}.
3712 Operations here must not address individual TAPs
3713 (or their associated targets)
3714 until the JTAG scan chain has first been verified to work.
3715
3716 Implementations must have verified the JTAG scan chain before
3717 they return.
3718 This is done by calling @command{jtag arp_init}
3719 (or @command{jtag arp_init-reset}).
3720 @end deffn
3721
3722 @deffn Command {jtag arp_init}
3723 This validates the scan chain using just the four
3724 standard JTAG signals (TMS, TCK, TDI, TDO).
3725 It starts by issuing a JTAG-only reset.
3726 Then it performs checks to verify that the scan chain configuration
3727 matches the TAPs it can observe.
3728 Those checks include checking IDCODE values for each active TAP,
3729 and verifying the length of their instruction registers using
3730 TAP @code{-ircapture} and @code{-irmask} values.
3731 If these tests all pass, TAP @code{setup} events are
3732 issued to all TAPs with handlers for that event.
3733 @end deffn
3734
3735 @deffn Command {jtag arp_init-reset}
3736 This uses TRST and SRST to try resetting
3737 everything on the JTAG scan chain
3738 (and anything else connected to SRST).
3739 It then invokes the logic of @command{jtag arp_init}.
3740 @end deffn
3741
3742
3743 @node TAP Declaration
3744 @chapter TAP Declaration
3745 @cindex TAP declaration
3746 @cindex TAP configuration
3747
3748 @emph{Test Access Ports} (TAPs) are the core of JTAG.
3749 TAPs serve many roles, including:
3750
3751 @itemize @bullet
3752 @item @b{Debug Target} A CPU TAP can be used as a GDB debug target.
3753 @item @b{Flash Programming} Some chips program the flash directly via JTAG.
3754 Others do it indirectly, making a CPU do it.
3755 @item @b{Program Download} Using the same CPU support GDB uses,
3756 you can initialize a DRAM controller, download code to DRAM, and then
3757 start running that code.
3758 @item @b{Boundary Scan} Most chips support boundary scan, which
3759 helps test for board assembly problems like solder bridges
3760 and missing connections.
3761 @end itemize
3762
3763 OpenOCD must know about the active TAPs on your board(s).
3764 Setting up the TAPs is the core task of your configuration files.
3765 Once those TAPs are set up, you can pass their names to code
3766 which sets up CPUs and exports them as GDB targets,
3767 probes flash memory, performs low-level JTAG operations, and more.
3768
3769 @section Scan Chains
3770 @cindex scan chain
3771
3772 TAPs are part of a hardware @dfn{scan chain},
3773 which is a daisy chain of TAPs.
3774 They also need to be added to
3775 OpenOCD's software mirror of that hardware list,
3776 giving each member a name and associating other data with it.
3777 Simple scan chains, with a single TAP, are common in
3778 systems with a single microcontroller or microprocessor.
3779 More complex chips may have several TAPs internally.
3780 Very complex scan chains might have a dozen or more TAPs:
3781 several in one chip, more in the next, and connecting
3782 to other boards with their own chips and TAPs.
3783
3784 You can display the list with the @command{scan_chain} command.
3785 (Don't confuse this with the list displayed by the @command{targets}
3786 command, presented in the next chapter.
3787 That only displays TAPs for CPUs which are configured as
3788 debugging targets.)
3789 Here's what the scan chain might look like for a chip more than one TAP:
3790
3791 @verbatim
3792 TapName Enabled IdCode Expected IrLen IrCap IrMask
3793 -- ------------------ ------- ---------- ---------- ----- ----- ------
3794 0 omap5912.dsp Y 0x03df1d81 0x03df1d81 38 0x01 0x03
3795 1 omap5912.arm Y 0x0692602f 0x0692602f 4 0x01 0x0f
3796 2 omap5912.unknown Y 0x00000000 0x00000000 8 0x01 0x03
3797 @end verbatim
3798
3799 OpenOCD can detect some of that information, but not all
3800 of it. @xref{autoprobing,,Autoprobing}.
3801 Unfortunately, those TAPs can't always be autoconfigured,
3802 because not all devices provide good support for that.
3803 JTAG doesn't require supporting IDCODE instructions, and
3804 chips with JTAG routers may not link TAPs into the chain
3805 until they are told to do so.
3806
3807 The configuration mechanism currently supported by OpenOCD
3808 requires explicit configuration of all TAP devices using
3809 @command{jtag newtap} commands, as detailed later in this chapter.
3810 A command like this would declare one tap and name it @code{chip1.cpu}:
3811
3812 @example
3813 jtag newtap chip1 cpu -irlen 4 -expected-id 0x3ba00477
3814 @end example
3815
3816 Each target configuration file lists the TAPs provided
3817 by a given chip.
3818 Board configuration files combine all the targets on a board,
3819 and so forth.
3820 Note that @emph{the order in which TAPs are declared is very important.}
3821 That declaration order must match the order in the JTAG scan chain,
3822 both inside a single chip and between them.
3823 @xref{faqtaporder,,FAQ TAP Order}.
3824
3825 For example, the STMicroelectronics STR912 chip has
3826 three separate TAPs@footnote{See the ST
3827 document titled: @emph{STR91xFAxxx, Section 3.15 Jtag Interface, Page:
3828 28/102, Figure 3: JTAG chaining inside the STR91xFA}.
3829 @url{http://eu.st.com/stonline/products/literature/ds/13495.pdf}}.
3830 To configure those taps, @file{target/str912.cfg}
3831 includes commands something like this:
3832
3833 @example
3834 jtag newtap str912 flash ... params ...
3835 jtag newtap str912 cpu ... params ...
3836 jtag newtap str912 bs ... params ...
3837 @end example
3838
3839 Actual config files typically use a variable such as @code{$_CHIPNAME}
3840 instead of literals like @option{str912}, to support more than one chip
3841 of each type. @xref{Config File Guidelines}.
3842
3843 @deffn Command {jtag names}
3844 Returns the names of all current TAPs in the scan chain.
3845 Use @command{jtag cget} or @command{jtag tapisenabled}
3846 to examine attributes and state of each TAP.
3847 @example
3848 foreach t [jtag names] @{
3849 puts [format "TAP: %s\n" $t]
3850 @}
3851 @end example
3852 @end deffn
3853
3854 @deffn Command {scan_chain}
3855 Displays the TAPs in the scan chain configuration,
3856 and their status.
3857 The set of TAPs listed by this command is fixed by
3858 exiting the OpenOCD configuration stage,
3859 but systems with a JTAG router can
3860 enable or disable TAPs dynamically.
3861 @end deffn
3862
3863 @c FIXME! "jtag cget" should be able to return all TAP
3864 @c attributes, like "$target_name cget" does for targets.
3865
3866 @c Probably want "jtag eventlist", and a "tap-reset" event
3867 @c (on entry to RESET state).
3868
3869 @section TAP Names
3870 @cindex dotted name
3871
3872 When TAP objects are declared with @command{jtag newtap},
3873 a @dfn{dotted.name} is created for the TAP, combining the
3874 name of a module (usually a chip) and a label for the TAP.
3875 For example: @code{xilinx.tap}, @code{str912.flash},
3876 @code{omap3530.jrc}, @code{dm6446.dsp}, or @code{stm32.cpu}.
3877 Many other commands use that dotted.name to manipulate or
3878 refer to the TAP. For example, CPU configuration uses the
3879 name, as does declaration of NAND or NOR flash banks.
3880
3881 The components of a dotted name should follow ``C'' symbol
3882 name rules: start with an alphabetic character, then numbers
3883 and underscores are OK; while others (including dots!) are not.
3884
3885 @section TAP Declaration Commands
3886
3887 @c shouldn't this be(come) a {Config Command}?
3888 @deffn Command {jtag newtap} chipname tapname configparams...
3889 Declares a new TAP with the dotted name @var{chipname}.@var{tapname},
3890 and configured according to the various @var{configparams}.
3891
3892 The @var{chipname} is a symbolic name for the chip.
3893 Conventionally target config files use @code{$_CHIPNAME},
3894 defaulting to the model name given by the chip vendor but
3895 overridable.
3896
3897 @cindex TAP naming convention
3898 The @var{tapname} reflects the role of that TAP,
3899 and should follow this convention:
3900
3901 @itemize @bullet
3902 @item @code{bs} -- For boundary scan if this is a separate TAP;
3903 @item @code{cpu} -- The main CPU of the chip, alternatively
3904 @code{arm} and @code{dsp} on chips with both ARM and DSP CPUs,
3905 @code{arm1} and @code{arm2} on chips with two ARMs, and so forth;
3906 @item @code{etb} -- For an embedded trace buffer (example: an ARM ETB11);
3907 @item @code{flash} -- If the chip has a flash TAP, like the str912;
3908 @item @code{jrc} -- For JTAG route controller (example: the ICEPick modules
3909 on many Texas Instruments chips, like the OMAP3530 on Beagleboards);
3910 @item @code{tap} -- Should be used only for FPGA- or CPLD-like devices
3911 with a single TAP;
3912 @item @code{unknownN} -- If you have no idea what the TAP is for (N is a number);
3913 @item @emph{when in doubt} -- Use the chip maker's name in their data sheet.
3914 For example, the Freescale i.MX31 has a SDMA (Smart DMA) with
3915 a JTAG TAP; that TAP should be named @code{sdma}.
3916 @end itemize
3917
3918 Every TAP requires at least the following @var{configparams}:
3919
3920 @itemize @bullet
3921 @item @code{-irlen} @var{NUMBER}
3922 @*The length in bits of the
3923 instruction register, such as 4 or 5 bits.
3924 @end itemize
3925
3926 A TAP may also provide optional @var{configparams}:
3927
3928 @itemize @bullet
3929 @item @code{-disable} (or @code{-enable})
3930 @*Use the @code{-disable} parameter to flag a TAP which is not
3931 linked into the scan chain after a reset using either TRST
3932 or the JTAG state machine's @sc{reset} state.
3933 You may use @code{-enable} to highlight the default state
3934 (the TAP is linked in).
3935 @xref{enablinganddisablingtaps,,Enabling and Disabling TAPs}.
3936 @item @code{-expected-id} @var{NUMBER}
3937 @*A non-zero @var{number} represents a 32-bit IDCODE
3938 which you expect to find when the scan chain is examined.
3939 These codes are not required by all JTAG devices.
3940 @emph{Repeat the option} as many times as required if more than one
3941 ID code could appear (for example, multiple versions).
3942 Specify @var{number} as zero to suppress warnings about IDCODE
3943 values that were found but not included in the list.
3944
3945 Provide this value if at all possible, since it lets OpenOCD
3946 tell when the scan chain it sees isn't right. These values
3947 are provided in vendors' chip documentation, usually a technical
3948 reference manual. Sometimes you may need to probe the JTAG
3949 hardware to find these values.
3950 @xref{autoprobing,,Autoprobing}.
3951 @item @code{-ignore-version}
3952 @*Specify this to ignore the JTAG version field in the @code{-expected-id}
3953 option. When vendors put out multiple versions of a chip, or use the same
3954 JTAG-level ID for several largely-compatible chips, it may be more practical
3955 to ignore the version field than to update config files to handle all of
3956 the various chip IDs. The version field is defined as bit 28-31 of the IDCODE.
3957 @item @code{-ircapture} @var{NUMBER}
3958 @*The bit pattern loaded by the TAP into the JTAG shift register
3959 on entry to the @sc{ircapture} state, such as 0x01.
3960 JTAG requires the two LSBs of this value to be 01.
3961 By default, @code{-ircapture} and @code{-irmask} are set
3962 up to verify that two-bit value. You may provide
3963 additional bits if you know them, or indicate that
3964 a TAP doesn't conform to the JTAG specification.
3965 @item @code{-irmask} @var{NUMBER}
3966 @*A mask used with @code{-ircapture}
3967 to verify that instruction scans work correctly.
3968 Such scans are not used by OpenOCD except to verify that
3969 there seems to be no problems with JTAG scan chain operations.
3970 @item @code{-ignore-syspwrupack}
3971 @*Specify this to ignore the CSYSPWRUPACK bit in the ARM DAP DP CTRL/STAT
3972 register during initial examination and when checking the sticky error bit.
3973 This bit is normally checked after setting the CSYSPWRUPREQ bit, but some
3974 devices do not set the ack bit until sometime later.
3975 @end itemize
3976 @end deffn
3977
3978 @section Other TAP commands
3979
3980 @deffn Command {jtag cget} dotted.name @option{-idcode}
3981 Get the value of the IDCODE found in hardware.
3982 @end deffn
3983
3984 @deffn Command {jtag cget} dotted.name @option{-event} event_name
3985 @deffnx Command {jtag configure} dotted.name @option{-event} event_name handler
3986 At this writing this TAP attribute
3987 mechanism is limited and used mostly for event handling.
3988 (It is not a direct analogue of the @code{cget}/@code{configure}
3989 mechanism for debugger targets.)
3990 See the next section for information about the available events.
3991
3992 The @code{configure} subcommand assigns an event handler,
3993 a TCL string which is evaluated when the event is triggered.
3994 The @code{cget} subcommand returns that handler.
3995 @end deffn
3996
3997 @section TAP Events
3998 @cindex events
3999 @cindex TAP events
4000
4001 OpenOCD includes two event mechanisms.
4002 The one presented here applies to all JTAG TAPs.
4003 The other applies to debugger targets,
4004 which are associated with certain TAPs.
4005
4006 The TAP events currently defined are:
4007
4008 @itemize @bullet
4009 @item @b{post-reset}
4010 @* The TAP has just completed a JTAG reset.
4011 The tap may still be in the JTAG @sc{reset} state.
4012 Handlers for these events might perform initialization sequences
4013 such as issuing TCK cycles, TMS sequences to ensure
4014 exit from the ARM SWD mode, and more.
4015
4016 Because the scan chain has not yet been verified, handlers for these events
4017 @emph{should not issue commands which scan the JTAG IR or DR registers}
4018 of any particular target.
4019 @b{NOTE:} As this is written (September 2009), nothing prevents such access.
4020 @item @b{setup}
4021 @* The scan chain has been reset and verified.
4022 This handler may enable TAPs as needed.
4023 @item @b{tap-disable}
4024 @* The TAP needs to be disabled. This handler should
4025 implement @command{jtag tapdisable}
4026 by issuing the relevant JTAG commands.
4027 @item @b{tap-enable}
4028 @* The TAP needs to be enabled. This handler should
4029 implement @command{jtag tapenable}
4030 by issuing the relevant JTAG commands.
4031 @end itemize
4032
4033 If you need some action after each JTAG reset which isn't actually
4034 specific to any TAP (since you can't yet trust the scan chain's
4035 contents to be accurate), you might:
4036
4037 @example
4038 jtag configure CHIP.jrc -event post-reset @{
4039 echo "JTAG Reset done"
4040 ... non-scan jtag operations to be done after reset
4041 @}
4042 @end example
4043
4044
4045 @anchor{enablinganddisablingtaps}
4046 @section Enabling and Disabling TAPs
4047 @cindex JTAG Route Controller
4048 @cindex jrc
4049
4050 In some systems, a @dfn{JTAG Route Controller} (JRC)
4051 is used to enable and/or disable specific JTAG TAPs.
4052 Many ARM-based chips from Texas Instruments include
4053 an ``ICEPick'' module, which is a JRC.
4054 Such chips include DaVinci and OMAP3 processors.
4055
4056 A given TAP may not be visible until the JRC has been
4057 told to link it into the scan chain; and if the JRC
4058 has been told to unlink that TAP, it will no longer
4059 be visible.
4060 Such routers address problems that JTAG ``bypass mode''
4061 ignores, such as:
4062
4063 @itemize
4064 @item The scan chain can only go as fast as its slowest TAP.
4065 @item Having many TAPs slows instruction scans, since all
4066 TAPs receive new instructions.
4067 @item TAPs in the scan chain must be powered up, which wastes
4068 power and prevents debugging some power management mechanisms.
4069 @end itemize
4070
4071 The IEEE 1149.1 JTAG standard has no concept of a ``disabled'' tap,
4072 as implied by the existence of JTAG routers.
4073 However, the upcoming IEEE 1149.7 framework (layered on top of JTAG)
4074 does include a kind of JTAG router functionality.
4075
4076 @c (a) currently the event handlers don't seem to be able to
4077 @c fail in a way that could lead to no-change-of-state.
4078
4079 In OpenOCD, tap enabling/disabling is invoked by the Tcl commands
4080 shown below, and is implemented using TAP event handlers.
4081 So for example, when defining a TAP for a CPU connected to
4082 a JTAG router, your @file{target.cfg} file
4083 should define TAP event handlers using
4084 code that looks something like this:
4085
4086 @example
4087 jtag configure CHIP.cpu -event tap-enable @{
4088 ... jtag operations using CHIP.jrc
4089 @}
4090 jtag configure CHIP.cpu -event tap-disable @{
4091 ... jtag operations using CHIP.jrc
4092 @}
4093 @end example
4094
4095 Then you might want that CPU's TAP enabled almost all the time:
4096
4097 @example
4098 jtag configure $CHIP.jrc -event setup "jtag tapenable $CHIP.cpu"
4099 @end example
4100
4101 Note how that particular setup event handler declaration
4102 uses quotes to evaluate @code{$CHIP} when the event is configured.
4103 Using brackets @{ @} would cause it to be evaluated later,
4104 at runtime, when it might have a different value.
4105
4106 @deffn Command {jtag tapdisable} dotted.name
4107 If necessary, disables the tap
4108 by sending it a @option{tap-disable} event.
4109 Returns the string "1" if the tap
4110 specified by @var{dotted.name} is enabled,
4111 and "0" if it is disabled.
4112 @end deffn
4113
4114 @deffn Command {jtag tapenable} dotted.name
4115 If necessary, enables the tap
4116 by sending it a @option{tap-enable} event.
4117 Returns the string "1" if the tap
4118 specified by @var{dotted.name} is enabled,
4119 and "0" if it is disabled.
4120 @end deffn
4121
4122 @deffn Command {jtag tapisenabled} dotted.name
4123 Returns the string "1" if the tap
4124 specified by @var{dotted.name} is enabled,
4125 and "0" if it is disabled.
4126
4127 @quotation Note
4128 Humans will find the @command{scan_chain} command more helpful
4129 for querying the state of the JTAG taps.
4130 @end quotation
4131 @end deffn
4132
4133 @anchor{autoprobing}
4134 @section Autoprobing
4135 @cindex autoprobe
4136 @cindex JTAG autoprobe
4137
4138 TAP configuration is the first thing that needs to be done
4139 after interface and reset configuration. Sometimes it's
4140 hard finding out what TAPs exist, or how they are identified.
4141 Vendor documentation is not always easy to find and use.
4142
4143 To help you get past such problems, OpenOCD has a limited
4144 @emph{autoprobing} ability to look at the scan chain, doing
4145 a @dfn{blind interrogation} and then reporting the TAPs it finds.
4146 To use this mechanism, start the OpenOCD server with only data
4147 that configures your JTAG interface, and arranges to come up
4148 with a slow clock (many devices don't support fast JTAG clocks
4149 right when they come out of reset).
4150
4151 For example, your @file{openocd.cfg} file might have:
4152
4153 @example
4154 source [find interface/olimex-arm-usb-tiny-h.cfg]
4155 reset_config trst_and_srst
4156 jtag_rclk 8
4157 @end example
4158
4159 When you start the server without any TAPs configured, it will
4160 attempt to autoconfigure the TAPs. There are two parts to this:
4161
4162 @enumerate
4163 @item @emph{TAP discovery} ...
4164 After a JTAG reset (sometimes a system reset may be needed too),
4165 each TAP's data registers will hold the contents of either the
4166 IDCODE or BYPASS register.
4167 If JTAG communication is working, OpenOCD will see each TAP,
4168 and report what @option{-expected-id} to use with it.
4169 @item @emph{IR Length discovery} ...
4170 Unfortunately JTAG does not provide a reliable way to find out
4171 the value of the @option{-irlen} parameter to use with a TAP
4172 that is discovered.
4173 If OpenOCD can discover the length of a TAP's instruction
4174 register, it will report it.
4175 Otherwise you may need to consult vendor documentation, such
4176 as chip data sheets or BSDL files.
4177 @end enumerate
4178
4179 In many cases your board will have a simple scan chain with just
4180 a single device. Here's what OpenOCD reported with one board
4181 that's a bit more complex:
4182
4183 @example
4184 clock speed 8 kHz
4185 There are no enabled taps. AUTO PROBING MIGHT NOT WORK!!
4186 AUTO auto0.tap - use "jtag newtap auto0 tap -expected-id 0x2b900f0f ..."
4187 AUTO auto1.tap - use "jtag newtap auto1 tap -expected-id 0x07926001 ..."
4188 AUTO auto2.tap - use "jtag newtap auto2 tap -expected-id 0x0b73b02f ..."
4189 AUTO auto0.tap - use "... -irlen 4"
4190 AUTO auto1.tap - use "... -irlen 4"
4191 AUTO auto2.tap - use "... -irlen 6"
4192 no gdb ports allocated as no target has been specified
4193 @end example
4194
4195 Given that information, you should be able to either find some existing
4196 config files to use, or create your own. If you create your own, you
4197 would configure from the bottom up: first a @file{target.cfg} file
4198 with these TAPs, any targets associated with them, and any on-chip
4199 resources; then a @file{board.cfg} with off-chip resources, clocking,
4200 and so forth.
4201
4202 @anchor{dapdeclaration}
4203 @section DAP declaration (ARMv6-M, ARMv7 and ARMv8 targets)
4204 @cindex DAP declaration
4205
4206 Since OpenOCD version 0.11.0, the Debug Access Port (DAP) is
4207 no longer implicitly created together with the target. It must be
4208 explicitly declared using the @command{dap create} command. For all ARMv6-M, ARMv7
4209 and ARMv8 targets, the option "@option{-dap} @var{dap_name}" has to be used
4210 instead of "@option{-chain-position} @var{dotted.name}" when the target is created.
4211
4212 The @command{dap} command group supports the following sub-commands:
4213
4214 @deffn Command {dap create} dap_name @option{-chain-position} dotted.name configparams...
4215 Declare a DAP instance named @var{dap_name} linked to the JTAG tap
4216 @var{dotted.name}. This also creates a new command (@command{dap_name})
4217 which is used for various purposes including additional configuration.
4218 There can only be one DAP for each JTAG tap in the system.
4219
4220 A DAP may also provide optional @var{configparams}:
4221
4222 @itemize @bullet
4223 @item @code{-ignore-syspwrupack}
4224 @*Specify this to ignore the CSYSPWRUPACK bit in the ARM DAP DP CTRL/STAT
4225 register during initial examination and when checking the sticky error bit.
4226 This bit is normally checked after setting the CSYSPWRUPREQ bit, but some
4227 devices do not set the ack bit until sometime later.
4228 @end itemize
4229 @end deffn
4230
4231 @deffn Command {dap names}
4232 This command returns a list of all registered DAP objects. It it useful mainly
4233 for TCL scripting.
4234 @end deffn
4235
4236 @deffn Command {dap info} [num]
4237 Displays the ROM table for MEM-AP @var{num},
4238 defaulting to the currently selected AP of the currently selected target.
4239 @end deffn
4240
4241 @deffn Command {dap init}
4242 Initialize all registered DAPs. This command is used internally
4243 during initialization. It can be issued at any time after the
4244 initialization, too.
4245 @end deffn
4246
4247 The following commands exist as subcommands of DAP instances:
4248
4249 @deffn Command {$dap_name info} [num]
4250 Displays the ROM table for MEM-AP @var{num},
4251 defaulting to the currently selected AP.
4252 @end deffn
4253
4254 @deffn Command {$dap_name apid} [num]
4255 Displays ID register from AP @var{num}, defaulting to the currently selected AP.
4256 @end deffn
4257
4258 @anchor{DAP subcommand apreg}
4259 @deffn Command {$dap_name apreg} ap_num reg [value]
4260 Displays content of a register @var{reg} from AP @var{ap_num}
4261 or set a new value @var{value}.
4262 @var{reg} is byte address of a word register, 0, 4, 8 ... 0xfc.
4263 @end deffn
4264
4265 @deffn Command {$dap_name apsel} [num]
4266 Select AP @var{num}, defaulting to 0.
4267 @end deffn
4268
4269 @deffn Command {$dap_name dpreg} reg [value]
4270 Displays the content of DP register at address @var{reg}, or set it to a new
4271 value @var{value}.
4272
4273 In case of SWD, @var{reg} is a value in packed format
4274 @math{dpbanksel << 4 | addr} and assumes values 0, 4, 8 ... 0xfc.
4275 In case of JTAG it only assumes values 0, 4, 8 and 0xc.
4276
4277 @emph{Note:} Consider using @command{poll off} to avoid any disturbing
4278 background activity by OpenOCD while you are operating at such low-level.
4279 @end deffn
4280
4281 @deffn Command {$dap_name baseaddr} [num]
4282 Displays debug base address from MEM-AP @var{num},
4283 defaulting to the currently selected AP.
4284 @end deffn
4285
4286 @deffn Command {$dap_name memaccess} [value]
4287 Displays the number of extra tck cycles in the JTAG idle to use for MEM-AP
4288 memory bus access [0-255], giving additional time to respond to reads.
4289 If @var{value} is defined, first assigns that.
4290 @end deffn
4291
4292 @deffn Command {$dap_name apcsw} [value [mask]]
4293 Displays or changes CSW bit pattern for MEM-AP transfers.
4294
4295 At the begin of each memory access the CSW pattern is extended (bitwise or-ed)
4296 by @dfn{Size} and @dfn{AddrInc} bit-fields according to transfer requirements
4297 and the result is written to the real CSW register. All bits except dynamically
4298 updated fields @dfn{Size} and @dfn{AddrInc} can be changed by changing
4299 the CSW pattern. Refer to ARM ADI v5 manual chapter 7.6.4 and appendix A
4300 for details.
4301
4302 Use @var{value} only syntax if you want to set the new CSW pattern as a whole.
4303 The example sets HPROT1 bit (required by Cortex-M) and clears the rest of
4304 the pattern:
4305 @example
4306 kx.dap apcsw 0x2000000
4307 @end example
4308
4309 If @var{mask} is also used, the CSW pattern is changed only on bit positions
4310 where the mask bit is 1. The following example sets HPROT3 (cacheable)
4311 and leaves the rest of the pattern intact. It configures memory access through
4312 DCache on Cortex-M7.
4313 @example
4314 set CSW_HPROT3_CACHEABLE [expr 1 << 27]
4315 samv.dap apcsw $CSW_HPROT3_CACHEABLE $CSW_HPROT3_CACHEABLE
4316 @end example
4317
4318 Another example clears SPROT bit and leaves the rest of pattern intact:
4319 @example
4320 set CSW_SPROT [expr 1 << 30]
4321 samv.dap apcsw 0 $CSW_SPROT
4322 @end example
4323
4324 @emph{Note:} If you want to check the real value of CSW, not CSW pattern, use
4325 @code{xxx.dap apreg 0}. @xref{DAP subcommand apreg,,}.
4326
4327 @emph{Warning:} Some of the CSW bits are vital for working memory transfer.
4328 If you set a wrong CSW pattern and MEM-AP stopped working, use the following
4329 example with a proper dap name:
4330 @example
4331 xxx.dap apcsw default
4332 @end example
4333 @end deffn
4334
4335 @deffn Command {$dap_name ti_be_32_quirks} [@option{enable}]
4336 Set/get quirks mode for TI TMS450/TMS570 processors
4337 Disabled by default
4338 @end deffn
4339
4340
4341 @node CPU Configuration
4342 @chapter CPU Configuration
4343 @cindex GDB target
4344
4345 This chapter discusses how to set up GDB debug targets for CPUs.
4346 You can also access these targets without GDB
4347 (@pxref{Architecture and Core Commands},
4348 and @ref{targetstatehandling,,Target State handling}) and
4349 through various kinds of NAND and NOR flash commands.
4350 If you have multiple CPUs you can have multiple such targets.
4351
4352 We'll start by looking at how to examine the targets you have,
4353 then look at how to add one more target and how to configure it.
4354
4355 @section Target List
4356 @cindex target, current
4357 @cindex target, list
4358
4359 All targets that have been set up are part of a list,
4360 where each member has a name.
4361 That name should normally be the same as the TAP name.
4362 You can display the list with the @command{targets}
4363 (plural!) command.
4364 This display often has only one CPU; here's what it might
4365 look like with more than one:
4366 @verbatim
4367 TargetName Type Endian TapName State
4368 -- ------------------ ---------- ------ ------------------ ------------
4369 0* at91rm9200.cpu arm920t little at91rm9200.cpu running
4370 1 MyTarget cortex_m little mychip.foo tap-disabled
4371 @end verbatim
4372
4373 One member of that list is the @dfn{current target}, which
4374 is implicitly referenced by many commands.
4375 It's the one marked with a @code{*} near the target name.
4376 In particular, memory addresses often refer to the address
4377 space seen by that current target.
4378 Commands like @command{mdw} (memory display words)
4379 and @command{flash erase_address} (erase NOR flash blocks)
4380 are examples; and there are many more.
4381
4382 Several commands let you examine the list of targets:
4383
4384 @deffn Command {target current}
4385 Returns the name of the current target.
4386 @end deffn
4387
4388 @deffn Command {target names}
4389 Lists the names of all current targets in the list.
4390 @example
4391 foreach t [target names] @{
4392 puts [format "Target: %s\n" $t]
4393 @}
4394 @end example
4395 @end deffn
4396
4397 @c yep, "target list" would have been better.
4398 @c plus maybe "target setdefault".
4399
4400 @deffn Command targets [name]
4401 @emph{Note: the name of this command is plural. Other target
4402 command names are singular.}
4403
4404 With no parameter, this command displays a table of all known
4405 targets in a user friendly form.
4406
4407 With a parameter, this command sets the current target to
4408 the given target with the given @var{name}; this is
4409 only relevant on boards which have more than one target.
4410 @end deffn
4411
4412 @section Target CPU Types
4413 @cindex target type
4414 @cindex CPU type
4415
4416 Each target has a @dfn{CPU type}, as shown in the output of
4417 the @command{targets} command. You need to specify that type
4418 when calling @command{target create}.
4419 The CPU type indicates more than just the instruction set.
4420 It also indicates how that instruction set is implemented,
4421 what kind of debug support it integrates,
4422 whether it has an MMU (and if so, what kind),
4423 what core-specific commands may be available
4424 (@pxref{Architecture and Core Commands}),
4425 and more.
4426
4427 It's easy to see what target types are supported,
4428 since there's a command to list them.
4429
4430 @anchor{targettypes}
4431 @deffn Command {target types}
4432 Lists all supported target types.
4433 At this writing, the supported CPU types are:
4434
4435 @itemize @bullet
4436 @item @code{aarch64} -- this is an ARMv8-A core with an MMU.
4437 @item @code{arm11} -- this is a generation of ARMv6 cores.
4438 @item @code{arm720t} -- this is an ARMv4 core with an MMU.
4439 @item @code{arm7tdmi} -- this is an ARMv4 core.
4440 @item @code{arm920t} -- this is an ARMv4 core with an MMU.
4441 @item @code{arm926ejs} -- this is an ARMv5 core with an MMU.
4442 @item @code{arm946e} -- this is an ARMv5 core with an MMU.
4443 @item @code{arm966e} -- this is an ARMv5 core.
4444 @item @code{arm9tdmi} -- this is an ARMv4 core.
4445 @item @code{avr} -- implements Atmel's 8-bit AVR instruction set.
4446 (Support for this is preliminary and incomplete.)
4447 @item @code{avr32_ap7k} -- this an AVR32 core.
4448 @item @code{cortex_a} -- this is an ARMv7-A core with an MMU.
4449 @item @code{cortex_m} -- this is an ARMv7-M core, supporting only the
4450 compact Thumb2 instruction set. Supports also ARMv6-M and ARMv8-M cores
4451 @item @code{cortex_r4} -- this is an ARMv7-R core.
4452 @item @code{dragonite} -- resembles arm966e.
4453 @item @code{dsp563xx} -- implements Freescale's 24-bit DSP.
4454 (Support for this is still incomplete.)
4455 @item @code{dsp5680xx} -- implements Freescale's 5680x DSP.
4456 @item @code{esirisc} -- this is an EnSilica eSi-RISC core.
4457 The current implementation supports eSi-32xx cores.
4458 @item @code{fa526} -- resembles arm920 (w/o Thumb).
4459 @item @code{feroceon} -- resembles arm926.
4460 @item @code{hla_target} -- a Cortex-M alternative to work with HL adapters like ST-Link.
4461 @item @code{ls1_sap} -- this is the SAP on NXP LS102x CPUs,
4462 allowing access to physical memory addresses independently of CPU cores.
4463 @item @code{mem_ap} -- this is an ARM debug infrastructure Access Port without a CPU, through which bus read and write cycles can be generated; it may be useful for working with non-CPU hardware behind an AP or during development of support for new CPUs.
4464 @item @code{mips_m4k} -- a MIPS core.
4465 @item @code{mips_mips64} -- a MIPS64 core.
4466 @item @code{nds32_v2} -- this is an Andes NDS32 v2 core.
4467 @item @code{nds32_v3} -- this is an Andes NDS32 v3 core.
4468 @item @code{nds32_v3m} -- this is an Andes NDS32 v3m core.
4469 @item @code{or1k} -- this is an OpenRISC 1000 core.
4470 The current implementation supports three JTAG TAP cores:
4471 @itemize @minus
4472 @item @code{OpenCores TAP} (See: @url{http://opencores.org/project@comma{}jtag})
4473 @item @code{Altera Virtual JTAG TAP} (See: @url{http://www.altera.com/literature/ug/ug_virtualjtag.pdf})
4474 @item @code{Xilinx BSCAN_* virtual JTAG interface} (See: @url{http://www.xilinx.com/support/documentation/sw_manuals/xilinx14_2/spartan6_hdl.pdf})
4475 @end itemize
4476 And two debug interfaces cores:
4477 @itemize @minus
4478 @item @code{Advanced debug interface} (See: @url{http://opencores.org/project@comma{}adv_debug_sys})
4479 @item @code{SoC Debug Interface} (See: @url{http://opencores.org/project@comma{}dbg_interface})
4480 @end itemize
4481 @item @code{quark_d20xx} -- an Intel Quark D20xx core.
4482 @item @code{quark_x10xx} -- an Intel Quark X10xx core.
4483 @item @code{riscv} -- a RISC-V core.
4484 @item @code{stm8} -- implements an STM8 core.
4485 @item @code{testee} -- a dummy target for cases without a real CPU, e.g. CPLD.
4486 @item @code{xscale} -- this is actually an architecture,
4487 not a CPU type. It is based on the ARMv5 architecture.
4488 @end itemize
4489 @end deffn
4490
4491 To avoid being confused by the variety of ARM based cores, remember
4492 this key point: @emph{ARM is a technology licencing company}.
4493 (See: @url{http://www.arm.com}.)
4494 The CPU name used by OpenOCD will reflect the CPU design that was
4495 licensed, not a vendor brand which incorporates that design.
4496 Name prefixes like arm7, arm9, arm11, and cortex
4497 reflect design generations;
4498 while names like ARMv4, ARMv5, ARMv6, ARMv7 and ARMv8
4499 reflect an architecture version implemented by a CPU design.
4500
4501 @anchor{targetconfiguration}
4502 @section Target Configuration
4503
4504 Before creating a ``target'', you must have added its TAP to the scan chain.
4505 When you've added that TAP, you will have a @code{dotted.name}
4506 which is used to set up the CPU support.
4507 The chip-specific configuration file will normally configure its CPU(s)
4508 right after it adds all of the chip's TAPs to the scan chain.
4509
4510 Although you can set up a target in one step, it's often clearer if you
4511 use shorter commands and do it in two steps: create it, then configure
4512 optional parts.
4513 All operations on the target after it's created will use a new
4514 command, created as part of target creation.
4515
4516 The two main things to configure after target creation are
4517 a work area, which usually has target-specific defaults even
4518 if the board setup code overrides them later;
4519 and event handlers (@pxref{targetevents,,Target Events}), which tend
4520 to be much more board-specific.
4521 The key steps you use might look something like this
4522
4523 @example
4524 dap create mychip.dap -chain-position mychip.cpu
4525 target create MyTarget cortex_m -dap mychip.dap
4526 MyTarget configure -work-area-phys 0x08000 -work-area-size 8096
4527 MyTarget configure -event reset-deassert-pre @{ jtag_rclk 5 @}
4528 MyTarget configure -event reset-init @{ myboard_reinit @}
4529 @end example
4530
4531 You should specify a working area if you can; typically it uses some
4532 on-chip SRAM.
4533 Such a working area can speed up many things, including bulk
4534 writes to target memory;
4535 flash operations like checking to see if memory needs to be erased;
4536 GDB memory checksumming;
4537 and more.
4538
4539 @quotation Warning
4540 On more complex chips, the work area can become
4541 inaccessible when application code
4542 (such as an operating system)
4543 enables or disables the MMU.
4544 For example, the particular MMU context used to access the virtual
4545 address will probably matter ... and that context might not have
4546 easy access to other addresses needed.
4547 At this writing, OpenOCD doesn't have much MMU intelligence.
4548 @end quotation
4549
4550 It's often very useful to define a @code{reset-init} event handler.
4551 For systems that are normally used with a boot loader,
4552 common tasks include updating clocks and initializing memory
4553 controllers.
4554 That may be needed to let you write the boot loader into flash,
4555 in order to ``de-brick'' your board; or to load programs into
4556 external DDR memory without having run the boot loader.
4557
4558 @deffn Command {target create} target_name type configparams...
4559 This command creates a GDB debug target that refers to a specific JTAG tap.
4560 It enters that target into a list, and creates a new
4561 command (@command{@var{target_name}}) which is used for various
4562 purposes including additional configuration.
4563
4564 @itemize @bullet
4565 @item @var{target_name} ... is the name of the debug target.
4566 By convention this should be the same as the @emph{dotted.name}
4567 of the TAP associated with this target, which must be specified here
4568 using the @code{-chain-position @var{dotted.name}} configparam.
4569
4570 This name is also used to create the target object command,
4571 referred to here as @command{$target_name},
4572 and in other places the target needs to be identified.
4573 @item @var{type} ... specifies the target type. @xref{targettypes,,target types}.
4574 @item @var{configparams} ... all parameters accepted by
4575 @command{$target_name configure} are permitted.
4576 If the target is big-endian, set it here with @code{-endian big}.
4577
4578 You @emph{must} set the @code{-chain-position @var{dotted.name}} or
4579 @code{-dap @var{dap_name}} here.
4580 @end itemize
4581 @end deffn
4582
4583 @deffn Command {$target_name configure} configparams...
4584 The options accepted by this command may also be
4585 specified as parameters to @command{target create}.
4586 Their values can later be queried one at a time by
4587 using the @command{$target_name cget} command.
4588
4589 @emph{Warning:} changing some of these after setup is dangerous.
4590 For example, moving a target from one TAP to another;
4591 and changing its endianness.
4592
4593 @itemize @bullet
4594
4595 @item @code{-chain-position} @var{dotted.name} -- names the TAP
4596 used to access this target.
4597
4598 @item @code{-dap} @var{dap_name} -- names the DAP used to access
4599 this target. @xref{dapdeclaration,,DAP declaration}, on how to
4600 create and manage DAP instances.
4601
4602 @item @code{-endian} (@option{big}|@option{little}) -- specifies
4603 whether the CPU uses big or little endian conventions
4604
4605 @item @code{-event} @var{event_name} @var{event_body} --
4606 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
4607 Note that this updates a list of named event handlers.
4608 Calling this twice with two different event names assigns
4609 two different handlers, but calling it twice with the
4610 same event name assigns only one handler.
4611
4612 Current target is temporarily overridden to the event issuing target
4613 before handler code starts and switched back after handler is done.
4614
4615 @item @code{-work-area-backup} (@option{0}|@option{1}) -- says
4616 whether the work area gets backed up; by default,
4617 @emph{it is not backed up.}
4618 When possible, use a working_area that doesn't need to be backed up,
4619 since performing a backup slows down operations.
4620 For example, the beginning of an SRAM block is likely to
4621 be used by most build systems, but the end is often unused.
4622
4623 @item @code{-work-area-size} @var{size} -- specify work are size,
4624 in bytes. The same size applies regardless of whether its physical
4625 or virtual address is being used.
4626
4627 @item @code{-work-area-phys} @var{address} -- set the work area
4628 base @var{address} to be used when no MMU is active.
4629
4630 @item @code{-work-area-virt} @var{address} -- set the work area
4631 base @var{address} to be used when an MMU is active.
4632 @emph{Do not specify a value for this except on targets with an MMU.}
4633 The value should normally correspond to a static mapping for the
4634 @code{-work-area-phys} address, set up by the current operating system.
4635
4636 @anchor{rtostype}
4637 @item @code{-rtos} @var{rtos_type} -- enable rtos support for target,
4638 @var{rtos_type} can be one of @option{auto}, @option{eCos},
4639 @option{ThreadX}, @option{FreeRTOS}, @option{linux}, @option{ChibiOS},
4640 @option{embKernel}, @option{mqx}, @option{uCOS-III}, @option{nuttx},
4641 @option{RIOT}
4642 @xref{gdbrtossupport,,RTOS Support}.
4643
4644 @item @code{-defer-examine} -- skip target examination at initial JTAG chain
4645 scan and after a reset. A manual call to arp_examine is required to
4646 access the target for debugging.
4647
4648 @item @code{-ap-num} @var{ap_number} -- set DAP access port for target,
4649 @var{ap_number} is the numeric index of the DAP AP the target is connected to.
4650 Use this option with systems where multiple, independent cores are connected
4651 to separate access ports of the same DAP.
4652
4653 @item @code{-cti} @var{cti_name} -- set Cross-Trigger Interface (CTI) connected
4654 to the target. Currently, only the @code{aarch64} target makes use of this option,
4655 where it is a mandatory configuration for the target run control.
4656 @xref{armcrosstrigger,,ARM Cross-Trigger Interface},
4657 for instruction on how to declare and control a CTI instance.
4658
4659 @anchor{gdbportoverride}
4660 @item @code{-gdb-port} @var{number} -- see command @command{gdb_port} for the
4661 possible values of the parameter @var{number}, which are not only numeric values.
4662 Use this option to override, for this target only, the global parameter set with
4663 command @command{gdb_port}.
4664 @xref{gdb_port,,command gdb_port}.
4665 @end itemize
4666 @end deffn
4667
4668 @section Other $target_name Commands
4669 @cindex object command
4670
4671 The Tcl/Tk language has the concept of object commands,
4672 and OpenOCD adopts that same model for targets.
4673
4674 A good Tk example is a on screen button.
4675 Once a button is created a button
4676 has a name (a path in Tk terms) and that name is useable as a first
4677 class command. For example in Tk, one can create a button and later
4678 configure it like this:
4679
4680 @example
4681 # Create
4682 button .foobar -background red -command @{ foo @}
4683 # Modify
4684 .foobar configure -foreground blue
4685 # Query
4686 set x [.foobar cget -background]
4687 # Report
4688 puts [format "The button is %s" $x]
4689 @end example
4690
4691 In OpenOCD's terms, the ``target'' is an object just like a Tcl/Tk
4692 button, and its object commands are invoked the same way.
4693
4694 @example
4695 str912.cpu mww 0x1234 0x42
4696 omap3530.cpu mww 0x5555 123
4697 @end example
4698
4699 The commands supported by OpenOCD target objects are:
4700
4701 @deffn Command {$target_name arp_examine} @option{allow-defer}
4702 @deffnx Command {$target_name arp_halt}
4703 @deffnx Command {$target_name arp_poll}
4704 @deffnx Command {$target_name arp_reset}
4705 @deffnx Command {$target_name arp_waitstate}
4706 Internal OpenOCD scripts (most notably @file{startup.tcl})
4707 use these to deal with specific reset cases.
4708 They are not otherwise documented here.
4709 @end deffn
4710
4711 @deffn Command {$target_name array2mem} arrayname width address count
4712 @deffnx Command {$target_name mem2array} arrayname width address count
4713 These provide an efficient script-oriented interface to memory.
4714 The @code{array2mem} primitive writes bytes, halfwords, or words;
4715 while @code{mem2array} reads them.
4716 In both cases, the TCL side uses an array, and
4717 the target side uses raw memory.
4718
4719 The efficiency comes from enabling the use of
4720 bulk JTAG data transfer operations.
4721 The script orientation comes from working with data
4722 values that are packaged for use by TCL scripts;
4723 @command{mdw} type primitives only print data they retrieve,
4724 and neither store nor return those values.
4725
4726 @itemize
4727 @item @var{arrayname} ... is the name of an array variable
4728 @item @var{width} ... is 8/16/32 - indicating the memory access size
4729 @item @var{address} ... is the target memory address
4730 @item @var{count} ... is the number of elements to process
4731 @end itemize
4732 @end deffn
4733
4734 @deffn Command {$target_name cget} queryparm
4735 Each configuration parameter accepted by
4736 @command{$target_name configure}
4737 can be individually queried, to return its current value.
4738 The @var{queryparm} is a parameter name
4739 accepted by that command, such as @code{-work-area-phys}.
4740 There are a few special cases:
4741
4742 @itemize @bullet
4743 @item @code{-event} @var{event_name} -- returns the handler for the
4744 event named @var{event_name}.
4745 This is a special case because setting a handler requires
4746 two parameters.
4747 @item @code{-type} -- returns the target type.
4748 This is a special case because this is set using
4749 @command{target create} and can't be changed
4750 using @command{$target_name configure}.
4751 @end itemize
4752
4753 For example, if you wanted to summarize information about
4754 all the targets you might use something like this:
4755
4756 @example
4757 foreach name [target names] @{
4758 set y [$name cget -endian]
4759 set z [$name cget -type]
4760 puts [format "Chip %d is %s, Endian: %s, type: %s" \
4761 $x $name $y $z]
4762 @}
4763 @end example
4764 @end deffn
4765
4766 @anchor{targetcurstate}
4767 @deffn Command {$target_name curstate}
4768 Displays the current target state:
4769 @code{debug-running},
4770 @code{halted},
4771 @code{reset},
4772 @code{running}, or @code{unknown}.
4773 (Also, @pxref{eventpolling,,Event Polling}.)
4774 @end deffn
4775
4776 @deffn Command {$target_name eventlist}
4777 Displays a table listing all event handlers
4778 currently associated with this target.
4779 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
4780 @end deffn
4781
4782 @deffn Command {$target_name invoke-event} event_name
4783 Invokes the handler for the event named @var{event_name}.
4784 (This is primarily intended for use by OpenOCD framework
4785 code, for example by the reset code in @file{startup.tcl}.)
4786 @end deffn
4787
4788 @deffn Command {$target_name mdd} [phys] addr [count]
4789 @deffnx Command {$target_name mdw} [phys] addr [count]
4790 @deffnx Command {$target_name mdh} [phys] addr [count]
4791 @deffnx Command {$target_name mdb} [phys] addr [count]
4792 Display contents of address @var{addr}, as
4793 64-bit doublewords (@command{mdd}),
4794 32-bit words (@command{mdw}), 16-bit halfwords (@command{mdh}),
4795 or 8-bit bytes (@command{mdb}).
4796 When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
4797 @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
4798 Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
4799 @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
4800 If @var{count} is specified, displays that many units.
4801 (If you want to manipulate the data instead of displaying it,
4802 see the @code{mem2array} primitives.)
4803 @end deffn
4804
4805 @deffn Command {$target_name mwd} [phys] addr doubleword [count]
4806 @deffnx Command {$target_name mww} [phys] addr word [count]
4807 @deffnx Command {$target_name mwh} [phys] addr halfword [count]
4808 @deffnx Command {$target_name mwb} [phys] addr byte [count]
4809 Writes the specified @var{doubleword} (64 bits), @var{word} (32 bits),
4810 @var{halfword} (16 bits), or @var{byte} (8-bit) value,
4811 at the specified address @var{addr}.
4812 When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
4813 @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
4814 Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
4815 @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
4816 If @var{count} is specified, fills that many units of consecutive address.
4817 @end deffn
4818
4819 @anchor{targetevents}
4820 @section Target Events
4821 @cindex target events
4822 @cindex events
4823 At various times, certain things can happen, or you want them to happen.
4824 For example:
4825 @itemize @bullet
4826 @item What should happen when GDB connects? Should your target reset?
4827 @item When GDB tries to flash the target, do you need to enable the flash via a special command?
4828 @item Is using SRST appropriate (and possible) on your system?
4829 Or instead of that, do you need to issue JTAG commands to trigger reset?
4830 SRST usually resets everything on the scan chain, which can be inappropriate.
4831 @item During reset, do you need to write to certain memory locations
4832 to set up system clocks or
4833 to reconfigure the SDRAM?
4834 How about configuring the watchdog timer, or other peripherals,
4835 to stop running while you hold the core stopped for debugging?
4836 @end itemize
4837
4838 All of the above items can be addressed by target event handlers.
4839 These are set up by @command{$target_name configure -event} or
4840 @command{target create ... -event}.
4841
4842 The programmer's model matches the @code{-command} option used in Tcl/Tk
4843 buttons and events. The two examples below act the same, but one creates
4844 and invokes a small procedure while the other inlines it.
4845
4846 @example
4847 proc my_init_proc @{ @} @{
4848 echo "Disabling watchdog..."
4849 mww 0xfffffd44 0x00008000
4850 @}
4851 mychip.cpu configure -event reset-init my_init_proc
4852 mychip.cpu configure -event reset-init @{
4853 echo "Disabling watchdog..."
4854 mww 0xfffffd44 0x00008000
4855 @}
4856 @end example
4857
4858 The following target events are defined:
4859
4860 @itemize @bullet
4861 @item @b{debug-halted}
4862 @* The target has halted for debug reasons (i.e.: breakpoint)
4863 @item @b{debug-resumed}
4864 @* The target has resumed (i.e.: GDB said run)
4865 @item @b{early-halted}
4866 @* Occurs early in the halt process
4867 @item @b{examine-start}
4868 @* Before target examine is called.
4869 @item @b{examine-end}
4870 @* After target examine is called with no errors.
4871 @item @b{examine-fail}
4872 @* After target examine fails.
4873 @item @b{gdb-attach}
4874 @* When GDB connects. Issued before any GDB communication with the target
4875 starts. GDB expects the target is halted during attachment.
4876 @xref{gdbmeminspect,,GDB as a non-intrusive memory inspector}, how to
4877 connect GDB to running target.
4878 The event can be also used to set up the target so it is possible to probe flash.
4879 Probing flash is necessary during GDB connect if you want to use
4880 @pxref{programmingusinggdb,,programming using GDB}.
4881 Another use of the flash memory map is for GDB to automatically choose
4882 hardware or software breakpoints depending on whether the breakpoint
4883 is in RAM or read only memory.
4884 Default is @code{halt}
4885 @item @b{gdb-detach}
4886 @* When GDB disconnects
4887 @item @b{gdb-end}
4888 @* When the target has halted and GDB is not doing anything (see early halt)
4889 @item @b{gdb-flash-erase-start}
4890 @* Before the GDB flash process tries to erase the flash (default is
4891 @code{reset init})
4892 @item @b{gdb-flash-erase-end}
4893 @* After the GDB flash process has finished erasing the flash
4894 @item @b{gdb-flash-write-start}
4895 @* Before GDB writes to the flash
4896 @item @b{gdb-flash-write-end}
4897 @* After GDB writes to the flash (default is @code{reset halt})
4898 @item @b{gdb-start}
4899 @* Before the target steps, GDB is trying to start/resume the target
4900 @item @b{halted}
4901 @* The target has halted
4902 @item @b{reset-assert-pre}
4903 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4904 after @command{reset-start} was triggered
4905 but before either SRST alone is asserted on the scan chain,
4906 or @code{reset-assert} is triggered.
4907 @item @b{reset-assert}
4908 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4909 after @command{reset-assert-pre} was triggered.
4910 When such a handler is present, cores which support this event will use
4911 it instead of asserting SRST.
4912 This support is essential for debugging with JTAG interfaces which
4913 don't include an SRST line (JTAG doesn't require SRST), and for
4914 selective reset on scan chains that have multiple targets.
4915 @item @b{reset-assert-post}
4916 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4917 after @code{reset-assert} has been triggered.
4918 or the target asserted SRST on the entire scan chain.
4919 @item @b{reset-deassert-pre}
4920 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4921 after @code{reset-assert-post} has been triggered.
4922 @item @b{reset-deassert-post}
4923 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4924 after @code{reset-deassert-pre} has been triggered
4925 and (if the target is using it) after SRST has been
4926 released on the scan chain.
4927 @item @b{reset-end}
4928 @* Issued as the final step in @command{reset} processing.
4929 @item @b{reset-init}
4930 @* Used by @b{reset init} command for board-specific initialization.
4931 This event fires after @emph{reset-deassert-post}.
4932
4933 This is where you would configure PLLs and clocking, set up DRAM so
4934 you can download programs that don't fit in on-chip SRAM, set up pin
4935 multiplexing, and so on.
4936 (You may be able to switch to a fast JTAG clock rate here, after
4937 the target clocks are fully set up.)
4938 @item @b{reset-start}
4939 @* Issued as the first step in @command{reset} processing
4940 before @command{reset-assert-pre} is called.
4941
4942 This is the most robust place to use @command{jtag_rclk}
4943 or @command{adapter speed} to switch to a low JTAG clock rate,
4944 when reset disables PLLs needed to use a fast clock.
4945 @item @b{resume-start}
4946 @* Before any target is resumed
4947 @item @b{resume-end}
4948 @* After all targets have resumed
4949 @item @b{resumed}
4950 @* Target has resumed
4951 @item @b{step-start}
4952 @* Before a target is single-stepped
4953 @item @b{step-end}
4954 @* After single-step has completed
4955 @item @b{trace-config}
4956 @* After target hardware trace configuration was changed
4957 @end itemize
4958
4959 @node Flash Commands
4960 @chapter Flash Commands
4961
4962 OpenOCD has different commands for NOR and NAND flash;
4963 the ``flash'' command works with NOR flash, while
4964 the ``nand'' command works with NAND flash.
4965 This partially reflects different hardware technologies:
4966 NOR flash usually supports direct CPU instruction and data bus access,
4967 while data from a NAND flash must be copied to memory before it can be
4968 used. (SPI flash must also be copied to memory before use.)
4969 However, the documentation also uses ``flash'' as a generic term;
4970 for example, ``Put flash configuration in board-specific files''.
4971
4972 Flash Steps:
4973 @enumerate
4974 @item Configure via the command @command{flash bank}
4975 @* Do this in a board-specific configuration file,
4976 passing parameters as needed by the driver.
4977 @item Operate on the flash via @command{flash subcommand}
4978 @* Often commands to manipulate the flash are typed by a human, or run
4979 via a script in some automated way. Common tasks include writing a
4980 boot loader, operating system, or other data.
4981 @item GDB Flashing
4982 @* Flashing via GDB requires the flash be configured via ``flash
4983 bank'', and the GDB flash features be enabled.
4984 @xref{gdbconfiguration,,GDB Configuration}.
4985 @end enumerate
4986
4987 Many CPUs have the ability to ``boot'' from the first flash bank.
4988 This means that misprogramming that bank can ``brick'' a system,
4989 so that it can't boot.
4990 JTAG tools, like OpenOCD, are often then used to ``de-brick'' the
4991 board by (re)installing working boot firmware.
4992
4993 @anchor{norconfiguration}
4994 @section Flash Configuration Commands
4995 @cindex flash configuration
4996
4997 @deffn {Config Command} {flash bank} name driver base size chip_width bus_width target [driver_options]
4998 Configures a flash bank which provides persistent storage
4999 for addresses from @math{base} to @math{base + size - 1}.
5000 These banks will often be visible to GDB through the target's memory map.
5001 In some cases, configuring a flash bank will activate extra commands;
5002 see the driver-specific documentation.
5003
5004 @itemize @bullet
5005 @item @var{name} ... may be used to reference the flash bank
5006 in other flash commands. A number is also available.
5007 @item @var{driver} ... identifies the controller driver
5008 associated with the flash bank being declared.
5009 This is usually @code{cfi} for external flash, or else
5010 the name of a microcontroller with embedded flash memory.
5011 @xref{flashdriverlist,,Flash Driver List}.
5012 @item @var{base} ... Base address of the flash chip.
5013 @item @var{size} ... Size of the chip, in bytes.
5014 For some drivers, this value is detected from the hardware.
5015 @item @var{chip_width} ... Width of the flash chip, in bytes;
5016 ignored for most microcontroller drivers.
5017 @item @var{bus_width} ... Width of the data bus used to access the
5018 chip, in bytes; ignored for most microcontroller drivers.
5019 @item @var{target} ... Names the target used to issue
5020 commands to the flash controller.
5021 @comment Actually, it's currently a controller-specific parameter...
5022 @item @var{driver_options} ... drivers may support, or require,
5023 additional parameters. See the driver-specific documentation
5024 for more information.
5025 @end itemize
5026 @quotation Note
5027 This command is not available after OpenOCD initialization has completed.
5028 Use it in board specific configuration files, not interactively.
5029 @end quotation
5030 @end deffn
5031
5032 @comment less confusing would be: "flash list" (like "nand list")
5033 @deffn Command {flash banks}
5034 Prints a one-line summary of each device that was
5035 declared using @command{flash bank}, numbered from zero.
5036 Note that this is the @emph{plural} form;
5037 the @emph{singular} form is a very different command.
5038 @end deffn
5039
5040 @deffn Command {flash list}
5041 Retrieves a list of associative arrays for each device that was
5042 declared using @command{flash bank}, numbered from zero.
5043 This returned list can be manipulated easily from within scripts.
5044 @end deffn
5045
5046 @deffn Command {flash probe} num
5047 Identify the flash, or validate the parameters of the configured flash. Operation
5048 depends on the flash type.
5049 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5050 Most flash commands will implicitly @emph{autoprobe} the bank;
5051 flash drivers can distinguish between probing and autoprobing,
5052 but most don't bother.
5053 @end deffn
5054
5055 @section Preparing a Target before Flash Programming
5056
5057 The target device should be in well defined state before the flash programming
5058 begins.
5059
5060 @emph{Always issue} @command{reset init} before @ref{flashprogrammingcommands,,Flash Programming Commands}.
5061 Do not issue another @command{reset} or @command{reset halt} or @command{resume}
5062 until the programming session is finished.
5063
5064 If you use @ref{programmingusinggdb,,Programming using GDB},
5065 the target is prepared automatically in the event gdb-flash-erase-start
5066
5067 The jimtcl script @command{program} calls @command{reset init} explicitly.
5068
5069 @section Erasing, Reading, Writing to Flash
5070 @cindex flash erasing
5071 @cindex flash reading
5072 @cindex flash writing
5073 @cindex flash programming
5074 @anchor{flashprogrammingcommands}
5075
5076 One feature distinguishing NOR flash from NAND or serial flash technologies
5077 is that for read access, it acts exactly like any other addressable memory.
5078 This means you can use normal memory read commands like @command{mdw} or
5079 @command{dump_image} with it, with no special @command{flash} subcommands.
5080 @xref{memoryaccess,,Memory access}, and @ref{imageaccess,,Image access}.
5081
5082 Write access works differently. Flash memory normally needs to be erased
5083 before it's written. Erasing a sector turns all of its bits to ones, and
5084 writing can turn ones into zeroes. This is why there are special commands
5085 for interactive erasing and writing, and why GDB needs to know which parts
5086 of the address space hold NOR flash memory.
5087
5088 @quotation Note
5089 Most of these erase and write commands leverage the fact that NOR flash
5090 chips consume target address space. They implicitly refer to the current
5091 JTAG target, and map from an address in that target's address space
5092 back to a flash bank.
5093 @comment In May 2009, those mappings may fail if any bank associated
5094 @comment with that target doesn't successfully autoprobe ... bug worth fixing?
5095 A few commands use abstract addressing based on bank and sector numbers,
5096 and don't depend on searching the current target and its address space.
5097 Avoid confusing the two command models.
5098 @end quotation
5099
5100 Some flash chips implement software protection against accidental writes,
5101 since such buggy writes could in some cases ``brick'' a system.
5102 For such systems, erasing and writing may require sector protection to be
5103 disabled first.
5104 Examples include CFI flash such as ``Intel Advanced Bootblock flash'',
5105 and AT91SAM7 on-chip flash.
5106 @xref{flashprotect,,flash protect}.
5107
5108 @deffn Command {flash erase_sector} num first last
5109 Erase sectors in bank @var{num}, starting at sector @var{first}
5110 up to and including @var{last}.
5111 Sector numbering starts at 0.
5112 Providing a @var{last} sector of @option{last}
5113 specifies "to the end of the flash bank".
5114 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5115 @end deffn
5116
5117 @deffn Command {flash erase_address} [@option{pad}] [@option{unlock}] address length
5118 Erase sectors starting at @var{address} for @var{length} bytes.
5119 Unless @option{pad} is specified, @math{address} must begin a
5120 flash sector, and @math{address + length - 1} must end a sector.
5121 Specifying @option{pad} erases extra data at the beginning and/or
5122 end of the specified region, as needed to erase only full sectors.
5123 The flash bank to use is inferred from the @var{address}, and
5124 the specified length must stay within that bank.
5125 As a special case, when @var{length} is zero and @var{address} is
5126 the start of the bank, the whole flash is erased.
5127 If @option{unlock} is specified, then the flash is unprotected
5128 before erase starts.
5129 @end deffn
5130
5131 @deffn Command {flash filld} address double-word length
5132 @deffnx Command {flash fillw} address word length
5133 @deffnx Command {flash fillh} address halfword length
5134 @deffnx Command {flash fillb} address byte length
5135 Fills flash memory with the specified @var{double-word} (64 bits), @var{word} (32 bits),
5136 @var{halfword} (16 bits), or @var{byte} (8-bit) pattern,
5137 starting at @var{address} and continuing
5138 for @var{length} units (word/halfword/byte).
5139 No erasure is done before writing; when needed, that must be done
5140 before issuing this command.
5141 Writes are done in blocks of up to 1024 bytes, and each write is
5142 verified by reading back the data and comparing it to what was written.
5143 The flash bank to use is inferred from the @var{address} of
5144 each block, and the specified length must stay within that bank.
5145 @end deffn
5146 @comment no current checks for errors if fill blocks touch multiple banks!
5147
5148 @deffn Command {flash mdw} addr [count]
5149 @deffnx Command {flash mdh} addr [count]
5150 @deffnx Command {flash mdb} addr [count]
5151 Display contents of address @var{addr}, as
5152 32-bit words (@command{mdw}), 16-bit halfwords (@command{mdh}),
5153 or 8-bit bytes (@command{mdb}).
5154 If @var{count} is specified, displays that many units.
5155 Reads from flash using the flash driver, therefore it enables reading
5156 from a bank not mapped in target address space.
5157 The flash bank to use is inferred from the @var{address} of
5158 each block, and the specified length must stay within that bank.
5159 @end deffn
5160
5161 @deffn Command {flash write_bank} num filename [offset]
5162 Write the binary @file{filename} to flash bank @var{num},
5163 starting at @var{offset} bytes from the beginning of the bank. If @var{offset}
5164 is omitted, start at the beginning of the flash bank.
5165 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5166 @end deffn
5167
5168 @deffn Command {flash read_bank} num filename [offset [length]]
5169 Read @var{length} bytes from the flash bank @var{num} starting at @var{offset}
5170 and write the contents to the binary @file{filename}. If @var{offset} is
5171 omitted, start at the beginning of the flash bank. If @var{length} is omitted,
5172 read the remaining bytes from the flash bank.
5173 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5174 @end deffn
5175
5176 @deffn Command {flash verify_bank} num filename [offset]
5177 Compare the contents of the binary file @var{filename} with the contents of the
5178 flash bank @var{num} starting at @var{offset}. If @var{offset} is omitted,
5179 start at the beginning of the flash bank. Fail if the contents do not match.
5180 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5181 @end deffn
5182
5183 @deffn Command {flash write_image} [erase] [unlock] filename [offset] [type]
5184 Write the image @file{filename} to the current target's flash bank(s).
5185 Only loadable sections from the image are written.
5186 A relocation @var{offset} may be specified, in which case it is added
5187 to the base address for each section in the image.
5188 The file [@var{type}] can be specified
5189 explicitly as @option{bin} (binary), @option{ihex} (Intel hex),
5190 @option{elf} (ELF file), @option{s19} (Motorola s19).
5191 @option{mem}, or @option{builder}.
5192 The relevant flash sectors will be erased prior to programming
5193 if the @option{erase} parameter is given. If @option{unlock} is
5194 provided, then the flash banks are unlocked before erase and
5195 program. The flash bank to use is inferred from the address of
5196 each image section.
5197
5198 @quotation Warning
5199 Be careful using the @option{erase} flag when the flash is holding
5200 data you want to preserve.
5201 Portions of the flash outside those described in the image's
5202 sections might be erased with no notice.
5203 @itemize
5204 @item
5205 When a section of the image being written does not fill out all the
5206 sectors it uses, the unwritten parts of those sectors are necessarily
5207 also erased, because sectors can't be partially erased.
5208 @item
5209 Data stored in sector "holes" between image sections are also affected.
5210 For example, "@command{flash write_image erase ...}" of an image with
5211 one byte at the beginning of a flash bank and one byte at the end
5212 erases the entire bank -- not just the two sectors being written.
5213 @end itemize
5214 Also, when flash protection is important, you must re-apply it after
5215 it has been removed by the @option{unlock} flag.
5216 @end quotation
5217
5218 @end deffn
5219
5220 @section Other Flash commands
5221 @cindex flash protection
5222
5223 @deffn Command {flash erase_check} num
5224 Check erase state of sectors in flash bank @var{num},
5225 and display that status.
5226 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5227 @end deffn
5228
5229 @deffn Command {flash info} num [sectors]
5230 Print info about flash bank @var{num}, a list of protection blocks
5231 and their status. Use @option{sectors} to show a list of sectors instead.
5232
5233 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5234 This command will first query the hardware, it does not print cached
5235 and possibly stale information.
5236 @end deffn
5237
5238 @anchor{flashprotect}
5239 @deffn Command {flash protect} num first last (@option{on}|@option{off})
5240 Enable (@option{on}) or disable (@option{off}) protection of flash blocks
5241 in flash bank @var{num}, starting at protection block @var{first}
5242 and continuing up to and including @var{last}.
5243 Providing a @var{last} block of @option{last}
5244 specifies "to the end of the flash bank".
5245 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5246 The protection block is usually identical to a flash sector.
5247 Some devices may utilize a protection block distinct from flash sector.
5248 See @command{flash info} for a list of protection blocks.
5249 @end deffn
5250
5251 @deffn Command {flash padded_value} num value
5252 Sets the default value used for padding any image sections, This should
5253 normally match the flash bank erased value. If not specified by this
5254 command or the flash driver then it defaults to 0xff.
5255 @end deffn
5256
5257 @anchor{program}
5258 @deffn Command {program} filename [preverify] [verify] [reset] [exit] [offset]
5259 This is a helper script that simplifies using OpenOCD as a standalone
5260 programmer. The only required parameter is @option{filename}, the others are optional.
5261 @xref{Flash Programming}.
5262 @end deffn
5263
5264 @anchor{flashdriverlist}
5265 @section Flash Driver List
5266 As noted above, the @command{flash bank} command requires a driver name,
5267 and allows driver-specific options and behaviors.
5268 Some drivers also activate driver-specific commands.
5269
5270 @deffn {Flash Driver} virtual
5271 This is a special driver that maps a previously defined bank to another
5272 address. All bank settings will be copied from the master physical bank.
5273
5274 The @var{virtual} driver defines one mandatory parameters,
5275
5276 @itemize
5277 @item @var{master_bank} The bank that this virtual address refers to.
5278 @end itemize
5279
5280 So in the following example addresses 0xbfc00000 and 0x9fc00000 refer to
5281 the flash bank defined at address 0x1fc00000. Any command executed on
5282 the virtual banks is actually performed on the physical banks.
5283 @example
5284 flash bank $_FLASHNAME pic32mx 0x1fc00000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5285 flash bank vbank0 virtual 0xbfc00000 0 0 0 \
5286 $_TARGETNAME $_FLASHNAME
5287 flash bank vbank1 virtual 0x9fc00000 0 0 0 \
5288 $_TARGETNAME $_FLASHNAME
5289 @end example
5290 @end deffn
5291
5292 @subsection External Flash
5293
5294 @deffn {Flash Driver} cfi
5295 @cindex Common Flash Interface
5296 @cindex CFI
5297 The ``Common Flash Interface'' (CFI) is the main standard for
5298 external NOR flash chips, each of which connects to a
5299 specific external chip select on the CPU.
5300 Frequently the first such chip is used to boot the system.
5301 Your board's @code{reset-init} handler might need to
5302 configure additional chip selects using other commands (like: @command{mww} to
5303 configure a bus and its timings), or
5304 perhaps configure a GPIO pin that controls the ``write protect'' pin
5305 on the flash chip.
5306 The CFI driver can use a target-specific working area to significantly
5307 speed up operation.
5308
5309 The CFI driver can accept the following optional parameters, in any order:
5310
5311 @itemize
5312 @item @var{jedec_probe} ... is used to detect certain non-CFI flash ROMs,
5313 like AM29LV010 and similar types.
5314 @item @var{x16_as_x8} ... when a 16-bit flash is hooked up to an 8-bit bus.
5315 @item @var{bus_swap} ... when data bytes in a 16-bit flash needs to be swapped.
5316 @item @var{data_swap} ... when data bytes in a 16-bit flash needs to be
5317 swapped when writing data values (i.e. not CFI commands).
5318 @end itemize
5319
5320 To configure two adjacent banks of 16 MBytes each, both sixteen bits (two bytes)
5321 wide on a sixteen bit bus:
5322
5323 @example
5324 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cfi 0x00000000 0x01000000 2 2 $_TARGETNAME
5325 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cfi 0x01000000 0x01000000 2 2 $_TARGETNAME
5326 @end example
5327
5328 To configure one bank of 32 MBytes
5329 built from two sixteen bit (two byte) wide parts wired in parallel
5330 to create a thirty-two bit (four byte) bus with doubled throughput:
5331
5332 @example
5333 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cfi 0x00000000 0x02000000 2 4 $_TARGETNAME
5334 @end example
5335
5336 @c "cfi part_id" disabled
5337 @end deffn
5338
5339 @deffn {Flash Driver} jtagspi
5340 @cindex Generic JTAG2SPI driver
5341 @cindex SPI
5342 @cindex jtagspi
5343 @cindex bscan_spi
5344 Several FPGAs and CPLDs can retrieve their configuration (bitstream) from a
5345 SPI flash connected to them. To access this flash from the host, the device
5346 is first programmed with a special proxy bitstream that
5347 exposes the SPI flash on the device's JTAG interface. The flash can then be
5348 accessed through JTAG.
5349
5350 Since signaling between JTAG and SPI is compatible, all that is required for
5351 a proxy bitstream is to connect TDI-MOSI, TDO-MISO, TCK-CLK and activate
5352 the flash chip select when the JTAG state machine is in SHIFT-DR. Such
5353 a bitstream for several Xilinx FPGAs can be found in
5354 @file{contrib/loaders/flash/fpga/xilinx_bscan_spi.py}. It requires
5355 @uref{https://github.com/m-labs/migen, migen} and a Xilinx toolchain to build.
5356
5357 This flash bank driver requires a target on a JTAG tap and will access that
5358 tap directly. Since no support from the target is needed, the target can be a
5359 "testee" dummy. Since the target does not expose the flash memory
5360 mapping, target commands that would otherwise be expected to access the flash
5361 will not work. These include all @command{*_image} and
5362 @command{$target_name m*} commands as well as @command{program}. Equivalent
5363 functionality is available through the @command{flash write_bank},
5364 @command{flash read_bank}, and @command{flash verify_bank} commands.
5365
5366 @itemize
5367 @item @var{ir} ... is loaded into the JTAG IR to map the flash as the JTAG DR.
5368 For the bitstreams generated from @file{xilinx_bscan_spi.py} this is the
5369 @var{USER1} instruction.
5370 @end itemize
5371
5372 @example
5373 target create $_TARGETNAME testee -chain-position $_CHIPNAME.fpga
5374 set _XILINX_USER1 0x02
5375 flash bank $_FLASHNAME spi 0x0 0 0 0 \
5376 $_TARGETNAME $_XILINX_USER1
5377 @end example
5378 @end deffn
5379
5380 @deffn {Flash Driver} xcf
5381 @cindex Xilinx Platform flash driver
5382 @cindex xcf
5383 Xilinx FPGAs can be configured from specialized flash ICs named Platform Flash.
5384 It is (almost) regular NOR flash with erase sectors, program pages, etc. The
5385 only difference is special registers controlling its FPGA specific behavior.
5386 They must be properly configured for successful FPGA loading using
5387 additional @var{xcf} driver command:
5388
5389 @deffn Command {xcf ccb} <bank_id>
5390 command accepts additional parameters:
5391 @itemize
5392 @item @var{external|internal} ... selects clock source.
5393 @item @var{serial|parallel} ... selects serial or parallel data bus mode.
5394 @item @var{slave|master} ... selects slave of master mode for flash device.
5395 @item @var{40|20} ... selects clock frequency in MHz for internal clock
5396 in master mode.
5397 @end itemize
5398 @example
5399 xcf ccb 0 external parallel slave 40
5400 @end example
5401 All of them must be specified even if clock frequency is pointless
5402 in slave mode. If only bank id specified than command prints current
5403 CCB register value. Note: there is no need to write this register
5404 every time you erase/program data sectors because it stores in
5405 dedicated sector.
5406 @end deffn
5407
5408 @deffn Command {xcf configure} <bank_id>
5409 Initiates FPGA loading procedure. Useful if your board has no "configure"
5410 button.
5411 @example
5412 xcf configure 0
5413 @end example
5414 @end deffn
5415
5416 Additional driver notes:
5417 @itemize
5418 @item Only single revision supported.
5419 @item Driver automatically detects need of bit reverse, but
5420 only "bin" (raw binary, do not confuse it with "bit") and "mcs"
5421 (Intel hex) file types supported.
5422 @item For additional info check xapp972.pdf and ug380.pdf.
5423 @end itemize
5424 @end deffn
5425
5426 @deffn {Flash Driver} lpcspifi
5427 @cindex NXP SPI Flash Interface
5428 @cindex SPIFI
5429 @cindex lpcspifi
5430 NXP's LPC43xx and LPC18xx families include a proprietary SPI
5431 Flash Interface (SPIFI) peripheral that can drive and provide
5432 memory mapped access to external SPI flash devices.
5433
5434 The lpcspifi driver initializes this interface and provides
5435 program and erase functionality for these serial flash devices.
5436 Use of this driver @b{requires} a working area of at least 1kB
5437 to be configured on the target device; more than this will
5438 significantly reduce flash programming times.
5439
5440 The setup command only requires the @var{base} parameter. All
5441 other parameters are ignored, and the flash size and layout
5442 are configured by the driver.
5443
5444 @example
5445 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpcspifi 0x14000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5446 @end example
5447
5448 @end deffn
5449
5450 @deffn {Flash Driver} stmsmi
5451 @cindex STMicroelectronics Serial Memory Interface
5452 @cindex SMI
5453 @cindex stmsmi
5454 Some devices from STMicroelectronics (e.g. STR75x MCU family,
5455 SPEAr MPU family) include a proprietary
5456 ``Serial Memory Interface'' (SMI) controller able to drive external
5457 SPI flash devices.
5458 Depending on specific device and board configuration, up to 4 external
5459 flash devices can be connected.
5460
5461 SMI makes the flash content directly accessible in the CPU address
5462 space; each external device is mapped in a memory bank.
5463 CPU can directly read data, execute code and boot from SMI banks.
5464 Normal OpenOCD commands like @command{mdw} can be used to display
5465 the flash content.
5466
5467 The setup command only requires the @var{base} parameter in order
5468 to identify the memory bank.
5469 All other parameters are ignored. Additional information, like
5470 flash size, are detected automatically.
5471
5472 @example
5473 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stmsmi 0xf8000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5474 @end example
5475
5476 @end deffn
5477
5478 @deffn {Flash Driver} mrvlqspi
5479 This driver supports QSPI flash controller of Marvell's Wireless
5480 Microcontroller platform.
5481
5482 The flash size is autodetected based on the table of known JEDEC IDs
5483 hardcoded in the OpenOCD sources.
5484
5485 @example
5486 flash bank $_FLASHNAME mrvlqspi 0x0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 0x46010000
5487 @end example
5488
5489 @end deffn
5490
5491 @deffn {Flash Driver} ath79
5492 @cindex Atheros ath79 SPI driver
5493 @cindex ath79
5494 Members of ATH79 SoC family from Atheros include a SPI interface with 3
5495 chip selects.
5496 On reset a SPI flash connected to the first chip select (CS0) is made
5497 directly read-accessible in the CPU address space (up to 16MBytes)
5498 and is usually used to store the bootloader and operating system.
5499 Normal OpenOCD commands like @command{mdw} can be used to display
5500 the flash content while it is in memory-mapped mode (only the first
5501 4MBytes are accessible without additional configuration on reset).
5502
5503 The setup command only requires the @var{base} parameter in order
5504 to identify the memory bank. The actual value for the base address
5505 is not otherwise used by the driver. However the mapping is passed
5506 to gdb. Thus for the memory mapped flash (chipselect CS0) the base
5507 address should be the actual memory mapped base address. For unmapped
5508 chipselects (CS1 and CS2) care should be taken to use a base address
5509 that does not overlap with real memory regions.
5510 Additional information, like flash size, are detected automatically.
5511 An optional additional parameter sets the chipselect for the bank,
5512 with the default CS0.
5513 CS1 and CS2 require additional GPIO setup before they can be used
5514 since the alternate function must be enabled on the GPIO pin
5515 CS1/CS2 is routed to on the given SoC.
5516
5517 @example
5518 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ath79 0xbf000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5519
5520 # When using multiple chipselects the base should be different for each,
5521 # otherwise the write_image command is not able to distinguish the
5522 # banks.
5523 flash bank flash0 ath79 0xbf000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME cs0
5524 flash bank flash1 ath79 0x10000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME cs1
5525 flash bank flash2 ath79 0x20000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME cs2
5526 @end example
5527
5528 @end deffn
5529
5530 @deffn {Flash Driver} fespi
5531 @cindex Freedom E SPI
5532 @cindex fespi
5533
5534 SiFive's Freedom E SPI controller, used in HiFive and other boards.
5535
5536 @example
5537 flash bank $_FLASHNAME fespi 0x20000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5538 @end example
5539 @end deffn
5540
5541 @subsection Internal Flash (Microcontrollers)
5542
5543 @deffn {Flash Driver} aduc702x
5544 The ADUC702x analog microcontrollers from Analog Devices
5545 include internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores.
5546 The aduc702x flash driver works with models ADUC7019 through ADUC7028.
5547 The setup command only requires the @var{target} argument
5548 since all devices in this family have the same memory layout.
5549
5550 @example
5551 flash bank $_FLASHNAME aduc702x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5552 @end example
5553 @end deffn
5554
5555 @deffn {Flash Driver} ambiqmicro
5556 @cindex ambiqmicro
5557 @cindex apollo
5558 All members of the Apollo microcontroller family from
5559 Ambiq Micro include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
5560 The host connects over USB to an FTDI interface that communicates
5561 with the target using SWD.
5562
5563 The @var{ambiqmicro} driver reads the Chip Information Register detect
5564 the device class of the MCU.
5565 The Flash and SRAM sizes directly follow device class, and are used
5566 to set up the flash banks.
5567 If this fails, the driver will use default values set to the minimum
5568 sizes of an Apollo chip.
5569
5570 All Apollo chips have two flash banks of the same size.
5571 In all cases the first flash bank starts at location 0,
5572 and the second bank starts after the first.
5573
5574 @example
5575 # Flash bank 0
5576 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ambiqmicro 0 0x00040000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5577 # Flash bank 1 - same size as bank0, starts after bank 0.
5578 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ambiqmicro 0x00040000 0x00040000 0 0 \
5579 $_TARGETNAME
5580 @end example
5581
5582 Flash is programmed using custom entry points into the bootloader.
5583 This is the only way to program the flash as no flash control registers
5584 are available to the user.
5585
5586 The @var{ambiqmicro} driver adds some additional commands:
5587
5588 @deffn Command {ambiqmicro mass_erase} <bank>
5589 Erase entire bank.
5590 @end deffn
5591 @deffn Command {ambiqmicro page_erase} <bank> <first> <last>
5592 Erase device pages.
5593 @end deffn
5594 @deffn Command {ambiqmicro program_otp} <bank> <offset> <count>
5595 Program OTP is a one time operation to create write protected flash.
5596 The user writes sectors to SRAM starting at 0x10000010.
5597 Program OTP will write these sectors from SRAM to flash, and write protect
5598 the flash.
5599 @end deffn
5600 @end deffn
5601
5602 @anchor{at91samd}
5603 @deffn {Flash Driver} at91samd
5604 @cindex at91samd
5605 All members of the ATSAM D2x, D1x, D0x, ATSAMR, ATSAML and ATSAMC microcontroller
5606 families from Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M0+ core.
5607
5608 Do not use for ATSAM D51 and E5x: use @xref{atsame5}.
5609
5610 The devices have one flash bank:
5611
5612 @example
5613 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91samd 0x00000000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
5614 @end example
5615
5616 @deffn Command {at91samd chip-erase}
5617 Issues a complete Flash erase via the Device Service Unit (DSU). This can be
5618 used to erase a chip back to its factory state and does not require the
5619 processor to be halted.
5620 @end deffn
5621
5622 @deffn Command {at91samd set-security}
5623 Secures the Flash via the Set Security Bit (SSB) command. This prevents access
5624 to the Flash and can only be undone by using the chip-erase command which
5625 erases the Flash contents and turns off the security bit. Warning: at this
5626 time, openocd will not be able to communicate with a secured chip and it is
5627 therefore not possible to chip-erase it without using another tool.
5628
5629 @example
5630 at91samd set-security enable
5631 @end example
5632 @end deffn
5633
5634 @deffn Command {at91samd eeprom}
5635 Shows or sets the EEPROM emulation size configuration, stored in the User Row
5636 of the Flash. When setting, the EEPROM size must be specified in bytes and it
5637 must be one of the permitted sizes according to the datasheet. Settings are
5638 written immediately but only take effect on MCU reset. EEPROM emulation
5639 requires additional firmware support and the minimum EEPROM size may not be
5640 the same as the minimum that the hardware supports. Set the EEPROM size to 0
5641 in order to disable this feature.
5642
5643 @example
5644 at91samd eeprom
5645 at91samd eeprom 1024
5646 @end example
5647 @end deffn
5648
5649 @deffn Command {at91samd bootloader}
5650 Shows or sets the bootloader size configuration, stored in the User Row of the
5651 Flash. This is called the BOOTPROT region. When setting, the bootloader size
5652 must be specified in bytes and it must be one of the permitted sizes according
5653 to the datasheet. Settings are written immediately but only take effect on
5654 MCU reset. Setting the bootloader size to 0 disables bootloader protection.
5655
5656 @example
5657 at91samd bootloader
5658 at91samd bootloader 16384
5659 @end example
5660 @end deffn
5661
5662 @deffn Command {at91samd dsu_reset_deassert}
5663 This command releases internal reset held by DSU
5664 and prepares reset vector catch in case of reset halt.
5665 Command is used internally in event reset-deassert-post.
5666 @end deffn
5667
5668 @deffn Command {at91samd nvmuserrow}
5669 Writes or reads the entire 64 bit wide NVM user row register which is located at
5670 0x804000. This register includes various fuses lock-bits and factory calibration
5671 data. Reading the register is done by invoking this command without any
5672 arguments. Writing is possible by giving 1 or 2 hex values. The first argument
5673 is the register value to be written and the second one is an optional changemask.
5674 Every bit which value in changemask is 0 will stay unchanged. The lock- and
5675 reserved-bits are masked out and cannot be changed.
5676
5677 @example
5678 # Read user row
5679 >at91samd nvmuserrow
5680 NVMUSERROW: 0xFFFFFC5DD8E0C788
5681 # Write 0xFFFFFC5DD8E0C788 to user row
5682 >at91samd nvmuserrow 0xFFFFFC5DD8E0C788
5683 # Write 0x12300 to user row but leave other bits and low byte unchanged
5684 >at91samd nvmuserrow 0x12345 0xFFF00
5685 @end example
5686 @end deffn
5687
5688 @end deffn
5689
5690 @anchor{at91sam3}
5691 @deffn {Flash Driver} at91sam3
5692 @cindex at91sam3
5693 All members of the AT91SAM3 microcontroller family from
5694 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M3 core. The driver
5695 currently (6/22/09) recognizes the AT91SAM3U[1/2/4][C/E] chips. Note
5696 that the driver was orginaly developed and tested using the
5697 AT91SAM3U4E, using a SAM3U-EK eval board. Support for other chips in
5698 the family was cribbed from the data sheet. @emph{Note to future
5699 readers/updaters: Please remove this worrisome comment after other
5700 chips are confirmed.}
5701
5702 The AT91SAM3U4[E/C] (256K) chips have two flash banks; most other chips
5703 have one flash bank. In all cases the flash banks are at
5704 the following fixed locations:
5705
5706 @example
5707 # Flash bank 0 - all chips
5708 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91sam3 0x00080000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
5709 # Flash bank 1 - only 256K chips
5710 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91sam3 0x00100000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
5711 @end example
5712
5713 Internally, the AT91SAM3 flash memory is organized as follows.
5714 Unlike the AT91SAM7 chips, these are not used as parameters
5715 to the @command{flash bank} command:
5716
5717 @itemize
5718 @item @emph{N-Banks:} 256K chips have 2 banks, others have 1 bank.
5719 @item @emph{Bank Size:} 128K/64K Per flash bank
5720 @item @emph{Sectors:} 16 or 8 per bank
5721 @item @emph{SectorSize:} 8K Per Sector
5722 @item @emph{PageSize:} 256 bytes per page. Note that OpenOCD operates on 'sector' sizes, not page sizes.
5723 @end itemize
5724
5725 The AT91SAM3 driver adds some additional commands:
5726
5727 @deffn Command {at91sam3 gpnvm}
5728 @deffnx Command {at91sam3 gpnvm clear} number
5729 @deffnx Command {at91sam3 gpnvm set} number
5730 @deffnx Command {at91sam3 gpnvm show} [@option{all}|number]
5731 With no parameters, @command{show} or @command{show all},
5732 shows the status of all GPNVM bits.
5733 With @command{show} @var{number}, displays that bit.
5734
5735 With @command{set} @var{number} or @command{clear} @var{number},
5736 modifies that GPNVM bit.
5737 @end deffn
5738
5739 @deffn Command {at91sam3 info}
5740 This command attempts to display information about the AT91SAM3
5741 chip. @emph{First} it read the @code{CHIPID_CIDR} [address 0x400e0740, see
5742 Section 28.2.1, page 505 of the AT91SAM3U 29/may/2009 datasheet,
5743 document id: doc6430A] and decodes the values. @emph{Second} it reads the
5744 various clock configuration registers and attempts to display how it
5745 believes the chip is configured. By default, the SLOWCLK is assumed to
5746 be 32768 Hz, see the command @command{at91sam3 slowclk}.
5747 @end deffn
5748
5749 @deffn Command {at91sam3 slowclk} [value]
5750 This command shows/sets the slow clock frequency used in the
5751 @command{at91sam3 info} command calculations above.
5752 @end deffn
5753 @end deffn
5754
5755 @deffn {Flash Driver} at91sam4
5756 @cindex at91sam4
5757 All members of the AT91SAM4 microcontroller family from
5758 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
5759 This driver uses the same command names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
5760 @end deffn
5761
5762 @deffn {Flash Driver} at91sam4l
5763 @cindex at91sam4l
5764 All members of the AT91SAM4L microcontroller family from
5765 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
5766 This driver uses the same command names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
5767
5768 The AT91SAM4L driver adds some additional commands:
5769 @deffn Command {at91sam4l smap_reset_deassert}
5770 This command releases internal reset held by SMAP
5771 and prepares reset vector catch in case of reset halt.
5772 Command is used internally in event reset-deassert-post.
5773 @end deffn
5774 @end deffn
5775
5776 @anchor{atsame5}
5777 @deffn {Flash Driver} atsame5
5778 @cindex atsame5
5779 All members of the SAM E54, E53, E51 and D51 microcontroller
5780 families from Microchip (former Atmel) include internal flash
5781 and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
5782
5783 The devices have two ECC flash banks with a swapping feature.
5784 This driver handles both banks together as it were one.
5785 Bank swapping is not supported yet.
5786
5787 @example
5788 flash bank $_FLASHNAME atsame5 0x00000000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
5789 @end example
5790
5791 @deffn Command {atsame5 bootloader}
5792 Shows or sets the bootloader size configuration, stored in the User Page of the
5793 Flash. This is called the BOOTPROT region. When setting, the bootloader size
5794 must be specified in bytes. The nearest bigger protection size is used.
5795 Settings are written immediately but only take effect on MCU reset.
5796 Setting the bootloader size to 0 disables bootloader protection.
5797
5798 @example
5799 atsame5 bootloader
5800 atsame5 bootloader 16384
5801 @end example
5802 @end deffn
5803
5804 @deffn Command {atsame5 chip-erase}
5805 Issues a complete Flash erase via the Device Service Unit (DSU). This can be
5806 used to erase a chip back to its factory state and does not require the
5807 processor to be halted.
5808 @end deffn
5809
5810 @deffn Command {atsame5 dsu_reset_deassert}
5811 This command releases internal reset held by DSU
5812 and prepares reset vector catch in case of reset halt.
5813 Command is used internally in event reset-deassert-post.
5814 @end deffn
5815
5816 @deffn Command {atsame5 userpage}
5817 Writes or reads the first 64 bits of NVM User Page which is located at
5818 0x804000. This field includes various fuses.
5819 Reading is done by invoking this command without any arguments.
5820 Writing is possible by giving 1 or 2 hex values. The first argument
5821 is the value to be written and the second one is an optional bit mask
5822 (a zero bit in the mask means the bit stays unchanged).
5823 The reserved fields are always masked out and cannot be changed.
5824
5825 @example
5826 # Read
5827 >atsame5 userpage
5828 USER PAGE: 0xAEECFF80FE9A9239
5829 # Write
5830 >atsame5 userpage 0xAEECFF80FE9A9239
5831 # Write 2 to SEESBLK and 4 to SEEPSZ fields but leave other bits unchanged
5832 # (setup SmartEEPROM of virtual size 8192 bytes)
5833 >atsame5 userpage 0x4200000000 0x7f00000000
5834 @end example
5835 @end deffn
5836
5837 @end deffn
5838
5839 @deffn {Flash Driver} atsamv
5840 @cindex atsamv
5841 All members of the ATSAMV7x, ATSAMS70, and ATSAME70 families from
5842 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M7 core.
5843 This driver uses the same command names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
5844 @end deffn
5845
5846 @deffn {Flash Driver} at91sam7
5847 All members of the AT91SAM7 microcontroller family from Atmel include
5848 internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores. The driver automatically
5849 recognizes a number of these chips using the chip identification
5850 register, and autoconfigures itself.
5851
5852 @example
5853 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91sam7 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5854 @end example
5855
5856 For chips which are not recognized by the controller driver, you must
5857 provide additional parameters in the following order:
5858
5859 @itemize
5860 @item @var{chip_model} ... label used with @command{flash info}
5861 @item @var{banks}
5862 @item @var{sectors_per_bank}
5863 @item @var{pages_per_sector}
5864 @item @var{pages_size}
5865 @item @var{num_nvm_bits}
5866 @item @var{freq_khz} ... required if an external clock is provided,
5867 optional (but recommended) when the oscillator frequency is known
5868 @end itemize
5869
5870 It is recommended that you provide zeroes for all of those values
5871 except the clock frequency, so that everything except that frequency
5872 will be autoconfigured.
5873 Knowing the frequency helps ensure correct timings for flash access.
5874
5875 The flash controller handles erases automatically on a page (128/256 byte)
5876 basis, so explicit erase commands are not necessary for flash programming.
5877 However, there is an ``EraseAll`` command that can erase an entire flash
5878 plane (of up to 256KB), and it will be used automatically when you issue
5879 @command{flash erase_sector} or @command{flash erase_address} commands.
5880
5881 @deffn Command {at91sam7 gpnvm} bitnum (@option{set}|@option{clear})
5882 Set or clear a ``General Purpose Non-Volatile Memory'' (GPNVM)
5883 bit for the processor. Each processor has a number of such bits,
5884 used for controlling features such as brownout detection (so they
5885 are not truly general purpose).
5886 @quotation Note
5887 This assumes that the first flash bank (number 0) is associated with
5888 the appropriate at91sam7 target.
5889 @end quotation
5890 @end deffn
5891 @end deffn
5892
5893 @deffn {Flash Driver} avr
5894 The AVR 8-bit microcontrollers from Atmel integrate flash memory.
5895 @emph{The current implementation is incomplete.}
5896 @comment - defines mass_erase ... pointless given flash_erase_address
5897 @end deffn
5898
5899 @deffn {Flash Driver} bluenrg-x
5900 STMicroelectronics BlueNRG-1, BlueNRG-2 and BlueNRG-LP Bluetooth low energy wireless system-on-chip. They include ARM Cortex-M0/M0+ core and internal flash memory.
5901 The driver automatically recognizes these chips using
5902 the chip identification registers, and autoconfigures itself.
5903
5904 @example
5905 flash bank $_FLASHNAME bluenrg-x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5906 @end example
5907
5908 Note that when users ask to erase all the sectors of the flash, a mass erase command is used which is faster than erasing
5909 each single sector one by one.
5910
5911 @example
5912 flash erase_sector 0 0 last # It will perform a mass erase
5913 @end example
5914
5915 Triggering a mass erase is also useful when users want to disable readout protection.
5916 @end deffn
5917
5918 @deffn {Flash Driver} cc26xx
5919 All versions of the SimpleLink CC13xx and CC26xx microcontrollers from Texas
5920 Instruments include internal flash. The cc26xx flash driver supports both the
5921 CC13xx and CC26xx family of devices. The driver automatically recognizes the
5922 specific version's flash parameters and autoconfigures itself. The flash bank
5923 starts at address 0.
5924
5925 @example
5926 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cc26xx 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5927 @end example
5928 @end deffn
5929
5930 @deffn {Flash Driver} cc3220sf
5931 The CC3220SF version of the SimpleLink CC32xx microcontrollers from Texas
5932 Instruments includes 1MB of internal flash. The cc3220sf flash driver only
5933 supports the internal flash. The serial flash on SimpleLink boards is
5934 programmed via the bootloader over a UART connection. Security features of
5935 the CC3220SF may erase the internal flash during power on reset. Refer to
5936 documentation at @url{www.ti.com/cc3220sf} for details on security features
5937 and programming the serial flash.
5938
5939 @example
5940 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cc3220sf 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5941 @end example
5942 @end deffn
5943
5944 @deffn {Flash Driver} efm32
5945 All members of the EFM32 microcontroller family from Energy Micro include
5946 internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores. The driver automatically recognizes
5947 a number of these chips using the chip identification register, and
5948 autoconfigures itself.
5949 @example
5950 flash bank $_FLASHNAME efm32 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5951 @end example
5952 A special feature of efm32 controllers is that it is possible to completely disable the
5953 debug interface by writing the correct values to the 'Debug Lock Word'. OpenOCD supports
5954 this via the following command:
5955 @example
5956 efm32 debuglock num
5957 @end example
5958 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5959 Note that in order for this command to take effect, the target needs to be reset.
5960 @emph{The current implementation is incomplete. Unprotecting flash pages is not
5961 supported.}
5962 @end deffn
5963
5964 @deffn {Flash Driver} esirisc
5965 Members of the eSi-RISC family may optionally include internal flash programmed
5966 via the eSi-TSMC Flash interface. Additional parameters are required to
5967 configure the driver: @option{cfg_address} is the base address of the
5968 configuration register interface, @option{clock_hz} is the expected clock
5969 frequency, and @option{wait_states} is the number of configured read wait states.
5970
5971 @example
5972 flash bank $_FLASHNAME esirisc base_address size_bytes 0 0 \
5973 $_TARGETNAME cfg_address clock_hz wait_states
5974 @end example
5975
5976 @deffn Command {esirisc flash mass_erase} bank_id
5977 Erase all pages in data memory for the bank identified by @option{bank_id}.
5978 @end deffn
5979
5980 @deffn Command {esirisc flash ref_erase} bank_id
5981 Erase the reference cell for the bank identified by @option{bank_id}. @emph{This
5982 is an uncommon operation.}
5983 @end deffn
5984 @end deffn
5985
5986 @deffn {Flash Driver} fm3
5987 All members of the FM3 microcontroller family from Fujitsu
5988 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores.
5989 The @var{fm3} driver uses the @var{target} parameter to select the
5990 correct bank config, it can currently be one of the following:
5991 @code{mb9bfxx1.cpu}, @code{mb9bfxx2.cpu}, @code{mb9bfxx3.cpu},
5992 @code{mb9bfxx4.cpu}, @code{mb9bfxx5.cpu} or @code{mb9bfxx6.cpu}.
5993
5994 @example
5995 flash bank $_FLASHNAME fm3 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5996 @end example
5997 @end deffn
5998
5999 @deffn {Flash Driver} fm4
6000 All members of the FM4 microcontroller family from Spansion (formerly Fujitsu)
6001 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M4 cores.
6002 The @var{fm4} driver uses a @var{family} parameter to select the
6003 correct bank config, it can currently be one of the following:
6004 @code{MB9BFx64}, @code{MB9BFx65}, @code{MB9BFx66}, @code{MB9BFx67}, @code{MB9BFx68},
6005 @code{S6E2Cx8}, @code{S6E2Cx9}, @code{S6E2CxA} or @code{S6E2Dx},
6006 with @code{x} treated as wildcard and otherwise case (and any trailing
6007 characters) ignored.
6008
6009 @example
6010 flash bank $@{_FLASHNAME@}0 fm4 0x00000000 0 0 0 \
6011 $_TARGETNAME S6E2CCAJ0A
6012 flash bank $@{_FLASHNAME@}1 fm4 0x00100000 0 0 0 \
6013 $_TARGETNAME S6E2CCAJ0A
6014 @end example
6015 @emph{The current implementation is incomplete. Protection is not supported,
6016 nor is Chip Erase (only Sector Erase is implemented).}
6017 @end deffn
6018
6019 @deffn {Flash Driver} kinetis
6020 @cindex kinetis
6021 Kx, KLx, KVx and KE1x members of the Kinetis microcontroller family
6022 from NXP (former Freescale) include
6023 internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0+ or M4 cores. The driver automatically
6024 recognizes flash size and a number of flash banks (1-4) using the chip
6025 identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
6026 Use kinetis_ke driver for KE0x and KEAx devices.
6027
6028 The @var{kinetis} driver defines option:
6029 @itemize
6030 @item -sim-base @var{addr} ... base of System Integration Module where chip identification resides. Driver tries two known locations if option is omitted.
6031 @end itemize
6032
6033 @example
6034 flash bank $_FLASHNAME kinetis 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6035 @end example
6036
6037 @deffn Command {kinetis create_banks}
6038 Configuration command enables automatic creation of additional flash banks
6039 based on real flash layout of device. Banks are created during device probe.
6040 Use 'flash probe 0' to force probe.
6041 @end deffn
6042
6043 @deffn Command {kinetis fcf_source} [protection|write]
6044 Select what source is used when writing to a Flash Configuration Field.
6045 @option{protection} mode builds FCF content from protection bits previously
6046 set by 'flash protect' command.
6047 This mode is default. MCU is protected from unwanted locking by immediate
6048 writing FCF after erase of relevant sector.
6049 @option{write} mode enables direct write to FCF.
6050 Protection cannot be set by 'flash protect' command. FCF is written along
6051 with the rest of a flash image.
6052 @emph{BEWARE: Incorrect flash configuration may permanently lock the device!}
6053 @end deffn
6054
6055 @deffn Command {kinetis fopt} [num]
6056 Set value to write to FOPT byte of Flash Configuration Field.
6057 Used in kinetis 'fcf_source protection' mode only.
6058 @end deffn
6059
6060 @deffn Command {kinetis mdm check_security}
6061 Checks status of device security lock. Used internally in examine-end
6062 and examine-fail event.
6063 @end deffn
6064
6065 @deffn Command {kinetis mdm halt}
6066 Issues a halt via the MDM-AP. This command can be used to break a watchdog reset
6067 loop when connecting to an unsecured target.
6068 @end deffn
6069
6070 @deffn Command {kinetis mdm mass_erase}
6071 Issues a complete flash erase via the MDM-AP. This can be used to erase a chip
6072 back to its factory state, removing security. It does not require the processor
6073 to be halted, however the target will remain in a halted state after this
6074 command completes.
6075 @end deffn
6076
6077 @deffn Command {kinetis nvm_partition}
6078 For FlexNVM devices only (KxxDX and KxxFX).
6079 Command shows or sets data flash or EEPROM backup size in kilobytes,
6080 sets two EEPROM blocks sizes in bytes and enables/disables loading
6081 of EEPROM contents to FlexRAM during reset.
6082
6083 For details see device reference manual, Flash Memory Module,
6084 Program Partition command.
6085
6086 Setting is possible only once after mass_erase.
6087 Reset the device after partition setting.
6088
6089 Show partition size:
6090 @example
6091 kinetis nvm_partition info
6092 @end example
6093
6094 Set 32 KB data flash, rest of FlexNVM is EEPROM backup. EEPROM has two blocks
6095 of 512 and 1536 bytes and its contents is loaded to FlexRAM during reset:
6096 @example
6097 kinetis nvm_partition dataflash 32 512 1536 on
6098 @end example
6099
6100 Set 16 KB EEPROM backup, rest of FlexNVM is a data flash. EEPROM has two blocks
6101 of 1024 bytes and its contents is not loaded to FlexRAM during reset:
6102 @example
6103 kinetis nvm_partition eebkp 16 1024 1024 off
6104 @end example
6105 @end deffn
6106
6107 @deffn Command {kinetis mdm reset}
6108 Issues a reset via the MDM-AP. This causes the MCU to output a low pulse on the
6109 RESET pin, which can be used to reset other hardware on board.
6110 @end deffn
6111
6112 @deffn Command {kinetis disable_wdog}
6113 For Kx devices only (KLx has different COP watchdog, it is not supported).
6114 Command disables watchdog timer.
6115 @end deffn
6116 @end deffn
6117
6118 @deffn {Flash Driver} kinetis_ke
6119 @cindex kinetis_ke
6120 KE0x and KEAx members of the Kinetis microcontroller family from NXP include
6121 internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0+. The driver automatically recognizes
6122 the KE0x sub-family using the chip identification register, and
6123 autoconfigures itself.
6124 Use kinetis (not kinetis_ke) driver for KE1x devices.
6125
6126 @example
6127 flash bank $_FLASHNAME kinetis_ke 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6128 @end example
6129
6130 @deffn Command {kinetis_ke mdm check_security}
6131 Checks status of device security lock. Used internally in examine-end event.
6132 @end deffn
6133
6134 @deffn Command {kinetis_ke mdm mass_erase}
6135 Issues a complete Flash erase via the MDM-AP.
6136 This can be used to erase a chip back to its factory state.
6137 Command removes security lock from a device (use of SRST highly recommended).
6138 It does not require the processor to be halted.
6139 @end deffn
6140
6141 @deffn Command {kinetis_ke disable_wdog}
6142 Command disables watchdog timer.
6143 @end deffn
6144 @end deffn
6145
6146 @deffn {Flash Driver} lpc2000
6147 This is the driver to support internal flash of all members of the
6148 LPC11(x)00 and LPC1300 microcontroller families and most members of
6149 the LPC800, LPC1500, LPC1700, LPC1800, LPC2000, LPC4000, LPC54100,
6150 LPC8Nxx and NHS31xx microcontroller families from NXP.
6151
6152 @quotation Note
6153 There are LPC2000 devices which are not supported by the @var{lpc2000}
6154 driver:
6155 The LPC2888 is supported by the @var{lpc288x} driver.
6156 The LPC29xx family is supported by the @var{lpc2900} driver.
6157 @end quotation
6158
6159 The @var{lpc2000} driver defines two mandatory and two optional parameters,
6160 which must appear in the following order:
6161
6162 @itemize
6163 @item @var{variant} ... required, may be
6164 @option{lpc2000_v1} (older LPC21xx and LPC22xx)
6165 @option{lpc2000_v2} (LPC213x, LPC214x, LPC210[123], LPC23xx and LPC24xx)
6166 @option{lpc1700} (LPC175x and LPC176x and LPC177x/8x)
6167 @option{lpc4300} - available also as @option{lpc1800} alias (LPC18x[2357] and
6168 LPC43x[2357])
6169 @option{lpc800} (LPC8xx)
6170 @option{lpc1100} (LPC11(x)xx and LPC13xx)
6171 @option{lpc1500} (LPC15xx)
6172 @option{lpc54100} (LPC541xx)
6173 @option{lpc4000} (LPC40xx)
6174 or @option{auto} - automatically detects flash variant and size for LPC11(x)00,
6175 LPC8xx, LPC13xx, LPC17xx, LPC40xx, LPC8Nxx and NHS31xx
6176 @item @var{clock_kHz} ... the frequency, in kiloHertz,
6177 at which the core is running
6178 @item @option{calc_checksum} ... optional (but you probably want to provide this!),
6179 telling the driver to calculate a valid checksum for the exception vector table.
6180 @quotation Note
6181 If you don't provide @option{calc_checksum} when you're writing the vector
6182 table, the boot ROM will almost certainly ignore your flash image.
6183 However, if you do provide it,
6184 with most tool chains @command{verify_image} will fail.
6185 @end quotation
6186 @item @option{iap_entry} ... optional telling the driver to use a different
6187 ROM IAP entry point.
6188 @end itemize
6189
6190 LPC flashes don't require the chip and bus width to be specified.
6191
6192 @example
6193 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc2000 0x0 0x7d000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME \
6194 lpc2000_v2 14765 calc_checksum
6195 @end example
6196
6197 @deffn {Command} {lpc2000 part_id} bank
6198 Displays the four byte part identifier associated with
6199 the specified flash @var{bank}.
6200 @end deffn
6201 @end deffn
6202
6203 @deffn {Flash Driver} lpc288x
6204 The LPC2888 microcontroller from NXP needs slightly different flash
6205 support from its lpc2000 siblings.
6206 The @var{lpc288x} driver defines one mandatory parameter,
6207 the programming clock rate in Hz.
6208 LPC flashes don't require the chip and bus width to be specified.
6209
6210 @example
6211 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc288x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 12000000
6212 @end example
6213 @end deffn
6214
6215 @deffn {Flash Driver} lpc2900
6216 This driver supports the LPC29xx ARM968E based microcontroller family
6217 from NXP.
6218
6219 The predefined parameters @var{base}, @var{size}, @var{chip_width} and
6220 @var{bus_width} of the @code{flash bank} command are ignored. Flash size and
6221 sector layout are auto-configured by the driver.
6222 The driver has one additional mandatory parameter: The CPU clock rate
6223 (in kHz) at the time the flash operations will take place. Most of the time this
6224 will not be the crystal frequency, but a higher PLL frequency. The
6225 @code{reset-init} event handler in the board script is usually the place where
6226 you start the PLL.
6227
6228 The driver rejects flashless devices (currently the LPC2930).
6229
6230 The EEPROM in LPC2900 devices is not mapped directly into the address space.
6231 It must be handled much more like NAND flash memory, and will therefore be
6232 handled by a separate @code{lpc2900_eeprom} driver (not yet available).
6233
6234 Sector protection in terms of the LPC2900 is handled transparently. Every time a
6235 sector needs to be erased or programmed, it is automatically unprotected.
6236 What is shown as protection status in the @code{flash info} command, is
6237 actually the LPC2900 @emph{sector security}. This is a mechanism to prevent a
6238 sector from ever being erased or programmed again. As this is an irreversible
6239 mechanism, it is handled by a special command (@code{lpc2900 secure_sector}),
6240 and not by the standard @code{flash protect} command.
6241
6242 Example for a 125 MHz clock frequency:
6243 @example
6244 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc2900 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 125000
6245 @end example
6246
6247 Some @code{lpc2900}-specific commands are defined. In the following command list,
6248 the @var{bank} parameter is the bank number as obtained by the
6249 @code{flash banks} command.
6250
6251 @deffn Command {lpc2900 signature} bank
6252 Calculates a 128-bit hash value, the @emph{signature}, from the whole flash
6253 content. This is a hardware feature of the flash block, hence the calculation is
6254 very fast. You may use this to verify the content of a programmed device against
6255 a known signature.
6256 Example:
6257 @example
6258 lpc2900 signature 0
6259 signature: 0x5f40cdc8:0xc64e592e:0x10490f89:0x32a0f317
6260 @end example
6261 @end deffn
6262
6263 @deffn Command {lpc2900 read_custom} bank filename
6264 Reads the 912 bytes of customer information from the flash index sector, and
6265 saves it to a file in binary format.
6266 Example:
6267 @example
6268 lpc2900 read_custom 0 /path_to/customer_info.bin
6269 @end example
6270 @end deffn
6271
6272 The index sector of the flash is a @emph{write-only} sector. It cannot be
6273 erased! In order to guard against unintentional write access, all following
6274 commands need to be preceded by a successful call to the @code{password}
6275 command:
6276
6277 @deffn Command {lpc2900 password} bank password
6278 You need to use this command right before each of the following commands:
6279 @code{lpc2900 write_custom}, @code{lpc2900 secure_sector},
6280 @code{lpc2900 secure_jtag}.
6281
6282 The password string is fixed to "I_know_what_I_am_doing".
6283 Example:
6284 @example
6285 lpc2900 password 0 I_know_what_I_am_doing
6286 Potentially dangerous operation allowed in next command!
6287 @end example
6288 @end deffn
6289
6290 @deffn Command {lpc2900 write_custom} bank filename type
6291 Writes the content of the file into the customer info space of the flash index
6292 sector. The filetype can be specified with the @var{type} field. Possible values
6293 for @var{type} are: @var{bin} (binary), @var{ihex} (Intel hex format),
6294 @var{elf} (ELF binary) or @var{s19} (Motorola S-records). The file must
6295 contain a single section, and the contained data length must be exactly
6296 912 bytes.
6297 @quotation Attention
6298 This cannot be reverted! Be careful!
6299 @end quotation
6300 Example:
6301 @example
6302 lpc2900 write_custom 0 /path_to/customer_info.bin bin
6303 @end example
6304 @end deffn
6305
6306 @deffn Command {lpc2900 secure_sector} bank first last
6307 Secures the sector range from @var{first} to @var{last} (including) against
6308 further program and erase operations. The sector security will be effective
6309 after the next power cycle.
6310 @quotation Attention
6311 This cannot be reverted! Be careful!
6312 @end quotation
6313 Secured sectors appear as @emph{protected} in the @code{flash info} command.
6314 Example:
6315 @example
6316 lpc2900 secure_sector 0 1 1
6317 flash info 0
6318 #0 : lpc2900 at 0x20000000, size 0x000c0000, (...)
6319 # 0: 0x00000000 (0x2000 8kB) not protected
6320 # 1: 0x00002000 (0x2000 8kB) protected
6321 # 2: 0x00004000 (0x2000 8kB) not protected
6322 @end example
6323 @end deffn
6324
6325 @deffn Command {lpc2900 secure_jtag} bank
6326 Irreversibly disable the JTAG port. The new JTAG security setting will be
6327 effective after the next power cycle.
6328 @quotation Attention
6329 This cannot be reverted! Be careful!
6330 @end quotation
6331 Examples:
6332 @example
6333 lpc2900 secure_jtag 0
6334 @end example
6335 @end deffn
6336 @end deffn
6337
6338 @deffn {Flash Driver} mdr
6339 This drivers handles the integrated NOR flash on Milandr Cortex-M
6340 based controllers. A known limitation is that the Info memory can't be
6341 read or verified as it's not memory mapped.
6342
6343 @example
6344 flash bank <name> mdr <base> <size> \
6345 0 0 <target#> @var{type} @var{page_count} @var{sec_count}
6346 @end example
6347
6348 @itemize @bullet
6349 @item @var{type} - 0 for main memory, 1 for info memory
6350 @item @var{page_count} - total number of pages
6351 @item @var{sec_count} - number of sector per page count
6352 @end itemize
6353
6354 Example usage:
6355 @example
6356 if @{ [info exists IMEMORY] && [string equal $IMEMORY true] @} @{
6357 flash bank $@{_CHIPNAME@}_info.flash mdr 0x00000000 0x01000 \
6358 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 1 1 4
6359 @} else @{
6360 flash bank $_CHIPNAME.flash mdr 0x00000000 0x20000 \
6361 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 0 32 4
6362 @}
6363 @end example
6364 @end deffn
6365
6366 @deffn {Flash Driver} msp432
6367 All versions of the SimpleLink MSP432 microcontrollers from Texas
6368 Instruments include internal flash. The msp432 flash driver automatically
6369 recognizes the specific version's flash parameters and autoconfigures itself.
6370 Main program flash starts at address 0. The information flash region on
6371 MSP432P4 versions starts at address 0x200000.
6372
6373 @example
6374 flash bank $_FLASHNAME msp432 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6375 @end example
6376
6377 @deffn Command {msp432 mass_erase} bank_id [main|all]
6378 Performs a complete erase of flash. By default, @command{mass_erase} will erase
6379 only the main program flash.
6380
6381 On MSP432P4 versions, using @command{mass_erase all} will erase both the
6382 main program and information flash regions. To also erase the BSL in information
6383 flash, the user must first use the @command{bsl} command.
6384 @end deffn
6385
6386 @deffn Command {msp432 bsl} bank_id [unlock|lock]
6387 On MSP432P4 versions, @command{bsl} unlocks and locks the bootstrap loader (BSL)
6388 region in information flash so that flash commands can erase or write the BSL.
6389 Leave the BSL locked to prevent accidentally corrupting the bootstrap loader.
6390
6391 To erase and program the BSL:
6392 @example
6393 msp432 bsl unlock
6394 flash erase_address 0x202000 0x2000
6395 flash write_image bsl.bin 0x202000
6396 msp432 bsl lock
6397 @end example
6398 @end deffn
6399 @end deffn
6400
6401 @deffn {Flash Driver} niietcm4
6402 This drivers handles the integrated NOR flash on NIIET Cortex-M4
6403 based controllers. Flash size and sector layout are auto-configured by the driver.
6404 Main flash memory is called "Bootflash" and has main region and info region.
6405 Info region is NOT memory mapped by default,
6406 but it can replace first part of main region if needed.
6407 Full erase, single and block writes are supported for both main and info regions.
6408 There is additional not memory mapped flash called "Userflash", which
6409 also have division into regions: main and info.
6410 Purpose of userflash - to store system and user settings.
6411 Driver has special commands to perform operations with this memory.
6412
6413 @example
6414 flash bank $_FLASHNAME niietcm4 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6415 @end example
6416
6417 Some niietcm4-specific commands are defined:
6418
6419 @deffn Command {niietcm4 uflash_read_byte} bank ('main'|'info') address
6420 Read byte from main or info userflash region.
6421 @end deffn
6422
6423 @deffn Command {niietcm4 uflash_write_byte} bank ('main'|'info') address value
6424 Write byte to main or info userflash region.
6425 @end deffn
6426
6427 @deffn Command {niietcm4 uflash_full_erase} bank
6428 Erase all userflash including info region.
6429 @end deffn
6430
6431 @deffn Command {niietcm4 uflash_erase} bank ('main'|'info') first_sector last_sector
6432 Erase sectors of main or info userflash region, starting at sector first up to and including last.
6433 @end deffn
6434
6435 @deffn Command {niietcm4 uflash_protect_check} bank ('main'|'info')
6436 Check sectors protect.
6437 @end deffn
6438
6439 @deffn Command {niietcm4 uflash_protect} bank ('main'|'info') first_sector last_sector ('on'|'off')
6440 Protect sectors of main or info userflash region, starting at sector first up to and including last.
6441 @end deffn
6442
6443 @deffn Command {niietcm4 bflash_info_remap} bank ('on'|'off')
6444 Enable remapping bootflash info region to 0x00000000 (or 0x40000000 if external memory boot used).
6445 @end deffn
6446
6447 @deffn Command {niietcm4 extmem_cfg} bank ('gpioa'|'gpiob'|'gpioc'|'gpiod'|'gpioe'|'gpiof'|'gpiog'|'gpioh') pin_num ('func1'|'func3')
6448 Configure external memory interface for boot.
6449 @end deffn
6450
6451 @deffn Command {niietcm4 service_mode_erase} bank
6452 Perform emergency erase of all flash (bootflash and userflash).
6453 @end deffn
6454
6455 @deffn Command {niietcm4 driver_info} bank
6456 Show information about flash driver.
6457 @end deffn
6458
6459 @end deffn
6460
6461 @deffn {Flash Driver} nrf5
6462 All members of the nRF51 microcontroller families from Nordic Semiconductor
6463 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0 core.
6464 Also, the nRF52832 microcontroller from Nordic Semiconductor, which include
6465 internal flash and use an ARM Cortex-M4F core.
6466
6467 @example
6468 flash bank $_FLASHNAME nrf5 0 0x00000000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6469 @end example
6470
6471 Some nrf5-specific commands are defined:
6472
6473 @deffn Command {nrf5 mass_erase}
6474 Erases the contents of the code memory and user information
6475 configuration registers as well. It must be noted that this command
6476 works only for chips that do not have factory pre-programmed region 0
6477 code.
6478 @end deffn
6479
6480 @deffn Command {nrf5 info}
6481 Decodes and shows information from FICR and UICR registers.
6482 @end deffn
6483
6484 @end deffn
6485
6486 @deffn {Flash Driver} ocl
6487 This driver is an implementation of the ``on chip flash loader''
6488 protocol proposed by Pavel Chromy.
6489
6490 It is a minimalistic command-response protocol intended to be used
6491 over a DCC when communicating with an internal or external flash
6492 loader running from RAM. An example implementation for AT91SAM7x is
6493 available in @file{contrib/loaders/flash/at91sam7x/}.
6494
6495 @example
6496 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ocl 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6497 @end example
6498 @end deffn
6499
6500 @deffn {Flash Driver} pic32mx
6501 The PIC32MX microcontrollers are based on the MIPS 4K cores,
6502 and integrate flash memory.
6503
6504 @example
6505 flash bank $_FLASHNAME pix32mx 0x1fc00000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6506 flash bank $_FLASHNAME pix32mx 0x1d000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6507 @end example
6508
6509 @comment numerous *disabled* commands are defined:
6510 @comment - chip_erase ... pointless given flash_erase_address
6511 @comment - lock, unlock ... pointless given protect on/off (yes?)
6512 @comment - pgm_word ... shouldn't bank be deduced from address??
6513 Some pic32mx-specific commands are defined:
6514 @deffn Command {pic32mx pgm_word} address value bank
6515 Programs the specified 32-bit @var{value} at the given @var{address}
6516 in the specified chip @var{bank}.
6517 @end deffn
6518 @deffn Command {pic32mx unlock} bank
6519 Unlock and erase specified chip @var{bank}.
6520 This will remove any Code Protection.
6521 @end deffn
6522 @end deffn
6523
6524 @deffn {Flash Driver} psoc4
6525 All members of the PSoC 41xx/42xx microcontroller family from Cypress
6526 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0 cores.
6527 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
6528 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
6529
6530 Note: Erased internal flash reads as 00.
6531 System ROM of PSoC 4 does not implement erase of a flash sector.
6532
6533 @example
6534 flash bank $_FLASHNAME psoc4 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6535 @end example
6536
6537 psoc4-specific commands
6538 @deffn Command {psoc4 flash_autoerase} num (on|off)
6539 Enables or disables autoerase mode for a flash bank.
6540
6541 If flash_autoerase is off, use mass_erase before flash programming.
6542 Flash erase command fails if region to erase is not whole flash memory.
6543
6544 If flash_autoerase is on, a sector is both erased and programmed in one
6545 system ROM call. Flash erase command is ignored.
6546 This mode is suitable for gdb load.
6547
6548 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6549 @end deffn
6550
6551 @deffn Command {psoc4 mass_erase} num
6552 Erases the contents of the flash memory, protection and security lock.
6553
6554 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6555 @end deffn
6556 @end deffn
6557
6558 @deffn {Flash Driver} psoc5lp
6559 All members of the PSoC 5LP microcontroller family from Cypress
6560 include internal program flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores.
6561 The driver probes for a number of these chips and autoconfigures itself,
6562 apart from the base address.
6563
6564 @example
6565 flash bank $_FLASHNAME psoc5lp 0x00000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6566 @end example
6567
6568 @b{Note:} PSoC 5LP chips can be configured to have ECC enabled or disabled.
6569 @quotation Attention
6570 If flash operations are performed in ECC-disabled mode, they will also affect
6571 the ECC flash region. Erasing a 16k flash sector in the 0x00000000 area will
6572 then also erase the corresponding 2k data bytes in the 0x48000000 area.
6573 Writing to the ECC data bytes in ECC-disabled mode is not implemented.
6574 @end quotation
6575
6576 Commands defined in the @var{psoc5lp} driver:
6577
6578 @deffn Command {psoc5lp mass_erase}
6579 Erases all flash data and ECC/configuration bytes, all flash protection rows,
6580 and all row latches in all flash arrays on the device.
6581 @end deffn
6582 @end deffn
6583
6584 @deffn {Flash Driver} psoc5lp_eeprom
6585 All members of the PSoC 5LP microcontroller family from Cypress
6586 include internal EEPROM and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores.
6587 The driver probes for a number of these chips and autoconfigures itself,
6588 apart from the base address.
6589
6590 @example
6591 flash bank $_CHIPNAME.eeprom psoc5lp_eeprom 0x40008000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6592 @end example
6593 @end deffn
6594
6595 @deffn {Flash Driver} psoc5lp_nvl
6596 All members of the PSoC 5LP microcontroller family from Cypress
6597 include internal Nonvolatile Latches and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores.
6598 The driver probes for a number of these chips and autoconfigures itself.
6599
6600 @example
6601 flash bank $_CHIPNAME.nvl psoc5lp_nvl 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6602 @end example
6603
6604 PSoC 5LP chips have multiple NV Latches:
6605
6606 @itemize
6607 @item Device Configuration NV Latch - 4 bytes
6608 @item Write Once (WO) NV Latch - 4 bytes
6609 @end itemize
6610
6611 @b{Note:} This driver only implements the Device Configuration NVL.
6612
6613 The @var{psoc5lp} driver reads the ECC mode from Device Configuration NVL.
6614 @quotation Attention
6615 Switching ECC mode via write to Device Configuration NVL will require a reset
6616 after successful write.
6617 @end quotation
6618 @end deffn
6619
6620 @deffn {Flash Driver} psoc6
6621 Supports PSoC6 (CY8C6xxx) family of Cypress microcontrollers.
6622 PSoC6 is a dual-core device with CM0+ and CM4 cores. Both cores share
6623 the same Flash/RAM/MMIO address space.
6624
6625 Flash in PSoC6 is split into three regions:
6626 @itemize @bullet
6627 @item Main Flash - this is the main storage for user application.
6628 Total size varies among devices, sector size: 256 kBytes, row size:
6629 512 bytes. Supports erase operation on individual rows.
6630 @item Work Flash - intended to be used as storage for user data
6631 (e.g. EEPROM emulation). Total size: 32 KBytes, sector size: 32 KBytes,
6632 row size: 512 bytes.
6633 @item Supervisory Flash - special region which contains device-specific
6634 service data. This region does not support erase operation. Only few rows can
6635 be programmed by the user, most of the rows are read only. Programming
6636 operation will erase row automatically.
6637 @end itemize
6638
6639 All three flash regions are supported by the driver. Flash geometry is detected
6640 automatically by parsing data in SPCIF_GEOMETRY register.
6641
6642 PSoC6 is equipped with NOR Flash so erased Flash reads as 0x00.
6643
6644 @example
6645 flash bank main_flash_cm0 psoc6 0x10000000 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
6646 flash bank work_flash_cm0 psoc6 0x14000000 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
6647 flash bank super_flash_user_cm0 psoc6 0x16000800 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
6648 flash bank super_flash_nar_cm0 psoc6 0x16001A00 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
6649 flash bank super_flash_key_cm0 psoc6 0x16005A00 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
6650 flash bank super_flash_toc2_cm0 psoc6 0x16007C00 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
6651
6652 flash bank main_flash_cm4 psoc6 0x10000000 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
6653 flash bank work_flash_cm4 psoc6 0x14000000 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
6654 flash bank super_flash_user_cm4 psoc6 0x16000800 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
6655 flash bank super_flash_nar_cm4 psoc6 0x16001A00 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
6656 flash bank super_flash_key_cm4 psoc6 0x16005A00 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
6657 flash bank super_flash_toc2_cm4 psoc6 0x16007C00 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
6658 @end example
6659
6660 psoc6-specific commands
6661 @deffn Command {psoc6 reset_halt}
6662 Command can be used to simulate broken Vector Catch from gdbinit or tcl scripts.
6663 When invoked for CM0+ target, it will set break point at application entry point
6664 and issue SYSRESETREQ. This will reset both cores and all peripherals. CM0+ will
6665 reset CM4 during boot anyway so this is safe. On CM4 target, VECTRESET is used
6666 instead of SYSRESETREQ to avoid unwanted reset of CM0+;
6667 @end deffn
6668
6669 @deffn Command {psoc6 mass_erase} num
6670 Erases the contents given flash bank. The @var{num} parameter is a value shown
6671 by @command{flash banks}.
6672 Note: only Main and Work flash regions support Erase operation.
6673 @end deffn
6674 @end deffn
6675
6676 @deffn {Flash Driver} sim3x
6677 All members of the SiM3 microcontroller family from Silicon Laboratories
6678 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores. It supports both JTAG
6679 and SWD interface.
6680 The @var{sim3x} driver tries to probe the device to auto detect the MCU.
6681 If this fails, it will use the @var{size} parameter as the size of flash bank.
6682
6683 @example
6684 flash bank $_FLASHNAME sim3x 0 $_CPUROMSIZE 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6685 @end example
6686
6687 There are 2 commands defined in the @var{sim3x} driver:
6688
6689 @deffn Command {sim3x mass_erase}
6690 Erases the complete flash. This is used to unlock the flash.
6691 And this command is only possible when using the SWD interface.
6692 @end deffn
6693
6694 @deffn Command {sim3x lock}
6695 Lock the flash. To unlock use the @command{sim3x mass_erase} command.
6696 @end deffn
6697 @end deffn
6698
6699 @deffn {Flash Driver} stellaris
6700 All members of the Stellaris LM3Sxxx, LM4x and Tiva C microcontroller
6701 families from Texas Instruments include internal flash. The driver
6702 automatically recognizes a number of these chips using the chip
6703 identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
6704
6705 @example
6706 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stellaris 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6707 @end example
6708
6709 @deffn Command {stellaris recover}
6710 Performs the @emph{Recovering a "Locked" Device} procedure to restore
6711 the flash and its associated nonvolatile registers to their factory
6712 default values (erased). This is the only way to remove flash
6713 protection or re-enable debugging if that capability has been
6714 disabled.
6715
6716 Note that the final "power cycle the chip" step in this procedure
6717 must be performed by hand, since OpenOCD can't do it.
6718 @quotation Warning
6719 if more than one Stellaris chip is connected, the procedure is
6720 applied to all of them.
6721 @end quotation
6722 @end deffn
6723 @end deffn
6724
6725 @deffn {Flash Driver} stm32f1x
6726 All members of the STM32F0, STM32F1 and STM32F3 microcontroller families
6727 from STMicroelectronics include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0/M3/M4 cores.
6728 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
6729 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
6730
6731 @example
6732 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f1x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6733 @end example
6734
6735 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
6736 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
6737 the flash driver.
6738
6739 @example
6740 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f1x 0 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6741 @end example
6742
6743 If you have a target with dual flash banks then define the second bank
6744 as per the following example.
6745 @example
6746 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f1x 0x08080000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6747 @end example
6748
6749 Some stm32f1x-specific commands are defined:
6750
6751 @deffn Command {stm32f1x lock} num
6752 Locks the entire stm32 device against reading.
6753 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6754 @end deffn
6755
6756 @deffn Command {stm32f1x unlock} num
6757 Unlocks the entire stm32 device for reading. This command will cause
6758 a mass erase of the entire stm32 device if previously locked.
6759 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6760 @end deffn
6761
6762 @deffn Command {stm32f1x mass_erase} num
6763 Mass erases the entire stm32 device.
6764 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6765 @end deffn
6766
6767 @deffn Command {stm32f1x options_read} num
6768 Reads and displays active stm32 option bytes loaded during POR
6769 or upon executing the @command{stm32f1x options_load} command.
6770 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6771 @end deffn
6772
6773 @deffn Command {stm32f1x options_write} num (@option{SWWDG}|@option{HWWDG}) (@option{RSTSTNDBY}|@option{NORSTSTNDBY}) (@option{RSTSTOP}|@option{NORSTSTOP}) (@option{USEROPT} user_data)
6774 Writes the stm32 option byte with the specified values.
6775 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6776 The @var{user_data} parameter is content of higher 16 bits of the option byte register (Data0 and Data1 as one 16bit number).
6777 @end deffn
6778
6779 @deffn Command {stm32f1x options_load} num
6780 Generates a special kind of reset to re-load the stm32 option bytes written
6781 by the @command{stm32f1x options_write} or @command{flash protect} commands
6782 without having to power cycle the target. Not applicable to stm32f1x devices.
6783 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6784 @end deffn
6785 @end deffn
6786
6787 @deffn {Flash Driver} stm32f2x
6788 All members of the STM32F2, STM32F4 and STM32F7 microcontroller families from STMicroelectronics
6789 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3/M4/M7 cores.
6790 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
6791 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
6792
6793 @example
6794 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f2x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6795 @end example
6796
6797 If you use OTP (One-Time Programmable) memory define it as a second bank
6798 as per the following example.
6799 @example
6800 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f2x 0x1FFF7800 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6801 @end example
6802
6803 @deffn Command {stm32f2x otp } num (@option{enable}|@option{disable}|@option{show})
6804 Enables or disables OTP write commands for bank @var{num}.
6805 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6806 @end deffn
6807
6808 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
6809 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
6810 the flash driver.
6811
6812 @example
6813 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f2x 0 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6814 @end example
6815
6816 Some stm32f2x-specific commands are defined:
6817
6818 @deffn Command {stm32f2x lock} num
6819 Locks the entire stm32 device.
6820 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6821 @end deffn
6822
6823 @deffn Command {stm32f2x unlock} num
6824 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
6825 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6826 @end deffn
6827
6828 @deffn Command {stm32f2x mass_erase} num
6829 Mass erases the entire stm32f2x device.
6830 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6831 @end deffn
6832
6833 @deffn Command {stm32f2x options_read} num
6834 Reads and displays user options and (where implemented) boot_addr0, boot_addr1, optcr2.
6835 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6836 @end deffn
6837
6838 @deffn Command {stm32f2x options_write} num user_options boot_addr0 boot_addr1
6839 Writes user options and (where implemented) boot_addr0 and boot_addr1 in raw format.
6840 Warning: The meaning of the various bits depends on the device, always check datasheet!
6841 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{user_options} a
6842 12 bit value, consisting of bits 31-28 and 7-0 of FLASH_OPTCR, @var{boot_addr0} and
6843 @var{boot_addr1} two halfwords (of FLASH_OPTCR1).
6844 @end deffn
6845
6846 @deffn Command {stm32f2x optcr2_write} num optcr2
6847 Writes FLASH_OPTCR2 options. Warning: Clearing PCROPi bits requires a full mass erase!
6848 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{optcr2} a 32-bit word.
6849 @end deffn
6850 @end deffn
6851
6852 @deffn {Flash Driver} stm32h7x
6853 All members of the STM32H7 microcontroller families from STMicroelectronics
6854 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M7 core.
6855 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
6856 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
6857
6858 @example
6859 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32h7x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6860 @end example
6861
6862 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
6863 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
6864 the flash driver.
6865
6866 @example
6867 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32h7x 0 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6868 @end example
6869
6870 Some stm32h7x-specific commands are defined:
6871
6872 @deffn Command {stm32h7x lock} num
6873 Locks the entire stm32 device.
6874 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6875 @end deffn
6876
6877 @deffn Command {stm32h7x unlock} num
6878 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
6879 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6880 @end deffn
6881
6882 @deffn Command {stm32h7x mass_erase} num
6883 Mass erases the entire stm32h7x device.
6884 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6885 @end deffn
6886
6887 @deffn Command {stm32h7x option_read} num reg_offset
6888 Reads an option byte register from the stm32h7x device.
6889 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{reg_offset}
6890 is the register offset of the option byte to read from the used bank registers' base.
6891 For example: in STM32H74x/H75x the bank 1 registers' base is 0x52002000 and 0x52002100 for bank 2.
6892
6893 Example usage:
6894 @example
6895 # read OPTSR_CUR
6896 stm32h7x option_read 0 0x1c
6897 # read WPSN_CUR1R
6898 stm32h7x option_read 0 0x38
6899 # read WPSN_CUR2R
6900 stm32h7x option_read 1 0x38
6901 @end example
6902 @end deffn
6903
6904 @deffn Command {stm32h7x option_write} num reg_offset value [reg_mask]
6905 Writes an option byte register of the stm32h7x device.
6906 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{reg_offset}
6907 is the register offset of the option byte to write from the used bank register base,
6908 and @var{reg_mask} is the mask to apply when writing the register (only bits with a '1'
6909 will be touched).
6910
6911 Example usage:
6912 @example
6913 # swap bank 1 and bank 2 in dual bank devices, by setting SWAP_BANK_OPT bit in OPTSR_PRG
6914 stm32h7x option_write 0 0x20 0x8000000 0x8000000
6915 @end example
6916 @end deffn
6917 @end deffn
6918
6919 @deffn {Flash Driver} stm32lx
6920 All members of the STM32L0 and STM32L1 microcontroller families from STMicroelectronics
6921 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 and Cortex-M0+ cores.
6922 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
6923 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
6924
6925 @example
6926 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32lx 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6927 @end example
6928
6929 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
6930 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
6931 the flash driver. If you use 0 as the bank base address, it tells the
6932 driver to autodetect the bank location assuming you're configuring the
6933 second bank.
6934
6935 @example
6936 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32lx 0x08000000 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6937 @end example
6938
6939 Some stm32lx-specific commands are defined:
6940
6941 @deffn Command {stm32lx lock} num
6942 Locks the entire stm32 device.
6943 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6944 @end deffn
6945
6946 @deffn Command {stm32lx unlock} num
6947 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
6948 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6949 @end deffn
6950
6951 @deffn Command {stm32lx mass_erase} num
6952 Mass erases the entire stm32lx device (all flash banks and EEPROM
6953 data). This is the only way to unlock a protected flash (unless RDP
6954 Level is 2 which can't be unlocked at all).
6955 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6956 @end deffn
6957 @end deffn
6958
6959 @deffn {Flash Driver} stm32l4x
6960 All members of the STM32L4, STM32L4+, STM32WB, STM32WL and STM32G4
6961 microcontroller families from STMicroelectronics include internal flash
6962 and use ARM Cortex-M4 cores.
6963 Additionally this driver supports STM32G0 family with ARM Cortex-M0+ core.
6964 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
6965 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
6966
6967 @example
6968 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32l4x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6969 @end example
6970
6971 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
6972 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
6973 the flash driver. However, specifying a wrong value might lead to a completely
6974 wrong flash layout, so this feature must be used carefully.
6975
6976 @example
6977 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32l4x 0x08000000 0x40000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6978 @end example
6979
6980 Some stm32l4x-specific commands are defined:
6981
6982 @deffn Command {stm32l4x lock} num
6983 Locks the entire stm32 device.
6984 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6985 @end deffn
6986
6987 @deffn Command {stm32l4x unlock} num
6988 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
6989 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6990 @end deffn
6991
6992 @deffn Command {stm32l4x mass_erase} num
6993 Mass erases the entire stm32l4x device.
6994 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6995 @end deffn
6996
6997 @deffn Command {stm32l4x option_read} num reg_offset
6998 Reads an option byte register from the stm32l4x device.
6999 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{reg_offset}
7000 is the register offset of the Option byte to read.
7001
7002 For example to read the FLASH_OPTR register:
7003 @example
7004 stm32l4x option_read 0 0x20
7005 # Option Register (for STM32L4x): <0x40022020> = 0xffeff8aa
7006 # Option Register (for STM32WBx): <0x58004020> = ...
7007 # The correct flash base address will be used automatically
7008 @end example
7009
7010 The above example will read out the FLASH_OPTR register which contains the RDP
7011 option byte, Watchdog configuration, BOR level etc.
7012 @end deffn
7013
7014 @deffn Command {stm32l4x option_write} num reg_offset reg_mask
7015 Write an option byte register of the stm32l4x device.
7016 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{reg_offset}
7017 is the register offset of the Option byte to write, and @var{reg_mask} is the mask
7018 to apply when writing the register (only bits with a '1' will be touched).
7019
7020 For example to write the WRP1AR option bytes:
7021 @example
7022 stm32l4x option_write 0 0x28 0x00FF0000 0x00FF00FF
7023 @end example
7024
7025 The above example will write the WRP1AR option register configuring the Write protection
7026 Area A for bank 1. The above example set WRP1AR_END=255, WRP1AR_START=0.
7027 This will effectively write protect all sectors in flash bank 1.
7028 @end deffn
7029
7030 @deffn Command {stm32l4x option_load} num
7031 Forces a re-load of the option byte registers. Will cause a system reset of the device.
7032 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7033 @end deffn
7034 @end deffn
7035
7036 @deffn {Flash Driver} str7x
7037 All members of the STR7 microcontroller family from STMicroelectronics
7038 include internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores.
7039 The @var{str7x} driver defines one mandatory parameter, @var{variant},
7040 which is either @code{STR71x}, @code{STR73x} or @code{STR75x}.
7041
7042 @example
7043 flash bank $_FLASHNAME str7x \
7044 0x40000000 0x00040000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME STR71x
7045 @end example
7046
7047 @deffn Command {str7x disable_jtag} bank
7048 Activate the Debug/Readout protection mechanism
7049 for the specified flash bank.
7050 @end deffn
7051 @end deffn
7052
7053 @deffn {Flash Driver} str9x
7054 Most members of the STR9 microcontroller family from STMicroelectronics
7055 include internal flash and use ARM966E cores.
7056 The str9 needs the flash controller to be configured using
7057 the @command{str9x flash_config} command prior to Flash programming.
7058
7059 @example
7060 flash bank $_FLASHNAME str9x 0x40000000 0x00040000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7061 str9x flash_config 0 4 2 0 0x80000
7062 @end example
7063
7064 @deffn Command {str9x flash_config} num bbsr nbbsr bbadr nbbadr
7065 Configures the str9 flash controller.
7066 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7067
7068 @itemize @bullet
7069 @item @var{bbsr} - Boot Bank Size register
7070 @item @var{nbbsr} - Non Boot Bank Size register
7071 @item @var{bbadr} - Boot Bank Start Address register
7072 @item @var{nbbadr} - Boot Bank Start Address register
7073 @end itemize
7074 @end deffn
7075
7076 @end deffn
7077
7078 @deffn {Flash Driver} str9xpec
7079 @cindex str9xpec
7080
7081 Only use this driver for locking/unlocking the device or configuring the option bytes.
7082 Use the standard str9 driver for programming.
7083 Before using the flash commands the turbo mode must be enabled using the
7084 @command{str9xpec enable_turbo} command.
7085
7086 Here is some background info to help
7087 you better understand how this driver works. OpenOCD has two flash drivers for
7088 the str9:
7089 @enumerate
7090 @item
7091 Standard driver @option{str9x} programmed via the str9 core. Normally used for
7092 flash programming as it is faster than the @option{str9xpec} driver.
7093 @item
7094 Direct programming @option{str9xpec} using the flash controller. This is an
7095 ISC compliant (IEEE 1532) tap connected in series with the str9 core. The str9
7096 core does not need to be running to program using this flash driver. Typical use
7097 for this driver is locking/unlocking the target and programming the option bytes.
7098 @end enumerate
7099
7100 Before we run any commands using the @option{str9xpec} driver we must first disable
7101 the str9 core. This example assumes the @option{str9xpec} driver has been
7102 configured for flash bank 0.
7103 @example
7104 # assert srst, we do not want core running
7105 # while accessing str9xpec flash driver
7106 adapter assert srst
7107 # turn off target polling
7108 poll off
7109 # disable str9 core
7110 str9xpec enable_turbo 0
7111 # read option bytes
7112 str9xpec options_read 0
7113 # re-enable str9 core
7114 str9xpec disable_turbo 0
7115 poll on
7116 reset halt
7117 @end example
7118 The above example will read the str9 option bytes.
7119 When performing a unlock remember that you will not be able to halt the str9 - it
7120 has been locked. Halting the core is not required for the @option{str9xpec} driver
7121 as mentioned above, just issue the commands above manually or from a telnet prompt.
7122
7123 Several str9xpec-specific commands are defined:
7124
7125 @deffn Command {str9xpec disable_turbo} num
7126 Restore the str9 into JTAG chain.
7127 @end deffn
7128
7129 @deffn Command {str9xpec enable_turbo} num
7130 Enable turbo mode, will simply remove the str9 from the chain and talk
7131 directly to the embedded flash controller.
7132 @end deffn
7133
7134 @deffn Command {str9xpec lock} num
7135 Lock str9 device. The str9 will only respond to an unlock command that will
7136 erase the device.
7137 @end deffn
7138
7139 @deffn Command {str9xpec part_id} num
7140 Prints the part identifier for bank @var{num}.
7141 @end deffn
7142
7143 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_cmap} num (@option{bank0}|@option{bank1})
7144 Configure str9 boot bank.
7145 @end deffn
7146
7147 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_lvdsel} num (@option{vdd}|@option{vdd_vddq})
7148 Configure str9 lvd source.
7149 @end deffn
7150
7151 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_lvdthd} num (@option{2.4v}|@option{2.7v})
7152 Configure str9 lvd threshold.
7153 @end deffn
7154
7155 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_lvdwarn} bank (@option{vdd}|@option{vdd_vddq})
7156 Configure str9 lvd reset warning source.
7157 @end deffn
7158
7159 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_read} num
7160 Read str9 option bytes.
7161 @end deffn
7162
7163 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_write} num
7164 Write str9 option bytes.
7165 @end deffn
7166
7167 @deffn Command {str9xpec unlock} num
7168 unlock str9 device.
7169 @end deffn
7170
7171 @end deffn
7172
7173 @deffn {Flash Driver} swm050
7174 @cindex swm050
7175 All members of the swm050 microcontroller family from Foshan Synwit Tech.
7176
7177 @example
7178 flash bank $_FLASHNAME swm050 0x0 0x2000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7179 @end example
7180
7181 One swm050-specific command is defined:
7182
7183 @deffn Command {swm050 mass_erase} bank_id
7184 Erases the entire flash bank.
7185 @end deffn
7186
7187 @end deffn
7188
7189
7190 @deffn {Flash Driver} tms470
7191 Most members of the TMS470 microcontroller family from Texas Instruments
7192 include internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores.
7193 This driver doesn't require the chip and bus width to be specified.
7194
7195 Some tms470-specific commands are defined:
7196
7197 @deffn Command {tms470 flash_keyset} key0 key1 key2 key3
7198 Saves programming keys in a register, to enable flash erase and write commands.
7199 @end deffn
7200
7201 @deffn Command {tms470 osc_mhz} clock_mhz
7202 Reports the clock speed, which is used to calculate timings.
7203 @end deffn
7204
7205 @deffn Command {tms470 plldis} (0|1)
7206 Disables (@var{1}) or enables (@var{0}) use of the PLL to speed up
7207 the flash clock.
7208 @end deffn
7209 @end deffn
7210
7211 @deffn {Flash Driver} w600
7212 W60x series Wi-Fi SoC from WinnerMicro
7213 are designed with ARM Cortex-M3 and have 1M Byte QFLASH inside.
7214 The @var{w600} driver uses the @var{target} parameter to select the
7215 correct bank config.
7216
7217 @example
7218 flash bank $_FLASHNAME w600 0x08000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAMEs
7219 @end example
7220 @end deffn
7221
7222 @deffn {Flash Driver} xmc1xxx
7223 All members of the XMC1xxx microcontroller family from Infineon.
7224 This driver does not require the chip and bus width to be specified.
7225 @end deffn
7226
7227 @deffn {Flash Driver} xmc4xxx
7228 All members of the XMC4xxx microcontroller family from Infineon.
7229 This driver does not require the chip and bus width to be specified.
7230
7231 Some xmc4xxx-specific commands are defined:
7232
7233 @deffn Command {xmc4xxx flash_password} bank_id passwd1 passwd2
7234 Saves flash protection passwords which are used to lock the user flash
7235 @end deffn
7236
7237 @deffn Command {xmc4xxx flash_unprotect} bank_id user_level[0-1]
7238 Removes Flash write protection from the selected user bank
7239 @end deffn
7240
7241 @end deffn
7242
7243 @section NAND Flash Commands
7244 @cindex NAND
7245
7246 Compared to NOR or SPI flash, NAND devices are inexpensive
7247 and high density. Today's NAND chips, and multi-chip modules,
7248 commonly hold multiple GigaBytes of data.
7249
7250 NAND chips consist of a number of ``erase blocks'' of a given
7251 size (such as 128 KBytes), each of which is divided into a
7252 number of pages (of perhaps 512 or 2048 bytes each). Each
7253 page of a NAND flash has an ``out of band'' (OOB) area to hold
7254 Error Correcting Code (ECC) and other metadata, usually 16 bytes
7255 of OOB for every 512 bytes of page data.
7256
7257 One key characteristic of NAND flash is that its error rate
7258 is higher than that of NOR flash. In normal operation, that
7259 ECC is used to correct and detect errors. However, NAND
7260 blocks can also wear out and become unusable; those blocks
7261 are then marked "bad". NAND chips are even shipped from the
7262 manufacturer with a few bad blocks. The highest density chips
7263 use a technology (MLC) that wears out more quickly, so ECC
7264 support is increasingly important as a way to detect blocks
7265 that have begun to fail, and help to preserve data integrity
7266 with techniques such as wear leveling.
7267
7268 Software is used to manage the ECC. Some controllers don't
7269 support ECC directly; in those cases, software ECC is used.
7270 Other controllers speed up the ECC calculations with hardware.
7271 Single-bit error correction hardware is routine. Controllers
7272 geared for newer MLC chips may correct 4 or more errors for
7273 every 512 bytes of data.
7274
7275 You will need to make sure that any data you write using
7276 OpenOCD includes the appropriate kind of ECC. For example,
7277 that may mean passing the @code{oob_softecc} flag when
7278 writing NAND data, or ensuring that the correct hardware
7279 ECC mode is used.
7280
7281 The basic steps for using NAND devices include:
7282 @enumerate
7283 @item Declare via the command @command{nand device}
7284 @* Do this in a board-specific configuration file,
7285 passing parameters as needed by the controller.
7286 @item Configure each device using @command{nand probe}.
7287 @* Do this only after the associated target is set up,
7288 such as in its reset-init script or in procures defined
7289 to access that device.
7290 @item Operate on the flash via @command{nand subcommand}
7291 @* Often commands to manipulate the flash are typed by a human, or run
7292 via a script in some automated way. Common task include writing a
7293 boot loader, operating system, or other data needed to initialize or
7294 de-brick a board.
7295 @end enumerate
7296
7297 @b{NOTE:} At the time this text was written, the largest NAND
7298 flash fully supported by OpenOCD is 2 GiBytes (16 GiBits).
7299 This is because the variables used to hold offsets and lengths
7300 are only 32 bits wide.
7301 (Larger chips may work in some cases, unless an offset or length
7302 is larger than 0xffffffff, the largest 32-bit unsigned integer.)
7303 Some larger devices will work, since they are actually multi-chip
7304 modules with two smaller chips and individual chipselect lines.
7305
7306 @anchor{nandconfiguration}
7307 @subsection NAND Configuration Commands
7308 @cindex NAND configuration
7309
7310 NAND chips must be declared in configuration scripts,
7311 plus some additional configuration that's done after
7312 OpenOCD has initialized.
7313
7314 @deffn {Config Command} {nand device} name driver target [configparams...]
7315 Declares a NAND device, which can be read and written to
7316 after it has been configured through @command{nand probe}.
7317 In OpenOCD, devices are single chips; this is unlike some
7318 operating systems, which may manage multiple chips as if
7319 they were a single (larger) device.
7320 In some cases, configuring a device will activate extra
7321 commands; see the controller-specific documentation.
7322
7323 @b{NOTE:} This command is not available after OpenOCD
7324 initialization has completed. Use it in board specific
7325 configuration files, not interactively.
7326
7327 @itemize @bullet
7328 @item @var{name} ... may be used to reference the NAND bank
7329 in most other NAND commands. A number is also available.
7330 @item @var{driver} ... identifies the NAND controller driver
7331 associated with the NAND device being declared.
7332 @xref{nanddriverlist,,NAND Driver List}.
7333 @item @var{target} ... names the target used when issuing
7334 commands to the NAND controller.
7335 @comment Actually, it's currently a controller-specific parameter...
7336 @item @var{configparams} ... controllers may support, or require,
7337 additional parameters. See the controller-specific documentation
7338 for more information.
7339 @end itemize
7340 @end deffn
7341
7342 @deffn Command {nand list}
7343 Prints a summary of each device declared
7344 using @command{nand device}, numbered from zero.
7345 Note that un-probed devices show no details.
7346 @example
7347 > nand list
7348 #0: NAND 1GiB 3,3V 8-bit (Micron) pagesize: 2048, buswidth: 8,
7349 blocksize: 131072, blocks: 8192
7350 #1: NAND 1GiB 3,3V 8-bit (Micron) pagesize: 2048, buswidth: 8,
7351 blocksize: 131072, blocks: 8192
7352 >
7353 @end example
7354 @end deffn
7355
7356 @deffn Command {nand probe} num
7357 Probes the specified device to determine key characteristics
7358 like its page and block sizes, and how many blocks it has.
7359 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7360 You must (successfully) probe a device before you can use
7361 it with most other NAND commands.
7362 @end deffn
7363
7364 @subsection Erasing, Reading, Writing to NAND Flash
7365
7366 @deffn Command {nand dump} num filename offset length [oob_option]
7367 @cindex NAND reading
7368 Reads binary data from the NAND device and writes it to the file,
7369 starting at the specified offset.
7370 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7371
7372 Use a complete path name for @var{filename}, so you don't depend
7373 on the directory used to start the OpenOCD server.
7374
7375 The @var{offset} and @var{length} must be exact multiples of the
7376 device's page size. They describe a data region; the OOB data
7377 associated with each such page may also be accessed.
7378
7379 @b{NOTE:} At the time this text was written, no error correction
7380 was done on the data that's read, unless raw access was disabled
7381 and the underlying NAND controller driver had a @code{read_page}
7382 method which handled that error correction.
7383
7384 By default, only page data is saved to the specified file.
7385 Use an @var{oob_option} parameter to save OOB data:
7386 @itemize @bullet
7387 @item no oob_* parameter
7388 @*Output file holds only page data; OOB is discarded.
7389 @item @code{oob_raw}
7390 @*Output file interleaves page data and OOB data;
7391 the file will be longer than "length" by the size of the
7392 spare areas associated with each data page.
7393 Note that this kind of "raw" access is different from
7394 what's implied by @command{nand raw_access}, which just
7395 controls whether a hardware-aware access method is used.
7396 @item @code{oob_only}
7397 @*Output file has only raw OOB data, and will
7398 be smaller than "length" since it will contain only the
7399 spare areas associated with each data page.
7400 @end itemize
7401 @end deffn
7402
7403 @deffn Command {nand erase} num [offset length]
7404 @cindex NAND erasing
7405 @cindex NAND programming
7406 Erases blocks on the specified NAND device, starting at the
7407 specified @var{offset} and continuing for @var{length} bytes.
7408 Both of those values must be exact multiples of the device's
7409 block size, and the region they specify must fit entirely in the chip.
7410 If those parameters are not specified,
7411 the whole NAND chip will be erased.
7412 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7413
7414 @b{NOTE:} This command will try to erase bad blocks, when told
7415 to do so, which will probably invalidate the manufacturer's bad
7416 block marker.
7417 For the remainder of the current server session, @command{nand info}
7418 will still report that the block ``is'' bad.
7419 @end deffn
7420
7421 @deffn Command {nand write} num filename offset [option...]
7422 @cindex NAND writing
7423 @cindex NAND programming
7424 Writes binary data from the file into the specified NAND device,
7425 starting at the specified offset. Those pages should already
7426 have been erased; you can't change zero bits to one bits.
7427 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7428
7429 Use a complete path name for @var{filename}, so you don't depend
7430 on the directory used to start the OpenOCD server.
7431
7432 The @var{offset} must be an exact multiple of the device's page size.
7433 All data in the file will be written, assuming it doesn't run
7434 past the end of the device.
7435 Only full pages are written, and any extra space in the last
7436 page will be filled with 0xff bytes. (That includes OOB data,
7437 if that's being written.)
7438
7439 @b{NOTE:} At the time this text was written, bad blocks are
7440 ignored. That is, this routine will not skip bad blocks,
7441 but will instead try to write them. This can cause problems.
7442
7443 Provide at most one @var{option} parameter. With some
7444 NAND drivers, the meanings of these parameters may change
7445 if @command{nand raw_access} was used to disable hardware ECC.
7446 @itemize @bullet
7447 @item no oob_* parameter
7448 @*File has only page data, which is written.
7449 If raw access is in use, the OOB area will not be written.
7450 Otherwise, if the underlying NAND controller driver has
7451 a @code{write_page} routine, that routine may write the OOB
7452 with hardware-computed ECC data.
7453 @item @code{oob_only}
7454 @*File has only raw OOB data, which is written to the OOB area.
7455 Each page's data area stays untouched. @i{This can be a dangerous
7456 option}, since it can invalidate the ECC data.
7457 You may need to force raw access to use this mode.
7458 @item @code{oob_raw}
7459 @*File interleaves data and OOB data, both of which are written
7460 If raw access is enabled, the data is written first, then the
7461 un-altered OOB.
7462 Otherwise, if the underlying NAND controller driver has
7463 a @code{write_page} routine, that routine may modify the OOB
7464 before it's written, to include hardware-computed ECC data.
7465 @item @code{oob_softecc}
7466 @*File has only page data, which is written.
7467 The OOB area is filled with 0xff, except for a standard 1-bit
7468 software ECC code stored in conventional locations.
7469 You might need to force raw access to use this mode, to prevent
7470 the underlying driver from applying hardware ECC.
7471 @item @code{oob_softecc_kw}
7472 @*File has only page data, which is written.
7473 The OOB area is filled with 0xff, except for a 4-bit software ECC
7474 specific to the boot ROM in Marvell Kirkwood SoCs.
7475 You might need to force raw access to use this mode, to prevent
7476 the underlying driver from applying hardware ECC.
7477 @end itemize
7478 @end deffn
7479
7480 @deffn Command {nand verify} num filename offset [option...]
7481 @cindex NAND verification
7482 @cindex NAND programming
7483 Verify the binary data in the file has been programmed to the
7484 specified NAND device, starting at the specified offset.
7485 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7486
7487 Use a complete path name for @var{filename}, so you don't depend
7488 on the directory used to start the OpenOCD server.
7489
7490 The @var{offset} must be an exact multiple of the device's page size.
7491 All data in the file will be read and compared to the contents of the
7492 flash, assuming it doesn't run past the end of the device.
7493 As with @command{nand write}, only full pages are verified, so any extra
7494 space in the last page will be filled with 0xff bytes.
7495
7496 The same @var{options} accepted by @command{nand write},
7497 and the file will be processed similarly to produce the buffers that
7498 can be compared against the contents produced from @command{nand dump}.
7499
7500 @b{NOTE:} This will not work when the underlying NAND controller
7501 driver's @code{write_page} routine must update the OOB with a
7502 hardware-computed ECC before the data is written. This limitation may
7503 be removed in a future release.
7504 @end deffn
7505
7506 @subsection Other NAND commands
7507 @cindex NAND other commands
7508
7509 @deffn Command {nand check_bad_blocks} num [offset length]
7510 Checks for manufacturer bad block markers on the specified NAND
7511 device. If no parameters are provided, checks the whole
7512 device; otherwise, starts at the specified @var{offset} and
7513 continues for @var{length} bytes.
7514 Both of those values must be exact multiples of the device's
7515 block size, and the region they specify must fit entirely in the chip.
7516 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7517
7518 @b{NOTE:} Before using this command you should force raw access
7519 with @command{nand raw_access enable} to ensure that the underlying
7520 driver will not try to apply hardware ECC.
7521 @end deffn
7522
7523 @deffn Command {nand info} num
7524 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7525 This prints the one-line summary from "nand list", plus for
7526 devices which have been probed this also prints any known
7527 status for each block.
7528 @end deffn
7529
7530 @deffn Command {nand raw_access} num (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
7531 Sets or clears an flag affecting how page I/O is done.
7532 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7533
7534 This flag is cleared (disabled) by default, but changing that
7535 value won't affect all NAND devices. The key factor is whether
7536 the underlying driver provides @code{read_page} or @code{write_page}
7537 methods. If it doesn't provide those methods, the setting of
7538 this flag is irrelevant; all access is effectively ``raw''.
7539
7540 When those methods exist, they are normally used when reading
7541 data (@command{nand dump} or reading bad block markers) or
7542 writing it (@command{nand write}). However, enabling
7543 raw access (setting the flag) prevents use of those methods,
7544 bypassing hardware ECC logic.
7545 @i{This can be a dangerous option}, since writing blocks
7546 with the wrong ECC data can cause them to be marked as bad.
7547 @end deffn
7548
7549 @anchor{nanddriverlist}
7550 @subsection NAND Driver List
7551 As noted above, the @command{nand device} command allows
7552 driver-specific options and behaviors.
7553 Some controllers also activate controller-specific commands.
7554
7555 @deffn {NAND Driver} at91sam9
7556 This driver handles the NAND controllers found on AT91SAM9 family chips from
7557 Atmel. It takes two extra parameters: address of the NAND chip;
7558 address of the ECC controller.
7559 @example
7560 nand device $NANDFLASH at91sam9 $CHIPNAME 0x40000000 0xfffffe800
7561 @end example
7562 AT91SAM9 chips support single-bit ECC hardware. The @code{write_page} and
7563 @code{read_page} methods are used to utilize the ECC hardware unless they are
7564 disabled by using the @command{nand raw_access} command. There are four
7565 additional commands that are needed to fully configure the AT91SAM9 NAND
7566 controller. Two are optional; most boards use the same wiring for ALE/CLE:
7567 @deffn Command {at91sam9 cle} num addr_line
7568 Configure the address line used for latching commands. The @var{num}
7569 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7570 @end deffn
7571 @deffn Command {at91sam9 ale} num addr_line
7572 Configure the address line used for latching addresses. The @var{num}
7573 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7574 @end deffn
7575
7576 For the next two commands, it is assumed that the pins have already been
7577 properly configured for input or output.
7578 @deffn Command {at91sam9 rdy_busy} num pio_base_addr pin
7579 Configure the RDY/nBUSY input from the NAND device. The @var{num}
7580 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}. @var{pio_base_addr}
7581 is the base address of the PIO controller and @var{pin} is the pin number.
7582 @end deffn
7583 @deffn Command {at91sam9 ce} num pio_base_addr pin
7584 Configure the chip enable input to the NAND device. The @var{num}
7585 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}. @var{pio_base_addr}
7586 is the base address of the PIO controller and @var{pin} is the pin number.
7587 @end deffn
7588 @end deffn
7589
7590 @deffn {NAND Driver} davinci
7591 This driver handles the NAND controllers found on DaVinci family
7592 chips from Texas Instruments.
7593 It takes three extra parameters:
7594 address of the NAND chip;
7595 hardware ECC mode to use (@option{hwecc1},
7596 @option{hwecc4}, @option{hwecc4_infix});
7597 address of the AEMIF controller on this processor.
7598 @example
7599 nand device davinci dm355.arm 0x02000000 hwecc4 0x01e10000
7600 @end example
7601 All DaVinci processors support the single-bit ECC hardware,
7602 and newer ones also support the four-bit ECC hardware.
7603 The @code{write_page} and @code{read_page} methods are used
7604 to implement those ECC modes, unless they are disabled using
7605 the @command{nand raw_access} command.
7606 @end deffn
7607
7608 @deffn {NAND Driver} lpc3180
7609 These controllers require an extra @command{nand device}
7610 parameter: the clock rate used by the controller.
7611 @deffn Command {lpc3180 select} num [mlc|slc]
7612 Configures use of the MLC or SLC controller mode.
7613 MLC implies use of hardware ECC.
7614 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7615 @end deffn
7616
7617 At this writing, this driver includes @code{write_page}
7618 and @code{read_page} methods. Using @command{nand raw_access}
7619 to disable those methods will prevent use of hardware ECC
7620 in the MLC controller mode, but won't change SLC behavior.
7621 @end deffn
7622 @comment current lpc3180 code won't issue 5-byte address cycles
7623
7624 @deffn {NAND Driver} mx3
7625 This driver handles the NAND controller in i.MX31. The mxc driver
7626 should work for this chip as well.
7627 @end deffn
7628
7629 @deffn {NAND Driver} mxc
7630 This driver handles the NAND controller found in Freescale i.MX
7631 chips. It has support for v1 (i.MX27 and i.MX31) and v2 (i.MX35).
7632 The driver takes 3 extra arguments, chip (@option{mx27},
7633 @option{mx31}, @option{mx35}), ecc (@option{noecc}, @option{hwecc})
7634 and optionally if bad block information should be swapped between
7635 main area and spare area (@option{biswap}), defaults to off.
7636 @example
7637 nand device mx35.nand mxc imx35.cpu mx35 hwecc biswap
7638 @end example
7639 @deffn Command {mxc biswap} bank_num [enable|disable]
7640 Turns on/off bad block information swapping from main area,
7641 without parameter query status.
7642 @end deffn
7643 @end deffn
7644
7645 @deffn {NAND Driver} orion
7646 These controllers require an extra @command{nand device}
7647 parameter: the address of the controller.
7648 @example
7649 nand device orion 0xd8000000
7650 @end example
7651 These controllers don't define any specialized commands.
7652 At this writing, their drivers don't include @code{write_page}
7653 or @code{read_page} methods, so @command{nand raw_access} won't
7654 change any behavior.
7655 @end deffn
7656
7657 @deffn {NAND Driver} s3c2410
7658 @deffnx {NAND Driver} s3c2412
7659 @deffnx {NAND Driver} s3c2440
7660 @deffnx {NAND Driver} s3c2443
7661 @deffnx {NAND Driver} s3c6400
7662 These S3C family controllers don't have any special
7663 @command{nand device} options, and don't define any
7664 specialized commands.
7665 At this writing, their drivers don't include @code{write_page}
7666 or @code{read_page} methods, so @command{nand raw_access} won't
7667 change any behavior.
7668 @end deffn
7669
7670 @node Flash Programming
7671 @chapter Flash Programming
7672
7673 OpenOCD implements numerous ways to program the target flash, whether internal or external.
7674 Programming can be achieved by either using @ref{programmingusinggdb,,Programming using GDB},
7675 or using the commands given in @ref{flashprogrammingcommands,,Flash Programming Commands}.
7676
7677 @*To simplify using the flash commands directly a jimtcl script is available that handles the programming and verify stage.
7678 OpenOCD will program/verify/reset the target and optionally shutdown.
7679
7680 The script is executed as follows and by default the following actions will be performed.
7681 @enumerate
7682 @item 'init' is executed.
7683 @item 'reset init' is called to reset and halt the target, any 'reset init' scripts are executed.
7684 @item @code{flash write_image} is called to erase and write any flash using the filename given.
7685 @item If the @option{preverify} parameter is given, the target is "verified" first and only flashed if this fails.
7686 @item @code{verify_image} is called if @option{verify} parameter is given.
7687 @item @code{reset run} is called if @option{reset} parameter is given.
7688 @item OpenOCD is shutdown if @option{exit} parameter is given.
7689 @end enumerate
7690
7691 An example of usage is given below. @xref{program}.
7692
7693 @example
7694 # program and verify using elf/hex/s19. verify and reset
7695 # are optional parameters
7696 openocd -f board/stm32f3discovery.cfg \
7697 -c "program filename.elf verify reset exit"
7698
7699 # binary files need the flash address passing
7700 openocd -f board/stm32f3discovery.cfg \
7701 -c "program filename.bin exit 0x08000000"
7702 @end example
7703
7704 @node PLD/FPGA Commands
7705 @chapter PLD/FPGA Commands
7706 @cindex PLD
7707 @cindex FPGA
7708
7709 Programmable Logic Devices (PLDs) and the more flexible
7710 Field Programmable Gate Arrays (FPGAs) are both types of programmable hardware.
7711 OpenOCD can support programming them.
7712 Although PLDs are generally restrictive (cells are less functional, and
7713 there are no special purpose cells for memory or computational tasks),
7714 they share the same OpenOCD infrastructure.
7715 Accordingly, both are called PLDs here.
7716
7717 @section PLD/FPGA Configuration and Commands
7718
7719 As it does for JTAG TAPs, debug targets, and flash chips (both NOR and NAND),
7720 OpenOCD maintains a list of PLDs available for use in various commands.
7721 Also, each such PLD requires a driver.
7722
7723 They are referenced by the number shown by the @command{pld devices} command,
7724 and new PLDs are defined by @command{pld device driver_name}.
7725
7726 @deffn {Config Command} {pld device} driver_name tap_name [driver_options]
7727 Defines a new PLD device, supported by driver @var{driver_name},
7728 using the TAP named @var{tap_name}.
7729 The driver may make use of any @var{driver_options} to configure its
7730 behavior.
7731 @end deffn
7732
7733 @deffn {Command} {pld devices}
7734 Lists the PLDs and their numbers.
7735 @end deffn
7736
7737 @deffn {Command} {pld load} num filename
7738 Loads the file @file{filename} into the PLD identified by @var{num}.
7739 The file format must be inferred by the driver.
7740 @end deffn
7741
7742 @section PLD/FPGA Drivers, Options, and Commands
7743
7744 Drivers may support PLD-specific options to the @command{pld device}
7745 definition command, and may also define commands usable only with
7746 that particular type of PLD.
7747
7748 @deffn {FPGA Driver} virtex2 [no_jstart]
7749 Virtex-II is a family of FPGAs sold by Xilinx.
7750 It supports the IEEE 1532 standard for In-System Configuration (ISC).
7751
7752 If @var{no_jstart} is non-zero, the JSTART instruction is not used after
7753 loading the bitstream. While required for Series2, Series3, and Series6, it
7754 breaks bitstream loading on Series7.
7755
7756 @deffn {Command} {virtex2 read_stat} num
7757 Reads and displays the Virtex-II status register (STAT)
7758 for FPGA @var{num}.
7759 @end deffn
7760 @end deffn
7761
7762 @node General Commands
7763 @chapter General Commands
7764 @cindex commands
7765
7766 The commands documented in this chapter here are common commands that
7767 you, as a human, may want to type and see the output of. Configuration type
7768 commands are documented elsewhere.
7769
7770 Intent:
7771 @itemize @bullet
7772 @item @b{Source Of Commands}
7773 @* OpenOCD commands can occur in a configuration script (discussed
7774 elsewhere) or typed manually by a human or supplied programmatically,
7775 or via one of several TCP/IP Ports.
7776
7777 @item @b{From the human}
7778 @* A human should interact with the telnet interface (default port: 4444)
7779 or via GDB (default port 3333).
7780
7781 To issue commands from within a GDB session, use the @option{monitor}
7782 command, e.g. use @option{monitor poll} to issue the @option{poll}
7783 command. All output is relayed through the GDB session.
7784
7785 @item @b{Machine Interface}
7786 The Tcl interface's intent is to be a machine interface. The default Tcl
7787 port is 5555.
7788 @end itemize
7789
7790
7791 @section Server Commands
7792
7793 @deffn {Command} exit
7794 Exits the current telnet session.
7795 @end deffn
7796
7797 @deffn {Command} help [string]
7798 With no parameters, prints help text for all commands.
7799 Otherwise, prints each helptext containing @var{string}.
7800 Not every command provides helptext.
7801
7802 Configuration commands, and commands valid at any time, are
7803 explicitly noted in parenthesis.
7804 In most cases, no such restriction is listed; this indicates commands
7805 which are only available after the configuration stage has completed.
7806 @end deffn
7807
7808 @deffn Command sleep msec [@option{busy}]
7809 Wait for at least @var{msec} milliseconds before resuming.
7810 If @option{busy} is passed, busy-wait instead of sleeping.
7811 (This option is strongly discouraged.)
7812 Useful in connection with script files
7813 (@command{script} command and @command{target_name} configuration).
7814 @end deffn
7815
7816 @deffn Command shutdown [@option{error}]
7817 Close the OpenOCD server, disconnecting all clients (GDB, telnet,
7818 other). If option @option{error} is used, OpenOCD will return a
7819 non-zero exit code to the parent process.
7820
7821 Like any TCL commands, also @command{shutdown} can be redefined, e.g.:
7822 @example
7823 # redefine shutdown
7824 rename shutdown original_shutdown
7825 proc shutdown @{@} @{
7826 puts "This is my implementation of shutdown"
7827 # my own stuff before exit OpenOCD
7828 original_shutdown
7829 @}
7830 @end example
7831 If user types CTRL-C or kills OpenOCD, either the command @command{shutdown}
7832 or its replacement will be automatically executed before OpenOCD exits.
7833 @end deffn
7834
7835 @anchor{debuglevel}
7836 @deffn Command debug_level [n]
7837 @cindex message level
7838 Display debug level.
7839 If @var{n} (from 0..4) is provided, then set it to that level.
7840 This affects the kind of messages sent to the server log.
7841 Level 0 is error messages only;
7842 level 1 adds warnings;
7843 level 2 adds informational messages;
7844 level 3 adds debugging messages;
7845 and level 4 adds verbose low-level debug messages.
7846 The default is level 2, but that can be overridden on
7847 the command line along with the location of that log
7848 file (which is normally the server's standard output).
7849 @xref{Running}.
7850 @end deffn
7851
7852 @deffn Command echo [-n] message
7853 Logs a message at "user" priority.
7854 Output @var{message} to stdout.
7855 Option "-n" suppresses trailing newline.
7856 @example
7857 echo "Downloading kernel -- please wait"
7858 @end example
7859 @end deffn
7860
7861 @deffn Command log_output [filename | "default"]
7862 Redirect logging to @var{filename} or set it back to default output;
7863 the default log output channel is stderr.
7864 @end deffn
7865
7866 @deffn Command add_script_search_dir [directory]
7867 Add @var{directory} to the file/script search path.
7868 @end deffn
7869
7870 @deffn Command bindto [@var{name}]
7871 Specify hostname or IPv4 address on which to listen for incoming
7872 TCP/IP connections. By default, OpenOCD will listen on the loopback
7873 interface only. If your network environment is safe, @code{bindto
7874 0.0.0.0} can be used to cover all available interfaces.
7875 @end deffn
7876
7877 @anchor{targetstatehandling}
7878 @section Target State handling
7879 @cindex reset
7880 @cindex halt
7881 @cindex target initialization
7882
7883 In this section ``target'' refers to a CPU configured as
7884 shown earlier (@pxref{CPU Configuration}).
7885 These commands, like many, implicitly refer to
7886 a current target which is used to perform the
7887 various operations. The current target may be changed
7888 by using @command{targets} command with the name of the
7889 target which should become current.
7890
7891 @deffn Command reg [(number|name) [(value|'force')]]
7892 Access a single register by @var{number} or by its @var{name}.
7893 The target must generally be halted before access to CPU core
7894 registers is allowed. Depending on the hardware, some other
7895 registers may be accessible while the target is running.
7896
7897 @emph{With no arguments}:
7898 list all available registers for the current target,
7899 showing number, name, size, value, and cache status.
7900 For valid entries, a value is shown; valid entries
7901 which are also dirty (and will be written back later)
7902 are flagged as such.
7903
7904 @emph{With number/name}: display that register's value.
7905 Use @var{force} argument to read directly from the target,
7906 bypassing any internal cache.
7907
7908 @emph{With both number/name and value}: set register's value.
7909 Writes may be held in a writeback cache internal to OpenOCD,
7910 so that setting the value marks the register as dirty instead
7911 of immediately flushing that value. Resuming CPU execution
7912 (including by single stepping) or otherwise activating the
7913 relevant module will flush such values.
7914
7915 Cores may have surprisingly many registers in their
7916 Debug and trace infrastructure:
7917
7918 @example
7919 > reg
7920 ===== ARM registers
7921 (0) r0 (/32): 0x0000D3C2 (dirty)
7922 (1) r1 (/32): 0xFD61F31C
7923 (2) r2 (/32)
7924 ...
7925 (164) ETM_contextid_comparator_mask (/32)
7926 >
7927 @end example
7928 @end deffn
7929
7930 @deffn Command halt [ms]
7931 @deffnx Command wait_halt [ms]
7932 The @command{halt} command first sends a halt request to the target,
7933 which @command{wait_halt} doesn't.
7934 Otherwise these behave the same: wait up to @var{ms} milliseconds,
7935 or 5 seconds if there is no parameter, for the target to halt
7936 (and enter debug mode).
7937 Using 0 as the @var{ms} parameter prevents OpenOCD from waiting.
7938
7939 @quotation Warning
7940 On ARM cores, software using the @emph{wait for interrupt} operation
7941 often blocks the JTAG access needed by a @command{halt} command.
7942 This is because that operation also puts the core into a low
7943 power mode by gating the core clock;
7944 but the core clock is needed to detect JTAG clock transitions.
7945
7946 One partial workaround uses adaptive clocking: when the core is
7947 interrupted the operation completes, then JTAG clocks are accepted
7948 at least until the interrupt handler completes.
7949 However, this workaround is often unusable since the processor, board,
7950 and JTAG adapter must all support adaptive JTAG clocking.
7951 Also, it can't work until an interrupt is issued.
7952
7953 A more complete workaround is to not use that operation while you
7954 work with a JTAG debugger.
7955 Tasking environments generally have idle loops where the body is the
7956 @emph{wait for interrupt} operation.
7957 (On older cores, it is a coprocessor action;
7958 newer cores have a @option{wfi} instruction.)
7959 Such loops can just remove that operation, at the cost of higher
7960 power consumption (because the CPU is needlessly clocked).
7961 @end quotation
7962
7963 @end deffn
7964
7965 @deffn Command resume [address]
7966 Resume the target at its current code position,
7967 or the optional @var{address} if it is provided.
7968 OpenOCD will wait 5 seconds for the target to resume.
7969 @end deffn
7970
7971 @deffn Command step [address]
7972 Single-step the target at its current code position,
7973 or the optional @var{address} if it is provided.
7974 @end deffn
7975
7976 @anchor{resetcommand}
7977 @deffn Command reset
7978 @deffnx Command {reset run}
7979 @deffnx Command {reset halt}
7980 @deffnx Command {reset init}
7981 Perform as hard a reset as possible, using SRST if possible.
7982 @emph{All defined targets will be reset, and target
7983 events will fire during the reset sequence.}
7984
7985 The optional parameter specifies what should
7986 happen after the reset.
7987 If there is no parameter, a @command{reset run} is executed.
7988 The other options will not work on all systems.
7989 @xref{Reset Configuration}.
7990
7991 @itemize @minus
7992 @item @b{run} Let the target run
7993 @item @b{halt} Immediately halt the target
7994 @item @b{init} Immediately halt the target, and execute the reset-init script
7995 @end itemize
7996 @end deffn
7997
7998 @deffn Command soft_reset_halt
7999 Requesting target halt and executing a soft reset. This is often used
8000 when a target cannot be reset and halted. The target, after reset is
8001 released begins to execute code. OpenOCD attempts to stop the CPU and
8002 then sets the program counter back to the reset vector. Unfortunately
8003 the code that was executed may have left the hardware in an unknown
8004 state.
8005 @end deffn
8006
8007 @deffn Command {adapter assert} [signal [assert|deassert signal]]
8008 @deffnx Command {adapter deassert} [signal [assert|deassert signal]]
8009 Set values of reset signals.
8010 Without parameters returns current status of the signals.
8011 The @var{signal} parameter values may be
8012 @option{srst}, indicating that srst signal is to be asserted or deasserted,
8013 @option{trst}, indicating that trst signal is to be asserted or deasserted.
8014
8015 The @command{reset_config} command should already have been used
8016 to configure how the board and the adapter treat these two
8017 signals, and to say if either signal is even present.
8018 @xref{Reset Configuration}.
8019 Trying to assert a signal that is not present triggers an error.
8020 If a signal is present on the adapter and not specified in the command,
8021 the signal will not be modified.
8022
8023 @quotation Note
8024 TRST is specially handled.
8025 It actually signifies JTAG's @sc{reset} state.
8026 So if the board doesn't support the optional TRST signal,
8027 or it doesn't support it along with the specified SRST value,
8028 JTAG reset is triggered with TMS and TCK signals
8029 instead of the TRST signal.
8030 And no matter how that JTAG reset is triggered, once
8031 the scan chain enters @sc{reset} with TRST inactive,
8032 TAP @code{post-reset} events are delivered to all TAPs
8033 with handlers for that event.
8034 @end quotation
8035 @end deffn
8036
8037 @section I/O Utilities
8038
8039 These commands are available when
8040 OpenOCD is built with @option{--enable-ioutil}.
8041 They are mainly useful on embedded targets,
8042 notably the ZY1000.
8043 Hosts with operating systems have complementary tools.
8044
8045 @emph{Note:} there are several more such commands.
8046
8047 @deffn Command append_file filename [string]*
8048 Appends the @var{string} parameters to
8049 the text file @file{filename}.
8050 Each string except the last one is followed by one space.
8051 The last string is followed by a newline.
8052 @end deffn
8053
8054 @deffn Command cat filename
8055 Reads and displays the text file @file{filename}.
8056 @end deffn
8057
8058 @deffn Command cp src_filename dest_filename
8059 Copies contents from the file @file{src_filename}
8060 into @file{dest_filename}.
8061 @end deffn
8062
8063 @deffn Command ip
8064 @emph{No description provided.}
8065 @end deffn
8066
8067 @deffn Command ls
8068 @emph{No description provided.}
8069 @end deffn
8070
8071 @deffn Command mac
8072 @emph{No description provided.}
8073 @end deffn
8074
8075 @deffn Command meminfo
8076 Display available RAM memory on OpenOCD host.
8077 Used in OpenOCD regression testing scripts.
8078 @end deffn
8079
8080 @deffn Command peek
8081 @emph{No description provided.}
8082 @end deffn
8083
8084 @deffn Command poke
8085 @emph{No description provided.}
8086 @end deffn
8087
8088 @deffn Command rm filename
8089 @c "rm" has both normal and Jim-level versions??
8090 Unlinks the file @file{filename}.
8091 @end deffn
8092
8093 @deffn Command trunc filename
8094 Removes all data in the file @file{filename}.
8095 @end deffn
8096
8097 @anchor{memoryaccess}
8098 @section Memory access commands
8099 @cindex memory access
8100
8101 These commands allow accesses of a specific size to the memory
8102 system. Often these are used to configure the current target in some
8103 special way. For example - one may need to write certain values to the
8104 SDRAM controller to enable SDRAM.
8105
8106 @enumerate
8107 @item Use the @command{targets} (plural) command
8108 to change the current target.
8109 @item In system level scripts these commands are deprecated.
8110 Please use their TARGET object siblings to avoid making assumptions
8111 about what TAP is the current target, or about MMU configuration.
8112 @end enumerate
8113
8114 @deffn Command mdd [phys] addr [count]
8115 @deffnx Command mdw [phys] addr [count]
8116 @deffnx Command mdh [phys] addr [count]
8117 @deffnx Command mdb [phys] addr [count]
8118 Display contents of address @var{addr}, as
8119 64-bit doublewords (@command{mdd}),
8120 32-bit words (@command{mdw}), 16-bit halfwords (@command{mdh}),
8121 or 8-bit bytes (@command{mdb}).
8122 When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
8123 @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
8124 Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
8125 @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
8126 If @var{count} is specified, displays that many units.
8127 (If you want to manipulate the data instead of displaying it,
8128 see the @code{mem2array} primitives.)
8129 @end deffn
8130
8131 @deffn Command mwd [phys] addr doubleword [count]
8132 @deffnx Command mww [phys] addr word [count]
8133 @deffnx Command mwh [phys] addr halfword [count]
8134 @deffnx Command mwb [phys] addr byte [count]
8135 Writes the specified @var{doubleword} (64 bits), @var{word} (32 bits),
8136 @var{halfword} (16 bits), or @var{byte} (8-bit) value,
8137 at the specified address @var{addr}.
8138 When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
8139 @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
8140 Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
8141 @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
8142 If @var{count} is specified, fills that many units of consecutive address.
8143 @end deffn
8144
8145 @anchor{imageaccess}
8146 @section Image loading commands
8147 @cindex image loading
8148 @cindex image dumping
8149
8150 @deffn Command {dump_image} filename address size
8151 Dump @var{size} bytes of target memory starting at @var{address} to the
8152 binary file named @var{filename}.
8153 @end deffn
8154
8155 @deffn Command {fast_load}
8156 Loads an image stored in memory by @command{fast_load_image} to the
8157 current target. Must be preceded by fast_load_image.
8158 @end deffn
8159
8160 @deffn Command {fast_load_image} filename address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}|@option{s19}]
8161 Normally you should be using @command{load_image} or GDB load. However, for
8162 testing purposes or when I/O overhead is significant(OpenOCD running on an embedded
8163 host), storing the image in memory and uploading the image to the target
8164 can be a way to upload e.g. multiple debug sessions when the binary does not change.
8165 Arguments are the same as @command{load_image}, but the image is stored in OpenOCD host
8166 memory, i.e. does not affect target. This approach is also useful when profiling
8167 target programming performance as I/O and target programming can easily be profiled
8168 separately.
8169 @end deffn
8170
8171 @deffn Command {load_image} filename address [[@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}|@option{s19}] @option{min_addr} @option{max_length}]
8172 Load image from file @var{filename} to target memory offset by @var{address} from its load address.
8173 The file format may optionally be specified
8174 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, @option{elf}, or @option{s19}).
8175 In addition the following arguments may be specified:
8176 @var{min_addr} - ignore data below @var{min_addr} (this is w.r.t. to the target's load address + @var{address})
8177 @var{max_length} - maximum number of bytes to load.
8178 @example
8179 proc load_image_bin @{fname foffset address length @} @{
8180 # Load data from fname filename at foffset offset to
8181 # target at address. Load at most length bytes.
8182 load_image $fname [expr $address - $foffset] bin \
8183 $address $length
8184 @}
8185 @end example
8186 @end deffn
8187
8188 @deffn Command {test_image} filename [address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}]]
8189 Displays image section sizes and addresses
8190 as if @var{filename} were loaded into target memory
8191 starting at @var{address} (defaults to zero).
8192 The file format may optionally be specified
8193 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, or @option{elf})
8194 @end deffn
8195
8196 @deffn Command {verify_image} filename address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}]
8197 Verify @var{filename} against target memory starting at @var{address}.
8198 The file format may optionally be specified
8199 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, or @option{elf})
8200 This will first attempt a comparison using a CRC checksum, if this fails it will try a binary compare.
8201 @end deffn
8202
8203 @deffn Command {verify_image_checksum} filename address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}]
8204 Verify @var{filename} against target memory starting at @var{address}.
8205 The file format may optionally be specified
8206 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, or @option{elf})
8207 This perform a comparison using a CRC checksum only
8208 @end deffn
8209
8210
8211 @section Breakpoint and Watchpoint commands
8212 @cindex breakpoint
8213 @cindex watchpoint
8214
8215 CPUs often make debug modules accessible through JTAG, with
8216 hardware support for a handful of code breakpoints and data
8217 watchpoints.
8218 In addition, CPUs almost always support software breakpoints.
8219
8220 @deffn Command {bp} [address len [@option{hw}]]
8221 With no parameters, lists all active breakpoints.
8222 Else sets a breakpoint on code execution starting
8223 at @var{address} for @var{length} bytes.
8224 This is a software breakpoint, unless @option{hw} is specified
8225 in which case it will be a hardware breakpoint.
8226
8227 (@xref{arm9vectorcatch,,arm9 vector_catch}, or @pxref{xscalevectorcatch,,xscale vector_catch},
8228 for similar mechanisms that do not consume hardware breakpoints.)
8229 @end deffn
8230
8231 @deffn Command {rbp} @option{all} | address
8232 Remove the breakpoint at @var{address} or all breakpoints.
8233 @end deffn
8234
8235 @deffn Command {rwp} address
8236 Remove data watchpoint on @var{address}
8237 @end deffn
8238
8239 @deffn Command {wp} [address len [(@option{r}|@option{w}|@option{a}) [value [mask]]]]
8240 With no parameters, lists all active watchpoints.
8241 Else sets a data watchpoint on data from @var{address} for @var{length} bytes.
8242 The watch point is an "access" watchpoint unless
8243 the @option{r} or @option{w} parameter is provided,
8244 defining it as respectively a read or write watchpoint.
8245 If a @var{value} is provided, that value is used when determining if
8246 the watchpoint should trigger. The value may be first be masked
8247 using @var{mask} to mark ``don't care'' fields.
8248 @end deffn
8249
8250 @section Misc Commands
8251
8252 @cindex profiling
8253 @deffn Command {profile} seconds filename [start end]
8254 Profiling samples the CPU's program counter as quickly as possible,
8255 which is useful for non-intrusive stochastic profiling.
8256 Saves up to 10000 samples in @file{filename} using ``gmon.out''
8257 format. Optional @option{start} and @option{end} parameters allow to
8258 limit the address range.
8259 @end deffn
8260
8261 @deffn Command {version}
8262 Displays a string identifying the version of this OpenOCD server.
8263 @end deffn
8264
8265 @deffn Command {virt2phys} virtual_address
8266 Requests the current target to map the specified @var{virtual_address}
8267 to its corresponding physical address, and displays the result.
8268 @end deffn
8269
8270 @node Architecture and Core Commands
8271 @chapter Architecture and Core Commands
8272 @cindex Architecture Specific Commands
8273 @cindex Core Specific Commands
8274
8275 Most CPUs have specialized JTAG operations to support debugging.
8276 OpenOCD packages most such operations in its standard command framework.
8277 Some of those operations don't fit well in that framework, so they are
8278 exposed here as architecture or implementation (core) specific commands.
8279
8280 @anchor{armhardwaretracing}
8281 @section ARM Hardware Tracing
8282 @cindex tracing
8283 @cindex ETM
8284 @cindex ETB
8285
8286 CPUs based on ARM cores may include standard tracing interfaces,
8287 based on an ``Embedded Trace Module'' (ETM) which sends voluminous
8288 address and data bus trace records to a ``Trace Port''.
8289
8290 @itemize
8291 @item
8292 Development-oriented boards will sometimes provide a high speed
8293 trace connector for collecting that data, when the particular CPU
8294 supports such an interface.
8295 (The standard connector is a 38-pin Mictor, with both JTAG
8296 and trace port support.)
8297 Those trace connectors are supported by higher end JTAG adapters
8298 and some logic analyzer modules; frequently those modules can
8299 buffer several megabytes of trace data.
8300 Configuring an ETM coupled to such an external trace port belongs
8301 in the board-specific configuration file.
8302 @item
8303 If the CPU doesn't provide an external interface, it probably
8304 has an ``Embedded Trace Buffer'' (ETB) on the chip, which is a
8305 dedicated SRAM. 4KBytes is one common ETB size.
8306 Configuring an ETM coupled only to an ETB belongs in the CPU-specific
8307 (target) configuration file, since it works the same on all boards.
8308 @end itemize
8309
8310 ETM support in OpenOCD doesn't seem to be widely used yet.
8311
8312 @quotation Issues
8313 ETM support may be buggy, and at least some @command{etm config}
8314 parameters should be detected by asking the ETM for them.
8315
8316 ETM trigger events could also implement a kind of complex
8317 hardware breakpoint, much more powerful than the simple
8318 watchpoint hardware exported by EmbeddedICE modules.
8319 @emph{Such breakpoints can be triggered even when using the
8320 dummy trace port driver}.
8321
8322 It seems like a GDB hookup should be possible,
8323 as well as tracing only during specific states
8324 (perhaps @emph{handling IRQ 23} or @emph{calls foo()}).
8325
8326 There should be GUI tools to manipulate saved trace data and help
8327 analyse it in conjunction with the source code.
8328 It's unclear how much of a common interface is shared
8329 with the current XScale trace support, or should be
8330 shared with eventual Nexus-style trace module support.
8331
8332 At this writing (November 2009) only ARM7, ARM9, and ARM11 support
8333 for ETM modules is available. The code should be able to
8334 work with some newer cores; but not all of them support
8335 this original style of JTAG access.
8336 @end quotation
8337
8338 @subsection ETM Configuration
8339 ETM setup is coupled with the trace port driver configuration.
8340
8341 @deffn {Config Command} {etm config} target width mode clocking driver
8342 Declares the ETM associated with @var{target}, and associates it
8343 with a given trace port @var{driver}. @xref{traceportdrivers,,Trace Port Drivers}.
8344
8345 Several of the parameters must reflect the trace port capabilities,
8346 which are a function of silicon capabilities (exposed later
8347 using @command{etm info}) and of what hardware is connected to
8348 that port (such as an external pod, or ETB).
8349 The @var{width} must be either 4, 8, or 16,
8350 except with ETMv3.0 and newer modules which may also
8351 support 1, 2, 24, 32, 48, and 64 bit widths.
8352 (With those versions, @command{etm info} also shows whether
8353 the selected port width and mode are supported.)
8354
8355 The @var{mode} must be @option{normal}, @option{multiplexed},
8356 or @option{demultiplexed}.
8357 The @var{clocking} must be @option{half} or @option{full}.
8358
8359 @quotation Warning
8360 With ETMv3.0 and newer, the bits set with the @var{mode} and
8361 @var{clocking} parameters both control the mode.
8362 This modified mode does not map to the values supported by
8363 previous ETM modules, so this syntax is subject to change.
8364 @end quotation
8365
8366 @quotation Note
8367 You can see the ETM registers using the @command{reg} command.
8368 Not all possible registers are present in every ETM.
8369 Most of the registers are write-only, and are used to configure
8370 what CPU activities are traced.
8371 @end quotation
8372 @end deffn
8373
8374 @deffn Command {etm info}
8375 Displays information about the current target's ETM.
8376 This includes resource counts from the @code{ETM_CONFIG} register,
8377 as well as silicon capabilities (except on rather old modules).
8378 from the @code{ETM_SYS_CONFIG} register.
8379 @end deffn
8380
8381 @deffn Command {etm status}
8382 Displays status of the current target's ETM and trace port driver:
8383 is the ETM idle, or is it collecting data?
8384 Did trace data overflow?
8385 Was it triggered?
8386 @end deffn
8387
8388 @deffn Command {etm tracemode} [type context_id_bits cycle_accurate branch_output]
8389 Displays what data that ETM will collect.
8390 If arguments are provided, first configures that data.
8391 When the configuration changes, tracing is stopped
8392 and any buffered trace data is invalidated.
8393
8394 @itemize
8395 @item @var{type} ... describing how data accesses are traced,
8396 when they pass any ViewData filtering that was set up.
8397 The value is one of
8398 @option{none} (save nothing),
8399 @option{data} (save data),
8400 @option{address} (save addresses),
8401 @option{all} (save data and addresses)
8402 @item @var{context_id_bits} ... 0, 8, 16, or 32
8403 @item @var{cycle_accurate} ... @option{enable} or @option{disable}
8404 cycle-accurate instruction tracing.
8405 Before ETMv3, enabling this causes much extra data to be recorded.
8406 @item @var{branch_output} ... @option{enable} or @option{disable}.
8407 Disable this unless you need to try reconstructing the instruction
8408 trace stream without an image of the code.
8409 @end itemize
8410 @end deffn
8411
8412 @deffn Command {etm trigger_debug} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
8413 Displays whether ETM triggering debug entry (like a breakpoint) is
8414 enabled or disabled, after optionally modifying that configuration.
8415 The default behaviour is @option{disable}.
8416 Any change takes effect after the next @command{etm start}.
8417
8418 By using script commands to configure ETM registers, you can make the
8419 processor enter debug state automatically when certain conditions,
8420 more complex than supported by the breakpoint hardware, happen.
8421 @end deffn
8422
8423 @subsection ETM Trace Operation
8424
8425 After setting up the ETM, you can use it to collect data.
8426 That data can be exported to files for later analysis.
8427 It can also be parsed with OpenOCD, for basic sanity checking.
8428
8429 To configure what is being traced, you will need to write
8430 various trace registers using @command{reg ETM_*} commands.
8431 For the definitions of these registers, read ARM publication
8432 @emph{IHI 0014, ``Embedded Trace Macrocell, Architecture Specification''}.
8433 Be aware that most of the relevant registers are write-only,
8434 and that ETM resources are limited. There are only a handful
8435 of address comparators, data comparators, counters, and so on.
8436
8437 Examples of scenarios you might arrange to trace include:
8438
8439 @itemize
8440 @item Code flow within a function, @emph{excluding} subroutines
8441 it calls. Use address range comparators to enable tracing
8442 for instruction access within that function's body.
8443 @item Code flow within a function, @emph{including} subroutines
8444 it calls. Use the sequencer and address comparators to activate
8445 tracing on an ``entered function'' state, then deactivate it by
8446 exiting that state when the function's exit code is invoked.
8447 @item Code flow starting at the fifth invocation of a function,
8448 combining one of the above models with a counter.
8449 @item CPU data accesses to the registers for a particular device,
8450 using address range comparators and the ViewData logic.
8451 @item Such data accesses only during IRQ handling, combining the above
8452 model with sequencer triggers which on entry and exit to the IRQ handler.
8453 @item @emph{... more}
8454 @end itemize
8455
8456 At this writing, September 2009, there are no Tcl utility
8457 procedures to help set up any common tracing scenarios.
8458
8459 @deffn Command {etm analyze}
8460 Reads trace data into memory, if it wasn't already present.
8461 Decodes and prints the data that was collected.
8462 @end deffn
8463
8464 @deffn Command {etm dump} filename
8465 Stores the captured trace data in @file{filename}.
8466 @end deffn
8467
8468 @deffn Command {etm image} filename [base_address] [type]
8469 Opens an image file.
8470 @end deffn
8471
8472 @deffn Command {etm load} filename
8473 Loads captured trace data from @file{filename}.
8474 @end deffn
8475
8476 @deffn Command {etm start}
8477 Starts trace data collection.
8478 @end deffn
8479
8480 @deffn Command {etm stop}
8481 Stops trace data collection.
8482 @end deffn
8483
8484 @anchor{traceportdrivers}
8485 @subsection Trace Port Drivers
8486
8487 To use an ETM trace port it must be associated with a driver.
8488
8489 @deffn {Trace Port Driver} dummy
8490 Use the @option{dummy} driver if you are configuring an ETM that's
8491 not connected to anything (on-chip ETB or off-chip trace connector).
8492 @emph{This driver lets OpenOCD talk to the ETM, but it does not expose
8493 any trace data collection.}
8494 @deffn {Config Command} {etm_dummy config} target
8495 Associates the ETM for @var{target} with a dummy driver.
8496 @end deffn
8497 @end deffn
8498
8499 @deffn {Trace Port Driver} etb
8500 Use the @option{etb} driver if you are configuring an ETM
8501 to use on-chip ETB memory.
8502 @deffn {Config Command} {etb config} target etb_tap
8503 Associates the ETM for @var{target} with the ETB at @var{etb_tap}.
8504 You can see the ETB registers using the @command{reg} command.
8505 @end deffn
8506 @deffn Command {etb trigger_percent} [percent]
8507 This displays, or optionally changes, ETB behavior after the
8508 ETM's configured @emph{trigger} event fires.
8509 It controls how much more trace data is saved after the (single)
8510 trace trigger becomes active.
8511
8512 @itemize
8513 @item The default corresponds to @emph{trace around} usage,
8514 recording 50 percent data before the event and the rest
8515 afterwards.
8516 @item The minimum value of @var{percent} is 2 percent,
8517 recording almost exclusively data before the trigger.
8518 Such extreme @emph{trace before} usage can help figure out
8519 what caused that event to happen.
8520 @item The maximum value of @var{percent} is 100 percent,
8521 recording data almost exclusively after the event.
8522 This extreme @emph{trace after} usage might help sort out
8523 how the event caused trouble.
8524 @end itemize
8525 @c REVISIT allow "break" too -- enter debug mode.
8526 @end deffn
8527
8528 @end deffn
8529
8530 @deffn {Trace Port Driver} oocd_trace
8531 This driver isn't available unless OpenOCD was explicitly configured
8532 with the @option{--enable-oocd_trace} option. You probably don't want
8533 to configure it unless you've built the appropriate prototype hardware;
8534 it's @emph{proof-of-concept} software.
8535
8536 Use the @option{oocd_trace} driver if you are configuring an ETM that's
8537 connected to an off-chip trace connector.
8538
8539 @deffn {Config Command} {oocd_trace config} target tty
8540 Associates the ETM for @var{target} with a trace driver which
8541 collects data through the serial port @var{tty}.
8542 @end deffn
8543
8544 @deffn Command {oocd_trace resync}
8545 Re-synchronizes with the capture clock.
8546 @end deffn
8547
8548 @deffn Command {oocd_trace status}
8549 Reports whether the capture clock is locked or not.
8550 @end deffn
8551 @end deffn
8552
8553 @anchor{armcrosstrigger}
8554 @section ARM Cross-Trigger Interface
8555 @cindex CTI
8556
8557 The ARM Cross-Trigger Interface (CTI) is a generic CoreSight component
8558 that connects event sources like tracing components or CPU cores with each
8559 other through a common trigger matrix (CTM). For ARMv8 architecture, a
8560 CTI is mandatory for core run control and each core has an individual
8561 CTI instance attached to it. OpenOCD has limited support for CTI using
8562 the @emph{cti} group of commands.
8563
8564 @deffn Command {cti create} cti_name @option{-dap} dap_name @option{-ap-num} apn @option{-ctibase} base_address
8565 Creates a CTI instance @var{cti_name} on the DAP instance @var{dap_name} on MEM-AP
8566 @var{apn}. The @var{base_address} must match the base address of the CTI
8567 on the respective MEM-AP. All arguments are mandatory. This creates a
8568 new command @command{$cti_name} which is used for various purposes
8569 including additional configuration.
8570 @end deffn
8571
8572 @deffn Command {$cti_name enable} @option{on|off}
8573 Enable (@option{on}) or disable (@option{off}) the CTI.
8574 @end deffn
8575
8576 @deffn Command {$cti_name dump}
8577 Displays a register dump of the CTI.
8578 @end deffn
8579
8580 @deffn Command {$cti_name write } @var{reg_name} @var{value}
8581 Write @var{value} to the CTI register with the symbolic name @var{reg_name}.
8582 @end deffn
8583
8584 @deffn Command {$cti_name read} @var{reg_name}
8585 Print the value read from the CTI register with the symbolic name @var{reg_name}.
8586 @end deffn
8587
8588 @deffn Command {$cti_name ack} @var{event}
8589 Acknowledge a CTI @var{event}.
8590 @end deffn
8591
8592 @deffn Command {$cti_name channel} @var{channel_number} @var{operation}
8593 Perform a specific channel operation, the possible operations are:
8594 gate, ungate, set, clear and pulse
8595 @end deffn
8596
8597 @deffn Command {$cti_name testmode} @option{on|off}
8598 Enable (@option{on}) or disable (@option{off}) the integration test mode
8599 of the CTI.
8600 @end deffn
8601
8602 @deffn Command {cti names}
8603 Prints a list of names of all CTI objects created. This command is mainly
8604 useful in TCL scripting.
8605 @end deffn
8606
8607 @section Generic ARM
8608 @cindex ARM
8609
8610 These commands should be available on all ARM processors.
8611 They are available in addition to other core-specific
8612 commands that may be available.
8613
8614 @deffn Command {arm core_state} [@option{arm}|@option{thumb}]
8615 Displays the core_state, optionally changing it to process
8616 either @option{arm} or @option{thumb} instructions.
8617 The target may later be resumed in the currently set core_state.
8618 (Processors may also support the Jazelle state, but
8619 that is not currently supported in OpenOCD.)
8620 @end deffn
8621
8622 @deffn Command {arm disassemble} address [count [@option{thumb}]]
8623 @cindex disassemble
8624 Disassembles @var{count} instructions starting at @var{address}.
8625 If @var{count} is not specified, a single instruction is disassembled.
8626 If @option{thumb} is specified, or the low bit of the address is set,
8627 Thumb2 (mixed 16/32-bit) instructions are used;
8628 else ARM (32-bit) instructions are used.
8629 (Processors may also support the Jazelle state, but
8630 those instructions are not currently understood by OpenOCD.)
8631
8632 Note that all Thumb instructions are Thumb2 instructions,
8633 so older processors (without Thumb2 support) will still
8634 see correct disassembly of Thumb code.
8635 Also, ThumbEE opcodes are the same as Thumb2,
8636 with a handful of exceptions.
8637 ThumbEE disassembly currently has no explicit support.
8638 @end deffn
8639
8640 @deffn Command {arm mcr} pX op1 CRn CRm op2 value
8641 Write @var{value} to a coprocessor @var{pX} register
8642 passing parameters @var{CRn},
8643 @var{CRm}, opcodes @var{opc1} and @var{opc2},
8644 and using the MCR instruction.
8645 (Parameter sequence matches the ARM instruction, but omits
8646 an ARM register.)
8647 @end deffn
8648
8649 @deffn Command {arm mrc} pX coproc op1 CRn CRm op2
8650 Read a coprocessor @var{pX} register passing parameters @var{CRn},
8651 @var{CRm}, opcodes @var{opc1} and @var{opc2},
8652 and the MRC instruction.
8653 Returns the result so it can be manipulated by Jim scripts.
8654 (Parameter sequence matches the ARM instruction, but omits
8655 an ARM register.)
8656 @end deffn
8657
8658 @deffn Command {arm reg}
8659 Display a table of all banked core registers, fetching the current value from every
8660 core mode if necessary.
8661 @end deffn
8662
8663 @deffn Command {arm semihosting} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8664 @cindex ARM semihosting
8665 Display status of semihosting, after optionally changing that status.
8666
8667 Semihosting allows for code executing on an ARM target to use the
8668 I/O facilities on the host computer i.e. the system where OpenOCD
8669 is running. The target application must be linked against a library
8670 implementing the ARM semihosting convention that forwards operation
8671 requests by using a special SVC instruction that is trapped at the
8672 Supervisor Call vector by OpenOCD.
8673 @end deffn
8674
8675 @deffn Command {arm semihosting_cmdline} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8676 @cindex ARM semihosting
8677 Set the command line to be passed to the debugger.
8678
8679 @example
8680 arm semihosting_cmdline argv0 argv1 argv2 ...
8681 @end example
8682
8683 This option lets one set the command line arguments to be passed to
8684 the program. The first argument (argv0) is the program name in a
8685 standard C environment (argv[0]). Depending on the program (not much
8686 programs look at argv[0]), argv0 is ignored and can be any string.
8687 @end deffn
8688
8689 @deffn Command {arm semihosting_fileio} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8690 @cindex ARM semihosting
8691 Display status of semihosting fileio, after optionally changing that
8692 status.
8693
8694 Enabling this option forwards semihosting I/O to GDB process using the
8695 File-I/O remote protocol extension. This is especially useful for
8696 interacting with remote files or displaying console messages in the
8697 debugger.
8698 @end deffn
8699
8700 @deffn Command {arm semihosting_resexit} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8701 @cindex ARM semihosting
8702 Enable resumable SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT.
8703
8704 When SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT is called outside a debug session,
8705 things are simple, the openocd process calls exit() and passes
8706 the value returned by the target.
8707
8708 When SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT is called during a debug session,
8709 by default execution returns to the debugger, leaving the
8710 debugger in a HALT state, similar to the state entered when
8711 encountering a break.
8712
8713 In some use cases, it is useful to have SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT
8714 return normally, as any semihosting call, and do not break
8715 to the debugger.
8716 The standard allows this to happen, but the condition
8717 to trigger it is a bit obscure ("by performing an RDI_Execute
8718 request or equivalent").
8719
8720 To make the SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT call return normally, enable
8721 this option (default: disabled).
8722 @end deffn
8723
8724 @section ARMv4 and ARMv5 Architecture
8725 @cindex ARMv4
8726 @cindex ARMv5
8727
8728 The ARMv4 and ARMv5 architectures are widely used in embedded systems,
8729 and introduced core parts of the instruction set in use today.
8730 That includes the Thumb instruction set, introduced in the ARMv4T
8731 variant.
8732
8733 @subsection ARM7 and ARM9 specific commands
8734 @cindex ARM7
8735 @cindex ARM9
8736
8737 These commands are specific to ARM7 and ARM9 cores, like ARM7TDMI, ARM720T,
8738 ARM9TDMI, ARM920T or ARM926EJ-S.
8739 They are available in addition to the ARM commands,
8740 and any other core-specific commands that may be available.
8741
8742 @deffn Command {arm7_9 dbgrq} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8743 Displays the value of the flag controlling use of the
8744 EmbeddedIce DBGRQ signal to force entry into debug mode,
8745 instead of breakpoints.
8746 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
8747
8748 This should be
8749 safe for all but ARM7TDMI-S cores (like NXP LPC).
8750 This feature is enabled by default on most ARM9 cores,
8751 including ARM9TDMI, ARM920T, and ARM926EJ-S.
8752 @end deffn
8753
8754 @deffn Command {arm7_9 dcc_downloads} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8755 @cindex DCC
8756 Displays the value of the flag controlling use of the debug communications
8757 channel (DCC) to write larger (>128 byte) amounts of memory.
8758 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
8759
8760 DCC downloads offer a huge speed increase, but might be
8761 unsafe, especially with targets running at very low speeds. This command was introduced
8762 with OpenOCD rev. 60, and requires a few bytes of working area.
8763 @end deffn
8764
8765 @deffn Command {arm7_9 fast_memory_access} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8766 Displays the value of the flag controlling use of memory writes and reads
8767 that don't check completion of the operation.
8768 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
8769
8770 This provides a huge speed increase, especially with USB JTAG
8771 cables (FT2232), but might be unsafe if used with targets running at very low
8772 speeds, like the 32kHz startup clock of an AT91RM9200.
8773 @end deffn
8774
8775 @subsection ARM720T specific commands
8776 @cindex ARM720T
8777
8778 These commands are available to ARM720T based CPUs,
8779 which are implementations of the ARMv4T architecture
8780 based on the ARM7TDMI-S integer core.
8781 They are available in addition to the ARM and ARM7/ARM9 commands.
8782
8783 @deffn Command {arm720t cp15} opcode [value]
8784 @emph{DEPRECATED -- avoid using this.
8785 Use the @command{arm mrc} or @command{arm mcr} commands instead.}
8786
8787 Display cp15 register returned by the ARM instruction @var{opcode};
8788 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
8789 The @var{opcode} should be the value of either an MRC or MCR instruction.
8790 @end deffn
8791
8792 @subsection ARM9 specific commands
8793 @cindex ARM9
8794
8795 ARM9-family cores are built around ARM9TDMI or ARM9E (including ARM9EJS)
8796 integer processors.
8797 Such cores include the ARM920T, ARM926EJ-S, and ARM966.
8798
8799 @c 9-june-2009: tried this on arm920t, it didn't work.
8800 @c no-params always lists nothing caught, and that's how it acts.
8801 @c 23-oct-2009: doesn't work _consistently_ ... as if the ICE
8802 @c versions have different rules about when they commit writes.
8803
8804 @anchor{arm9vectorcatch}
8805 @deffn Command {arm9 vector_catch} [@option{all}|@option{none}|list]
8806 @cindex vector_catch
8807 Vector Catch hardware provides a sort of dedicated breakpoint
8808 for hardware events such as reset, interrupt, and abort.
8809 You can use this to conserve normal breakpoint resources,
8810 so long as you're not concerned with code that branches directly
8811 to those hardware vectors.
8812
8813 This always finishes by listing the current configuration.
8814 If parameters are provided, it first reconfigures the
8815 vector catch hardware to intercept
8816 @option{all} of the hardware vectors,
8817 @option{none} of them,
8818 or a list with one or more of the following:
8819 @option{reset} @option{undef} @option{swi} @option{pabt} @option{dabt}
8820 @option{irq} @option{fiq}.
8821 @end deffn
8822
8823 @subsection ARM920T specific commands
8824 @cindex ARM920T
8825
8826 These commands are available to ARM920T based CPUs,
8827 which are implementations of the ARMv4T architecture
8828 built using the ARM9TDMI integer core.
8829 They are available in addition to the ARM, ARM7/ARM9,
8830 and ARM9 commands.
8831
8832 @deffn Command {arm920t cache_info}
8833 Print information about the caches found. This allows to see whether your target
8834 is an ARM920T (2x16kByte cache) or ARM922T (2x8kByte cache).
8835 @end deffn
8836
8837 @deffn Command {arm920t cp15} regnum [value]
8838 Display cp15 register @var{regnum};
8839 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
8840 This uses "physical access" and the register number is as
8841 shown in bits 38..33 of table 9-9 in the ARM920T TRM.
8842 (Not all registers can be written.)
8843 @end deffn
8844
8845 @deffn Command {arm920t cp15i} opcode [value [address]]
8846 @emph{DEPRECATED -- avoid using this.
8847 Use the @command{arm mrc} or @command{arm mcr} commands instead.}
8848
8849 Interpreted access using ARM instruction @var{opcode}, which should
8850 be the value of either an MRC or MCR instruction
8851 (as shown tables 9-11, 9-12, and 9-13 in the ARM920T TRM).
8852 If no @var{value} is provided, the result is displayed.
8853 Else if that value is written using the specified @var{address},
8854 or using zero if no other address is provided.
8855 @end deffn
8856
8857 @deffn Command {arm920t read_cache} filename
8858 Dump the content of ICache and DCache to a file named @file{filename}.
8859 @end deffn
8860
8861 @deffn Command {arm920t read_mmu} filename
8862 Dump the content of the ITLB and DTLB to a file named @file{filename}.
8863 @end deffn
8864
8865 @subsection ARM926ej-s specific commands
8866 @cindex ARM926ej-s
8867
8868 These commands are available to ARM926ej-s based CPUs,
8869 which are implementations of the ARMv5TEJ architecture
8870 based on the ARM9EJ-S integer core.
8871 They are available in addition to the ARM, ARM7/ARM9,
8872 and ARM9 commands.
8873
8874 The Feroceon cores also support these commands, although
8875 they are not built from ARM926ej-s designs.
8876
8877 @deffn Command {arm926ejs cache_info}
8878 Print information about the caches found.
8879 @end deffn
8880
8881 @subsection ARM966E specific commands
8882 @cindex ARM966E
8883
8884 These commands are available to ARM966 based CPUs,
8885 which are implementations of the ARMv5TE architecture.
8886 They are available in addition to the ARM, ARM7/ARM9,
8887 and ARM9 commands.
8888
8889 @deffn Command {arm966e cp15} regnum [value]
8890 Display cp15 register @var{regnum};
8891 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
8892 The six bit @var{regnum} values are bits 37..32 from table 7-2 of the
8893 ARM966E-S TRM.
8894 There is no current control over bits 31..30 from that table,
8895 as required for BIST support.
8896 @end deffn
8897
8898 @subsection XScale specific commands
8899 @cindex XScale
8900
8901 Some notes about the debug implementation on the XScale CPUs:
8902
8903 The XScale CPU provides a special debug-only mini-instruction cache
8904 (mini-IC) in which exception vectors and target-resident debug handler
8905 code are placed by OpenOCD. In order to get access to the CPU, OpenOCD
8906 must point vector 0 (the reset vector) to the entry of the debug
8907 handler. However, this means that the complete first cacheline in the
8908 mini-IC is marked valid, which makes the CPU fetch all exception
8909 handlers from the mini-IC, ignoring the code in RAM.
8910
8911 To address this situation, OpenOCD provides the @code{xscale
8912 vector_table} command, which allows the user to explicitly write
8913 individual entries to either the high or low vector table stored in
8914 the mini-IC.
8915
8916 It is recommended to place a pc-relative indirect branch in the vector
8917 table, and put the branch destination somewhere in memory. Doing so
8918 makes sure the code in the vector table stays constant regardless of
8919 code layout in memory:
8920 @example
8921 _vectors:
8922 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
8923 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
8924 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
8925 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
8926 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
8927 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
8928 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
8929 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
8930 .org 0x100
8931 .long real_reset_vector
8932 .long real_ui_handler
8933 .long real_swi_handler
8934 .long real_pf_abort
8935 .long real_data_abort
8936 .long 0 /* unused */
8937 .long real_irq_handler
8938 .long real_fiq_handler
8939 @end example
8940
8941 Alternatively, you may choose to keep some or all of the mini-IC
8942 vector table entries synced with those written to memory by your
8943 system software. The mini-IC can not be modified while the processor
8944 is executing, but for each vector table entry not previously defined
8945 using the @code{xscale vector_table} command, OpenOCD will copy the
8946 value from memory to the mini-IC every time execution resumes from a
8947 halt. This is done for both high and low vector tables (although the
8948 table not in use may not be mapped to valid memory, and in this case
8949 that copy operation will silently fail). This means that you will
8950 need to briefly halt execution at some strategic point during system
8951 start-up; e.g., after the software has initialized the vector table,
8952 but before exceptions are enabled. A breakpoint can be used to
8953 accomplish this once the appropriate location in the start-up code has
8954 been identified. A watchpoint over the vector table region is helpful
8955 in finding the location if you're not sure. Note that the same
8956 situation exists any time the vector table is modified by the system
8957 software.
8958
8959 The debug handler must be placed somewhere in the address space using
8960 the @code{xscale debug_handler} command. The allowed locations for the
8961 debug handler are either (0x800 - 0x1fef800) or (0xfe000800 -
8962 0xfffff800). The default value is 0xfe000800.
8963
8964 XScale has resources to support two hardware breakpoints and two
8965 watchpoints. However, the following restrictions on watchpoint
8966 functionality apply: (1) the value and mask arguments to the @code{wp}
8967 command are not supported, (2) the watchpoint length must be a
8968 power of two and not less than four, and can not be greater than the
8969 watchpoint address, and (3) a watchpoint with a length greater than
8970 four consumes all the watchpoint hardware resources. This means that
8971 at any one time, you can have enabled either two watchpoints with a
8972 length of four, or one watchpoint with a length greater than four.
8973
8974 These commands are available to XScale based CPUs,
8975 which are implementations of the ARMv5TE architecture.
8976
8977 @deffn Command {xscale analyze_trace}
8978 Displays the contents of the trace buffer.
8979 @end deffn
8980
8981 @deffn Command {xscale cache_clean_address} address
8982 Changes the address used when cleaning the data cache.
8983 @end deffn
8984
8985 @deffn Command {xscale cache_info}
8986 Displays information about the CPU caches.
8987 @end deffn
8988
8989 @deffn Command {xscale cp15} regnum [value]
8990 Display cp15 register @var{regnum};
8991 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
8992 @end deffn
8993
8994 @deffn Command {xscale debug_handler} target address
8995 Changes the address used for the specified target's debug handler.
8996 @end deffn
8997
8998 @deffn Command {xscale dcache} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8999 Enables or disable the CPU's data cache.
9000 @end deffn
9001
9002 @deffn Command {xscale dump_trace} filename
9003 Dumps the raw contents of the trace buffer to @file{filename}.
9004 @end deffn
9005
9006 @deffn Command {xscale icache} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9007 Enables or disable the CPU's instruction cache.
9008 @end deffn
9009
9010 @deffn Command {xscale mmu} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9011 Enables or disable the CPU's memory management unit.
9012 @end deffn
9013
9014 @deffn Command {xscale trace_buffer} [@option{enable}|@option{disable} [@option{fill} [n] | @option{wrap}]]
9015 Displays the trace buffer status, after optionally
9016 enabling or disabling the trace buffer
9017 and modifying how it is emptied.
9018 @end deffn
9019
9020 @deffn Command {xscale trace_image} filename [offset [type]]
9021 Opens a trace image from @file{filename}, optionally rebasing
9022 its segment addresses by @var{offset}.
9023 The image @var{type} may be one of
9024 @option{bin} (binary), @option{ihex} (Intel hex),
9025 @option{elf} (ELF file), @option{s19} (Motorola s19),
9026 @option{mem}, or @option{builder}.
9027 @end deffn
9028
9029 @anchor{xscalevectorcatch}
9030 @deffn Command {xscale vector_catch} [mask]
9031 @cindex vector_catch
9032 Display a bitmask showing the hardware vectors to catch.
9033 If the optional parameter is provided, first set the bitmask to that value.
9034
9035 The mask bits correspond with bit 16..23 in the DCSR:
9036 @example
9037 0x01 Trap Reset
9038 0x02 Trap Undefined Instructions
9039 0x04 Trap Software Interrupt
9040 0x08 Trap Prefetch Abort
9041 0x10 Trap Data Abort
9042 0x20 reserved
9043 0x40 Trap IRQ
9044 0x80 Trap FIQ
9045 @end example
9046 @end deffn
9047
9048 @deffn Command {xscale vector_table} [(@option{low}|@option{high}) index value]
9049 @cindex vector_table
9050
9051 Set an entry in the mini-IC vector table. There are two tables: one for
9052 low vectors (at 0x00000000), and one for high vectors (0xFFFF0000), each
9053 holding the 8 exception vectors. @var{index} can be 1-7, because vector 0
9054 points to the debug handler entry and can not be overwritten.
9055 @var{value} holds the 32-bit opcode that is placed in the mini-IC.
9056
9057 Without arguments, the current settings are displayed.
9058
9059 @end deffn
9060
9061 @section ARMv6 Architecture
9062 @cindex ARMv6
9063
9064 @subsection ARM11 specific commands
9065 @cindex ARM11
9066
9067 @deffn Command {arm11 memwrite burst} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9068 Displays the value of the memwrite burst-enable flag,
9069 which is enabled by default.
9070 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
9071 Burst writes are only used for memory writes larger than 1 word.
9072 They improve performance by assuming that the CPU has read each data
9073 word over JTAG and completed its write before the next word arrives,
9074 instead of polling for a status flag to verify that completion.
9075 This is usually safe, because JTAG runs much slower than the CPU.
9076 @end deffn
9077
9078 @deffn Command {arm11 memwrite error_fatal} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9079 Displays the value of the memwrite error_fatal flag,
9080 which is enabled by default.
9081 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
9082 When set, certain memory write errors cause earlier transfer termination.
9083 @end deffn
9084
9085 @deffn Command {arm11 step_irq_enable} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9086 Displays the value of the flag controlling whether
9087 IRQs are enabled during single stepping;
9088 they are disabled by default.
9089 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that.
9090 @end deffn
9091
9092 @deffn Command {arm11 vcr} [value]
9093 @cindex vector_catch
9094 Displays the value of the @emph{Vector Catch Register (VCR)},
9095 coprocessor 14 register 7.
9096 If @var{value} is defined, first assigns that.
9097
9098 Vector Catch hardware provides dedicated breakpoints
9099 for certain hardware events.
9100 The specific bit values are core-specific (as in fact is using
9101 coprocessor 14 register 7 itself) but all current ARM11
9102 cores @emph{except the ARM1176} use the same six bits.
9103 @end deffn
9104
9105 @section ARMv7 and ARMv8 Architecture
9106 @cindex ARMv7
9107 @cindex ARMv8
9108
9109 @subsection ARMv7-A specific commands
9110 @cindex Cortex-A
9111
9112 @deffn Command {cortex_a cache_info}
9113 display information about target caches
9114 @end deffn
9115
9116 @deffn Command {cortex_a dacrfixup [@option{on}|@option{off}]}
9117 Work around issues with software breakpoints when the program text is
9118 mapped read-only by the operating system. This option sets the CP15 DACR
9119 to "all-manager" to bypass MMU permission checks on memory access.
9120 Defaults to 'off'.
9121 @end deffn
9122
9123 @deffn Command {cortex_a dbginit}
9124 Initialize core debug
9125 Enables debug by unlocking the Software Lock and clearing sticky powerdown indications
9126 @end deffn
9127
9128 @deffn Command {cortex_a smp} [on|off]
9129 Display/set the current SMP mode
9130 @end deffn
9131
9132 @deffn Command {cortex_a smp_gdb} [core_id]
9133 Display/set the current core displayed in GDB
9134 @end deffn
9135
9136 @deffn Command {cortex_a maskisr} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
9137 Selects whether interrupts will be processed when single stepping
9138 @end deffn
9139
9140 @deffn Command {cache_config l2x} [base way]
9141 configure l2x cache
9142 @end deffn
9143
9144 @deffn Command {cortex_a mmu dump} [@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{addr} address [@option{num_entries}]]
9145 Dump the MMU translation table from TTB0 or TTB1 register, or from physical
9146 memory location @var{address}. When dumping the table from @var{address}, print at most
9147 @var{num_entries} page table entries. @var{num_entries} is optional, if omitted, the maximum
9148 possible (4096) entries are printed.
9149 @end deffn
9150
9151 @subsection ARMv7-R specific commands
9152 @cindex Cortex-R
9153
9154 @deffn Command {cortex_r dbginit}
9155 Initialize core debug
9156 Enables debug by unlocking the Software Lock and clearing sticky powerdown indications
9157 @end deffn
9158
9159 @deffn Command {cortex_r maskisr} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
9160 Selects whether interrupts will be processed when single stepping
9161 @end deffn
9162
9163
9164 @subsection ARMv7-M specific commands
9165 @cindex tracing
9166 @cindex SWO
9167 @cindex SWV
9168 @cindex TPIU
9169 @cindex ITM
9170 @cindex ETM
9171
9172 @deffn Command {tpiu config} (@option{disable} | ((@option{external} | @option{internal (@var{filename} | -)}) @
9173 (@option{sync @var{port_width}} | ((@option{manchester} | @option{uart}) @var{formatter_enable})) @
9174 @var{TRACECLKIN_freq} [@var{trace_freq}]))
9175
9176 ARMv7-M architecture provides several modules to generate debugging
9177 information internally (ITM, DWT and ETM). Their output is directed
9178 through TPIU to be captured externally either on an SWO pin (this
9179 configuration is called SWV) or on a synchronous parallel trace port.
9180
9181 This command configures the TPIU module of the target and, if internal
9182 capture mode is selected, starts to capture trace output by using the
9183 debugger adapter features.
9184
9185 Some targets require additional actions to be performed in the
9186 @b{trace-config} handler for trace port to be activated.
9187
9188 Command options:
9189 @itemize @minus
9190 @item @option{disable} disable TPIU handling;
9191 @item @option{external} configure TPIU to let user capture trace
9192 output externally (with an additional UART or logic analyzer hardware);
9193 @item @option{internal @var{filename}} configure TPIU and debug adapter to
9194 gather trace data and append it to @var{filename} (which can be
9195 either a regular file or a named pipe);
9196 @item @option{internal -} configure TPIU and debug adapter to
9197 gather trace data, but not write to any file. Useful in conjunction with the @command{tcl_trace} command;
9198 @item @option{sync @var{port_width}} use synchronous parallel trace output
9199 mode, and set port width to @var{port_width};
9200 @item @option{manchester} use asynchronous SWO mode with Manchester
9201 coding;
9202 @item @option{uart} use asynchronous SWO mode with NRZ (same as
9203 regular UART 8N1) coding;
9204 @item @var{formatter_enable} is @option{on} or @option{off} to enable
9205 or disable TPIU formatter which needs to be used when both ITM and ETM
9206 data is to be output via SWO;
9207 @item @var{TRACECLKIN_freq} this should be specified to match target's
9208 current TRACECLKIN frequency (usually the same as HCLK);
9209 @item @var{trace_freq} trace port frequency. Can be omitted in
9210 internal mode to let the adapter driver select the maximum supported
9211 rate automatically.
9212 @end itemize
9213
9214 Example usage:
9215 @enumerate
9216 @item STM32L152 board is programmed with an application that configures
9217 PLL to provide core clock with 24MHz frequency; to use ITM output it's
9218 enough to:
9219 @example
9220 #include <libopencm3/cm3/itm.h>
9221 ...
9222 ITM_STIM8(0) = c;
9223 ...
9224 @end example
9225 (the most obvious way is to use the first stimulus port for printf,
9226 for that this ITM_STIM8 assignment can be used inside _write(); to make it
9227 blocking to avoid data loss, add @code{while (!(ITM_STIM8(0) &
9228 ITM_STIM_FIFOREADY));});
9229 @item An FT2232H UART is connected to the SWO pin of the board;
9230 @item Commands to configure UART for 12MHz baud rate:
9231 @example
9232 $ setserial /dev/ttyUSB1 spd_cust divisor 5
9233 $ stty -F /dev/ttyUSB1 38400
9234 @end example
9235 (FT2232H's base frequency is 60MHz, spd_cust allows to alias 38400
9236 baud with our custom divisor to get 12MHz)
9237 @item @code{itmdump -f /dev/ttyUSB1 -d1}
9238 @item OpenOCD invocation line:
9239 @example
9240 openocd -f interface/stlink.cfg \
9241 -c "transport select hla_swd" \
9242 -f target/stm32l1.cfg \
9243 -c "tpiu config external uart off 24000000 12000000"
9244 @end example
9245 @end enumerate
9246 @end deffn
9247
9248 @deffn Command {itm port} @var{port} (@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{on}|@option{off})
9249 Enable or disable trace output for ITM stimulus @var{port} (counting
9250 from 0). Port 0 is enabled on target creation automatically.
9251 @end deffn
9252
9253 @deffn Command {itm ports} (@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{on}|@option{off})
9254 Enable or disable trace output for all ITM stimulus ports.
9255 @end deffn
9256
9257 @subsection Cortex-M specific commands
9258 @cindex Cortex-M
9259
9260 @deffn Command {cortex_m maskisr} (@option{auto}|@option{on}|@option{off}|@option{steponly})
9261 Control masking (disabling) interrupts during target step/resume.
9262
9263 The @option{auto} option handles interrupts during stepping in a way that they
9264 get served but don't disturb the program flow. The step command first allows
9265 pending interrupt handlers to execute, then disables interrupts and steps over
9266 the next instruction where the core was halted. After the step interrupts
9267 are enabled again. If the interrupt handlers don't complete within 500ms,
9268 the step command leaves with the core running.
9269
9270 The @option{steponly} option disables interrupts during single-stepping but
9271 enables them during normal execution. This can be used as a partial workaround
9272 for 702596 erratum in Cortex-M7 r0p1. See "Cortex-M7 (AT610) and Cortex-M7 with
9273 FPU (AT611) Software Developer Errata Notice" from ARM for further details.
9274
9275 Note that a free hardware (FPB) breakpoint is required for the @option{auto}
9276 option. If no breakpoint is available at the time of the step, then the step
9277 is taken with interrupts enabled, i.e. the same way the @option{off} option
9278 does.
9279
9280 Default is @option{auto}.
9281 @end deffn
9282
9283 @deffn Command {cortex_m vector_catch} [@option{all}|@option{none}|list]
9284 @cindex vector_catch
9285 Vector Catch hardware provides dedicated breakpoints
9286 for certain hardware events.
9287
9288 Parameters request interception of
9289 @option{all} of these hardware event vectors,
9290 @option{none} of them,
9291 or one or more of the following:
9292 @option{hard_err} for a HardFault exception;
9293 @option{mm_err} for a MemManage exception;
9294 @option{bus_err} for a BusFault exception;
9295 @option{irq_err},
9296 @option{state_err},
9297 @option{chk_err}, or
9298 @option{nocp_err} for various UsageFault exceptions; or
9299 @option{reset}.
9300 If NVIC setup code does not enable them,
9301 MemManage, BusFault, and UsageFault exceptions
9302 are mapped to HardFault.
9303 UsageFault checks for
9304 divide-by-zero and unaligned access
9305 must also be explicitly enabled.
9306
9307 This finishes by listing the current vector catch configuration.
9308 @end deffn
9309
9310 @deffn Command {cortex_m reset_config} (@option{sysresetreq}|@option{vectreset})
9311 Control reset handling if hardware srst is not fitted
9312 @xref{reset_config,,reset_config}.
9313
9314 @itemize @minus
9315 @item @option{sysresetreq} use AIRCR SYSRESETREQ to reset system.
9316 @item @option{vectreset} use AIRCR VECTRESET to reset system (default).
9317 @end itemize
9318
9319 Using @option{vectreset} is a safe option for Cortex-M3, M4 and M7 cores.
9320 This however has the disadvantage of only resetting the core, all peripherals
9321 are unaffected. A solution would be to use a @code{reset-init} event handler
9322 to manually reset the peripherals.
9323 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
9324
9325 Cortex-M0, M0+ and M1 do not support @option{vectreset}, use @option{sysresetreq}
9326 instead.
9327 @end deffn
9328
9329 @subsection ARMv8-A specific commands
9330 @cindex ARMv8-A
9331 @cindex aarch64
9332
9333 @deffn Command {aarch64 cache_info}
9334 Display information about target caches
9335 @end deffn
9336
9337 @deffn Command {aarch64 dbginit}
9338 This command enables debugging by clearing the OS Lock and sticky power-down and reset
9339 indications. It also establishes the expected, basic cross-trigger configuration the aarch64
9340 target code relies on. In a configuration file, the command would typically be called from a
9341 @code{reset-end} or @code{reset-deassert-post} handler, to re-enable debugging after a system reset.
9342 However, normally it is not necessary to use the command at all.
9343 @end deffn
9344
9345 @deffn Command {aarch64 smp} [on|off]
9346 Display, enable or disable SMP handling mode. The state of SMP handling influences the way targets in an SMP group
9347 are handled by the run control. With SMP handling enabled, issuing halt or resume to one core will trigger
9348 halting or resuming of all cores in the group. The command @code{target smp} defines which targets are in the SMP
9349 group. With SMP handling disabled, all targets need to be treated individually.
9350 @end deffn
9351
9352 @deffn Command {aarch64 maskisr} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
9353 Selects whether interrupts will be processed when single stepping. The default configuration is
9354 @option{on}.
9355 @end deffn
9356
9357 @deffn Command {$target_name catch_exc} [@option{off}|@option{sec_el1}|@option{sec_el3}|@option{nsec_el1}|@option{nsec_el2}]+
9358 Cause @command{$target_name} to halt when an exception is taken. Any combination of
9359 Secure (sec) EL1/EL3 or Non-Secure (nsec) EL1/EL2 is valid. The target
9360 @command{$target_name} will halt before taking the exception. In order to resume
9361 the target, the exception catch must be disabled again with @command{$target_name catch_exc off}.
9362 Issuing the command without options prints the current configuration.
9363 @end deffn
9364
9365 @section EnSilica eSi-RISC Architecture
9366
9367 eSi-RISC is a highly configurable microprocessor architecture for embedded systems
9368 provided by EnSilica. (See: @url{http://www.ensilica.com/risc-ip/}.)
9369
9370 @subsection eSi-RISC Configuration
9371
9372 @deffn Command {esirisc cache_arch} (@option{harvard}|@option{von_neumann})
9373 Configure the caching architecture. Targets with the @code{UNIFIED_ADDRESS_SPACE}
9374 option disabled employ a Harvard architecture. By default, @option{von_neumann} is assumed.
9375 @end deffn
9376
9377 @deffn Command {esirisc hwdc} (@option{all}|@option{none}|mask ...)
9378 Configure hardware debug control. The HWDC register controls which exceptions return
9379 control back to the debugger. Possible masks are @option{all}, @option{none},
9380 @option{reset}, @option{interrupt}, @option{syscall}, @option{error}, and @option{debug}.
9381 By default, @option{reset}, @option{error}, and @option{debug} are enabled.
9382 @end deffn
9383
9384 @subsection eSi-RISC Operation
9385
9386 @deffn Command {esirisc flush_caches}
9387 Flush instruction and data caches. This command requires that the target is halted
9388 when the command is issued and configured with an instruction or data cache.
9389 @end deffn
9390
9391 @subsection eSi-Trace Configuration
9392
9393 eSi-RISC targets may be configured with support for instruction tracing. Trace
9394 data may be written to an in-memory buffer or FIFO. If a FIFO is configured, DMA
9395 is typically employed to move trace data off-device using a high-speed
9396 peripheral (eg. SPI). Collected trace data is encoded in one of three different
9397 formats. At a minimum, @command{esirisc trace buffer} or @command{esirisc trace
9398 fifo} must be issued along with @command{esirisc trace format} before trace data
9399 can be collected.
9400
9401 OpenOCD provides rudimentary analysis of collected trace data. If more detail is
9402 needed, collected trace data can be dumped to a file and processed by external
9403 tooling.
9404
9405 @quotation Issues
9406 OpenOCD is unable to process trace data sent to a FIFO. A potential workaround
9407 for this issue is to configure DMA to copy trace data to an in-memory buffer,
9408 which can then be passed to the @command{esirisc trace analyze} and
9409 @command{esirisc trace dump} commands.
9410
9411 It is possible to corrupt trace data when using a FIFO if the peripheral
9412 responsible for draining data from the FIFO is not fast enough. This can be
9413 managed by enabling flow control, however this can impact timing-sensitive
9414 software operation on the CPU.
9415 @end quotation
9416
9417 @deffn Command {esirisc trace buffer} address size [@option{wrap}]
9418 Configure trace buffer using the provided address and size. If the @option{wrap}
9419 option is specified, trace collection will continue once the end of the buffer
9420 is reached. By default, wrap is disabled.
9421 @end deffn
9422
9423 @deffn Command {esirisc trace fifo} address
9424 Configure trace FIFO using the provided address.
9425 @end deffn
9426
9427 @deffn Command {esirisc trace flow_control} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
9428 Enable or disable stalling the CPU to collect trace data. By default, flow
9429 control is disabled.
9430 @end deffn
9431
9432 @deffn Command {esirisc trace format} (@option{full}|@option{branch}|@option{icache}) pc_bits
9433 Configure trace format and number of PC bits to be captured. @option{pc_bits}
9434 must be within 1 and 31 as the LSB is not collected. If external tooling is used
9435 to analyze collected trace data, these values must match.
9436
9437 Supported trace formats:
9438 @itemize
9439 @item @option{full} capture full trace data, allowing execution history and
9440 timing to be determined.
9441 @item @option{branch} capture taken branch instructions and branch target
9442 addresses.
9443 @item @option{icache} capture instruction cache misses.
9444 @end itemize
9445 @end deffn
9446
9447 @deffn Command {esirisc trace trigger start} (@option{condition}) [start_data start_mask]
9448 Configure trigger start condition using the provided start data and mask. A
9449 brief description of each condition is provided below; for more detail on how
9450 these values are used, see the eSi-RISC Architecture Manual.
9451
9452 Supported conditions:
9453 @itemize
9454 @item @option{none} manual tracing (see @command{esirisc trace start}).
9455 @item @option{pc} start tracing if the PC matches start data and mask.
9456 @item @option{load} start tracing if the effective address of a load
9457 instruction matches start data and mask.
9458 @item @option{store} start tracing if the effective address of a store
9459 instruction matches start data and mask.
9460 @item @option{exception} start tracing if the EID of an exception matches start
9461 data and mask.
9462 @item @option{eret} start tracing when an @code{ERET} instruction is executed.
9463 @item @option{wait} start tracing when a @code{WAIT} instruction is executed.
9464 @item @option{stop} start tracing when a @code{STOP} instruction is executed.
9465 @item @option{high} start tracing when an external signal is a logical high.
9466 @item @option{low} start tracing when an external signal is a logical low.
9467 @end itemize
9468 @end deffn
9469
9470 @deffn Command {esirisc trace trigger stop} (@option{condition}) [stop_data stop_mask]
9471 Configure trigger stop condition using the provided stop data and mask. A brief
9472 description of each condition is provided below; for more detail on how these
9473 values are used, see the eSi-RISC Architecture Manual.
9474
9475 Supported conditions:
9476 @itemize
9477 @item @option{none} manual tracing (see @command{esirisc trace stop}).
9478 @item @option{pc} stop tracing if the PC matches stop data and mask.
9479 @item @option{load} stop tracing if the effective address of a load
9480 instruction matches stop data and mask.
9481 @item @option{store} stop tracing if the effective address of a store
9482 instruction matches stop data and mask.
9483 @item @option{exception} stop tracing if the EID of an exception matches stop
9484 data and mask.
9485 @item @option{eret} stop tracing when an @code{ERET} instruction is executed.
9486 @item @option{wait} stop tracing when a @code{WAIT} instruction is executed.
9487 @item @option{stop} stop tracing when a @code{STOP} instruction is executed.
9488 @end itemize
9489 @end deffn
9490
9491 @deffn Command {esirisc trace trigger delay} (@option{trigger}) [cycles]
9492 Configure trigger start/stop delay in clock cycles.
9493
9494 Supported triggers:
9495 @itemize
9496 @item @option{none} no delay to start or stop collection.
9497 @item @option{start} delay @option{cycles} after trigger to start collection.
9498 @item @option{stop} delay @option{cycles} after trigger to stop collection.
9499 @item @option{both} delay @option{cycles} after both triggers to start or stop
9500 collection.
9501 @end itemize
9502 @end deffn
9503
9504 @subsection eSi-Trace Operation
9505
9506 @deffn Command {esirisc trace init}
9507 Initialize trace collection. This command must be called any time the
9508 configuration changes. If a trace buffer has been configured, the contents will
9509 be overwritten when trace collection starts.
9510 @end deffn
9511
9512 @deffn Command {esirisc trace info}
9513 Display trace configuration.
9514 @end deffn
9515
9516 @deffn Command {esirisc trace status}
9517 Display trace collection status.
9518 @end deffn
9519
9520 @deffn Command {esirisc trace start}
9521 Start manual trace collection.
9522 @end deffn
9523
9524 @deffn Command {esirisc trace stop}
9525 Stop manual trace collection.
9526 @end deffn
9527
9528 @deffn Command {esirisc trace analyze} [address size]
9529 Analyze collected trace data. This command may only be used if a trace buffer
9530 has been configured. If a trace FIFO has been configured, trace data must be
9531 copied to an in-memory buffer identified by the @option{address} and
9532 @option{size} options using DMA.
9533 @end deffn
9534
9535 @deffn Command {esirisc trace dump} [address size] @file{filename}
9536 Dump collected trace data to file. This command may only be used if a trace
9537 buffer has been configured. If a trace FIFO has been configured, trace data must
9538 be copied to an in-memory buffer identified by the @option{address} and
9539 @option{size} options using DMA.
9540 @end deffn
9541
9542 @section Intel Architecture
9543
9544 Intel Quark X10xx is the first product in the Quark family of SoCs. It is an IA-32
9545 (Pentium x86 ISA) compatible SoC. The core CPU in the X10xx is codenamed Lakemont.
9546 Lakemont version 1 (LMT1) is used in X10xx. The CPU TAP (Lakemont TAP) is used for
9547 software debug and the CLTAP is used for SoC level operations.
9548 Useful docs are here: https://communities.intel.com/community/makers/documentation
9549 @itemize
9550 @item Intel Quark SoC X1000 OpenOCD/GDB/Eclipse App Note (web search for doc num 330015)
9551 @item Intel Quark SoC X1000 Debug Operations User Guide (web search for doc num 329866)
9552 @item Intel Quark SoC X1000 Datasheet (web search for doc num 329676)
9553 @end itemize
9554
9555 @subsection x86 32-bit specific commands
9556 The three main address spaces for x86 are memory, I/O and configuration space.
9557 These commands allow a user to read and write to the 64Kbyte I/O address space.
9558
9559 @deffn Command {x86_32 idw} address
9560 Display the contents of a 32-bit I/O port from address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
9561 @end deffn
9562
9563 @deffn Command {x86_32 idh} address
9564 Display the contents of a 16-bit I/O port from address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
9565 @end deffn
9566
9567 @deffn Command {x86_32 idb} address
9568 Display the contents of a 8-bit I/O port from address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
9569 @end deffn
9570
9571 @deffn Command {x86_32 iww} address
9572 Write the contents of a 32-bit I/O port to address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
9573 @end deffn
9574
9575 @deffn Command {x86_32 iwh} address
9576 Write the contents of a 16-bit I/O port to address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
9577 @end deffn
9578
9579 @deffn Command {x86_32 iwb} address
9580 Write the contents of a 8-bit I/O port to address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
9581 @end deffn
9582
9583 @section OpenRISC Architecture
9584
9585 The OpenRISC CPU is a soft core. It is used in a programmable SoC which can be
9586 configured with any of the TAP / Debug Unit available.
9587
9588 @subsection TAP and Debug Unit selection commands
9589 @deffn Command {tap_select} (@option{vjtag}|@option{mohor}|@option{xilinx_bscan})
9590 Select between the Altera Virtual JTAG , Xilinx Virtual JTAG and Mohor TAP.
9591 @end deffn
9592 @deffn Command {du_select} (@option{adv}|@option{mohor}) [option]
9593 Select between the Advanced Debug Interface and the classic one.
9594
9595 An option can be passed as a second argument to the debug unit.
9596
9597 When using the Advanced Debug Interface, option = 1 means the RTL core is
9598 configured with ADBG_USE_HISPEED = 1. This configuration skips status checking
9599 between bytes while doing read or write bursts.
9600 @end deffn
9601
9602 @subsection Registers commands
9603 @deffn Command {addreg} [name] [address] [feature] [reg_group]
9604 Add a new register in the cpu register list. This register will be
9605 included in the generated target descriptor file.
9606
9607 @strong{[feature]} must be "org.gnu.gdb.or1k.group[0..10]".
9608
9609 @strong{[reg_group]} can be anything. The default register list defines "system",
9610 "dmmu", "immu", "dcache", "icache", "mac", "debug", "perf", "power", "pic"
9611 and "timer" groups.
9612
9613 @emph{example:}
9614 @example
9615 addreg rtest 0x1234 org.gnu.gdb.or1k.group0 system
9616 @end example
9617
9618
9619 @end deffn
9620 @deffn Command {readgroup} (@option{group})
9621 Display all registers in @emph{group}.
9622
9623 @emph{group} can be "system",
9624 "dmmu", "immu", "dcache", "icache", "mac", "debug", "perf", "power", "pic",
9625 "timer" or any new group created with addreg command.
9626 @end deffn
9627
9628 @section RISC-V Architecture
9629
9630 @uref{http://riscv.org/, RISC-V} is a free and open ISA. OpenOCD supports JTAG
9631 debug of RV32 and RV64 cores in heterogeneous multicore systems of up to 32
9632 harts. (It's possible to increase this limit to 1024 by changing
9633 RISCV_MAX_HARTS in riscv.h.) OpenOCD primarily supports 0.13 of the RISC-V
9634 Debug Specification, but there is also support for legacy targets that
9635 implement version 0.11.
9636
9637 @subsection RISC-V Terminology
9638
9639 A @emph{hart} is a hardware thread. A hart may share resources (eg. FPU) with
9640 another hart, or may be a separate core. RISC-V treats those the same, and
9641 OpenOCD exposes each hart as a separate core.
9642
9643 @subsection RISC-V Debug Configuration Commands
9644
9645 @deffn Command {riscv expose_csrs} n0[-m0][,n1[-m1]]...
9646 Configure a list of inclusive ranges for CSRs to expose in addition to the
9647 standard ones. This must be executed before `init`.
9648
9649 By default OpenOCD attempts to expose only CSRs that are mentioned in a spec,
9650 and then only if the corresponding extension appears to be implemented. This
9651 command can be used if OpenOCD gets this wrong, or a target implements custom
9652 CSRs.
9653 @end deffn
9654
9655 @deffn Command {riscv expose_custom} n0[-m0][,n1[-m1]]...
9656 The RISC-V Debug Specification allows targets to expose custom registers
9657 through abstract commands. (See Section 3.5.1.1 in that document.) This command
9658 configures a list of inclusive ranges of those registers to expose. Number 0
9659 indicates the first custom register, whose abstract command number is 0xc000.
9660 This command must be executed before `init`.
9661 @end deffn
9662
9663 @deffn Command {riscv set_command_timeout_sec} [seconds]
9664 Set the wall-clock timeout (in seconds) for individual commands. The default
9665 should work fine for all but the slowest targets (eg. simulators).
9666 @end deffn
9667
9668 @deffn Command {riscv set_reset_timeout_sec} [seconds]
9669 Set the maximum time to wait for a hart to come out of reset after reset is
9670 deasserted.
9671 @end deffn
9672
9673 @deffn Command {riscv set_scratch_ram} none|[address]
9674 Set the address of 16 bytes of scratch RAM the debugger can use, or 'none'.
9675 This is used to access 64-bit floating point registers on 32-bit targets.
9676 @end deffn
9677
9678 @deffn Command {riscv set_prefer_sba} on|off
9679 When on, prefer to use System Bus Access to access memory. When off, prefer to
9680 use the Program Buffer to access memory.
9681 @end deffn
9682
9683 @deffn Command {riscv set_ir} (@option{idcode}|@option{dtmcs}|@option{dmi}) [value]
9684 Set the IR value for the specified JTAG register. This is useful, for
9685 example, when using the existing JTAG interface on a Xilinx FPGA by
9686 way of BSCANE2 primitives that only permit a limited selection of IR
9687 values.
9688
9689 When utilizing version 0.11 of the RISC-V Debug Specification,
9690 @option{dtmcs} and @option{dmi} set the IR values for the DTMCONTROL
9691 and DBUS registers, respectively.
9692 @end deffn
9693
9694 @subsection RISC-V Authentication Commands
9695
9696 The following commands can be used to authenticate to a RISC-V system. Eg. a
9697 trivial challenge-response protocol could be implemented as follows in a
9698 configuration file, immediately following @command{init}:
9699 @example
9700 set challenge [riscv authdata_read]
9701 riscv authdata_write [expr $challenge + 1]
9702 @end example
9703
9704 @deffn Command {riscv authdata_read}
9705 Return the 32-bit value read from authdata.
9706 @end deffn
9707
9708 @deffn Command {riscv authdata_write} value
9709 Write the 32-bit value to authdata.
9710 @end deffn
9711
9712 @subsection RISC-V DMI Commands
9713
9714 The following commands allow direct access to the Debug Module Interface, which
9715 can be used to interact with custom debug features.
9716
9717 @deffn Command {riscv dmi_read}
9718 Perform a 32-bit DMI read at address, returning the value.
9719 @end deffn
9720
9721 @deffn Command {riscv dmi_write} address value
9722 Perform a 32-bit DMI write of value at address.
9723 @end deffn
9724
9725 @section ARC Architecture
9726 @cindex ARC
9727
9728 Synopsys DesignWare ARC Processors are a family of 32-bit CPUs that SoC
9729 designers can optimize for a wide range of uses, from deeply embedded to
9730 high-performance host applications in a variety of market segments. See more
9731 at: http://www.synopsys.com/IP/ProcessorIP/ARCProcessors/Pages/default.aspx.
9732 OpenOCD currently supports ARC EM processors.
9733 There is a set ARC-specific OpenOCD commands that allow low-level
9734 access to the core and provide necessary support for ARC extensibility and
9735 configurability capabilities. ARC processors has much more configuration
9736 capabilities than most of the other processors and in addition there is an
9737 extension interface that allows SoC designers to add custom registers and
9738 instructions. For the OpenOCD that mostly means that set of core and AUX
9739 registers in target will vary and is not fixed for a particular processor
9740 model. To enable extensibility several TCL commands are provided that allow to
9741 describe those optional registers in OpenOCD configuration files. Moreover
9742 those commands allow for a dynamic target features discovery.
9743
9744
9745 @subsection General ARC commands
9746
9747 @deffn {Config Command} {arc add-reg} configparams
9748
9749 Add a new register to processor target. By default newly created register is
9750 marked as not existing. @var{configparams} must have following required
9751 arguments:
9752
9753 @itemize @bullet
9754
9755 @item @code{-name} name
9756 @*Name of a register.
9757
9758 @item @code{-num} number
9759 @*Architectural register number: core register number or AUX register number.
9760
9761 @item @code{-feature} XML_feature
9762 @*Name of GDB XML target description feature.
9763
9764 @end itemize
9765
9766 @var{configparams} may have following optional arguments:
9767
9768 @itemize @bullet
9769
9770 @item @code{-gdbnum} number
9771 @*GDB register number. It is recommended to not assign GDB register number
9772 manually, because there would be a risk that two register will have same
9773 number. When register GDB number is not set with this option, then register
9774 will get a previous register number + 1. This option is required only for those
9775 registers that must be at particular address expected by GDB.
9776
9777 @item @code{-core}
9778 @*This option specifies that register is a core registers. If not - this is an
9779 AUX register. AUX registers and core registers reside in different address
9780 spaces.
9781
9782 @item @code{-bcr}
9783 @*This options specifies that register is a BCR register. BCR means Build
9784 Configuration Registers - this is a special type of AUX registers that are read
9785 only and non-volatile, that is - they never change their value. Therefore OpenOCD
9786 never invalidates values of those registers in internal caches. Because BCR is a
9787 type of AUX registers, this option cannot be used with @code{-core}.
9788
9789 @item @code{-type} type_name
9790 @*Name of type of this register. This can be either one of the basic GDB types,
9791 or a custom types described with @command{arc add-reg-type-[flags|struct]}.
9792
9793 @item @code{-g}
9794 @* If specified then this is a "general" register. General registers are always
9795 read by OpenOCD on context save (when core has just been halted) and is always
9796 transferred to GDB client in a response to g-packet. Contrary to this,
9797 non-general registers are read and sent to GDB client on-demand. In general it
9798 is not recommended to apply this option to custom registers.
9799
9800 @end itemize
9801
9802 @end deffn
9803
9804 @deffn {Config Command} {arc add-reg-type-flags} -name name flags...
9805 Adds new register type of ``flags'' class. ``Flags'' types can contain only
9806 one-bit fields. Each flag definition looks like @code{-flag name bit-position}.
9807 @end deffn
9808
9809 @anchor{add-reg-type-struct}
9810 @deffn {Config Command} {arc add-reg-type-struct} -name name structs...
9811 Adds new register type of ``struct'' class. ``Struct'' types can contain either
9812 bit-fields or fields of other types, however at the moment only bit fields are
9813 supported. Structure bit field definition looks like @code{-bitfield name
9814 startbit endbit}.
9815 @end deffn
9816
9817 @deffn {Command} {arc get-reg-field} reg-name field-name
9818 Returns value of bit-field in a register. Register must be ``struct'' register
9819 type, @xref{add-reg-type-struct} command definition.
9820 @end deffn
9821
9822 @deffn {Command} {arc set-reg-exists} reg-names...
9823 Specify that some register exists. Any amount of names can be passed
9824 as an argument for a single command invocation.
9825 @end deffn
9826
9827 @subsection ARC JTAG commands
9828
9829 @deffn {Command} {arc jtag set-aux-reg} regnum value
9830 This command writes value to AUX register via its number. This command access
9831 register in target directly via JTAG, bypassing any OpenOCD internal caches,
9832 therefore it is unsafe to use if that register can be operated by other means.
9833
9834 @end deffn
9835
9836 @deffn {Command} {arc jtag set-core-reg} regnum value
9837 This command is similar to @command{arc jtag set-aux-reg} but is for core
9838 registers.
9839 @end deffn
9840
9841 @deffn {Command} {arc jtag get-aux-reg} regnum
9842 This command returns the value storded in AUX register via its number. This commands access
9843 register in target directly via JTAG, bypassing any OpenOCD internal caches,
9844 therefore it is unsafe to use if that register can be operated by other means.
9845
9846 @end deffn
9847
9848 @deffn {Command} {arc jtag get-core-reg} regnum
9849 This command is similar to @command{arc jtag get-aux-reg} but is for core
9850 registers.
9851 @end deffn
9852
9853 @section STM8 Architecture
9854 @uref{http://st.com/stm8/, STM8} is a 8-bit microcontroller platform from
9855 STMicroelectronics, based on a proprietary 8-bit core architecture.
9856
9857 OpenOCD supports debugging STM8 through the STMicroelectronics debug
9858 protocol SWIM, @pxref{swimtransport,,SWIM}.
9859
9860 @anchor{softwaredebugmessagesandtracing}
9861 @section Software Debug Messages and Tracing
9862 @cindex Linux-ARM DCC support
9863 @cindex tracing
9864 @cindex libdcc
9865 @cindex DCC
9866 OpenOCD can process certain requests from target software, when
9867 the target uses appropriate libraries.
9868 The most powerful mechanism is semihosting, but there is also
9869 a lighter weight mechanism using only the DCC channel.
9870
9871 Currently @command{target_request debugmsgs}
9872 is supported only for @option{arm7_9} and @option{cortex_m} cores.
9873 These messages are received as part of target polling, so
9874 you need to have @command{poll on} active to receive them.
9875 They are intrusive in that they will affect program execution
9876 times. If that is a problem, @pxref{armhardwaretracing,,ARM Hardware Tracing}.
9877
9878 See @file{libdcc} in the contrib dir for more details.
9879 In addition to sending strings, characters, and
9880 arrays of various size integers from the target,
9881 @file{libdcc} also exports a software trace point mechanism.
9882 The target being debugged may
9883 issue trace messages which include a 24-bit @dfn{trace point} number.
9884 Trace point support includes two distinct mechanisms,
9885 each supported by a command:
9886
9887 @itemize
9888 @item @emph{History} ... A circular buffer of trace points
9889 can be set up, and then displayed at any time.
9890 This tracks where code has been, which can be invaluable in
9891 finding out how some fault was triggered.
9892
9893 The buffer may overflow, since it collects records continuously.
9894 It may be useful to use some of the 24 bits to represent a
9895 particular event, and other bits to hold data.
9896
9897 @item @emph{Counting} ... An array of counters can be set up,
9898 and then displayed at any time.
9899 This can help establish code coverage and identify hot spots.
9900
9901 The array of counters is directly indexed by the trace point
9902 number, so trace points with higher numbers are not counted.
9903 @end itemize
9904
9905 Linux-ARM kernels have a ``Kernel low-level debugging
9906 via EmbeddedICE DCC channel'' option (CONFIG_DEBUG_ICEDCC,
9907 depends on CONFIG_DEBUG_LL) which uses this mechanism to
9908 deliver messages before a serial console can be activated.
9909 This is not the same format used by @file{libdcc}.
9910 Other software, such as the U-Boot boot loader, sometimes
9911 does the same thing.
9912
9913 @deffn Command {target_request debugmsgs} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}|@option{charmsg}]
9914 Displays current handling of target DCC message requests.
9915 These messages may be sent to the debugger while the target is running.
9916 The optional @option{enable} and @option{charmsg} parameters
9917 both enable the messages, while @option{disable} disables them.
9918
9919 With @option{charmsg} the DCC words each contain one character,
9920 as used by Linux with CONFIG_DEBUG_ICEDCC;
9921 otherwise the libdcc format is used.
9922 @end deffn
9923
9924 @deffn Command {trace history} [@option{clear}|count]
9925 With no parameter, displays all the trace points that have triggered
9926 in the order they triggered.
9927 With the parameter @option{clear}, erases all current trace history records.
9928 With a @var{count} parameter, allocates space for that many
9929 history records.
9930 @end deffn
9931
9932 @deffn Command {trace point} [@option{clear}|identifier]
9933 With no parameter, displays all trace point identifiers and how many times
9934 they have been triggered.
9935 With the parameter @option{clear}, erases all current trace point counters.
9936 With a numeric @var{identifier} parameter, creates a new a trace point counter
9937 and associates it with that identifier.
9938
9939 @emph{Important:} The identifier and the trace point number
9940 are not related except by this command.
9941 These trace point numbers always start at zero (from server startup,
9942 or after @command{trace point clear}) and count up from there.
9943 @end deffn
9944
9945
9946 @node JTAG Commands
9947 @chapter JTAG Commands
9948 @cindex JTAG Commands
9949 Most general purpose JTAG commands have been presented earlier.
9950 (@xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}, @ref{Reset Configuration}, and @ref{TAP Declaration}.)
9951 Lower level JTAG commands, as presented here,
9952 may be needed to work with targets which require special
9953 attention during operations such as reset or initialization.
9954
9955 To use these commands you will need to understand some
9956 of the basics of JTAG, including:
9957
9958 @itemize @bullet
9959 @item A JTAG scan chain consists of a sequence of individual TAP
9960 devices such as a CPUs.
9961 @item Control operations involve moving each TAP through the same
9962 standard state machine (in parallel)
9963 using their shared TMS and clock signals.
9964 @item Data transfer involves shifting data through the chain of
9965 instruction or data registers of each TAP, writing new register values
9966 while the reading previous ones.
9967 @item Data register sizes are a function of the instruction active in
9968 a given TAP, while instruction register sizes are fixed for each TAP.
9969 All TAPs support a BYPASS instruction with a single bit data register.
9970 @item The way OpenOCD differentiates between TAP devices is by
9971 shifting different instructions into (and out of) their instruction
9972 registers.
9973 @end itemize
9974
9975 @section Low Level JTAG Commands
9976
9977 These commands are used by developers who need to access
9978 JTAG instruction or data registers, possibly controlling
9979 the order of TAP state transitions.
9980 If you're not debugging OpenOCD internals, or bringing up a
9981 new JTAG adapter or a new type of TAP device (like a CPU or
9982 JTAG router), you probably won't need to use these commands.
9983 In a debug session that doesn't use JTAG for its transport protocol,
9984 these commands are not available.
9985
9986 @deffn Command {drscan} tap [numbits value]+ [@option{-endstate} tap_state]
9987 Loads the data register of @var{tap} with a series of bit fields
9988 that specify the entire register.
9989 Each field is @var{numbits} bits long with
9990 a numeric @var{value} (hexadecimal encouraged).
9991 The return value holds the original value of each
9992 of those fields.
9993
9994 For example, a 38 bit number might be specified as one
9995 field of 32 bits then one of 6 bits.
9996 @emph{For portability, never pass fields which are more
9997 than 32 bits long. Many OpenOCD implementations do not
9998 support 64-bit (or larger) integer values.}
9999
10000 All TAPs other than @var{tap} must be in BYPASS mode.
10001 The single bit in their data registers does not matter.
10002
10003 When @var{tap_state} is specified, the JTAG state machine is left
10004 in that state.
10005 For example @sc{drpause} might be specified, so that more
10006 instructions can be issued before re-entering the @sc{run/idle} state.
10007 If the end state is not specified, the @sc{run/idle} state is entered.
10008
10009 @quotation Warning
10010 OpenOCD does not record information about data register lengths,
10011 so @emph{it is important that you get the bit field lengths right}.
10012 Remember that different JTAG instructions refer to different
10013 data registers, which may have different lengths.
10014 Moreover, those lengths may not be fixed;
10015 the SCAN_N instruction can change the length of
10016 the register accessed by the INTEST instruction
10017 (by connecting a different scan chain).
10018 @end quotation
10019 @end deffn
10020
10021 @deffn Command {flush_count}
10022 Returns the number of times the JTAG queue has been flushed.
10023 This may be used for performance tuning.
10024
10025 For example, flushing a queue over USB involves a
10026 minimum latency, often several milliseconds, which does
10027 not change with the amount of data which is written.
10028 You may be able to identify performance problems by finding
10029 tasks which waste bandwidth by flushing small transfers too often,
10030 instead of batching them into larger operations.
10031 @end deffn
10032
10033 @deffn Command {irscan} [tap instruction]+ [@option{-endstate} tap_state]
10034 For each @var{tap} listed, loads the instruction register
10035 with its associated numeric @var{instruction}.
10036 (The number of bits in that instruction may be displayed
10037 using the @command{scan_chain} command.)
10038 For other TAPs, a BYPASS instruction is loaded.
10039
10040 When @var{tap_state} is specified, the JTAG state machine is left
10041 in that state.
10042 For example @sc{irpause} might be specified, so the data register
10043 can be loaded before re-entering the @sc{run/idle} state.
10044 If the end state is not specified, the @sc{run/idle} state is entered.
10045
10046 @quotation Note
10047 OpenOCD currently supports only a single field for instruction
10048 register values, unlike data register values.
10049 For TAPs where the instruction register length is more than 32 bits,
10050 portable scripts currently must issue only BYPASS instructions.
10051 @end quotation
10052 @end deffn
10053
10054 @deffn Command {pathmove} start_state [next_state ...]
10055 Start by moving to @var{start_state}, which
10056 must be one of the @emph{stable} states.
10057 Unless it is the only state given, this will often be the
10058 current state, so that no TCK transitions are needed.
10059 Then, in a series of single state transitions
10060 (conforming to the JTAG state machine) shift to
10061 each @var{next_state} in sequence, one per TCK cycle.
10062 The final state must also be stable.
10063 @end deffn
10064
10065 @deffn Command {runtest} @var{num_cycles}
10066 Move to the @sc{run/idle} state, and execute at least
10067 @var{num_cycles} of the JTAG clock (TCK).
10068 Instructions often need some time
10069 to execute before they take effect.
10070 @end deffn
10071
10072 @c tms_sequence (short|long)
10073 @c ... temporary, debug-only, other than USBprog bug workaround...
10074
10075 @deffn Command {verify_ircapture} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
10076 Verify values captured during @sc{ircapture} and returned
10077 during IR scans. Default is enabled, but this can be
10078 overridden by @command{verify_jtag}.
10079 This flag is ignored when validating JTAG chain configuration.
10080 @end deffn
10081
10082 @deffn Command {verify_jtag} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
10083 Enables verification of DR and IR scans, to help detect
10084 programming errors. For IR scans, @command{verify_ircapture}
10085 must also be enabled.
10086 Default is enabled.
10087 @end deffn
10088
10089 @section TAP state names
10090 @cindex TAP state names
10091
10092 The @var{tap_state} names used by OpenOCD in the @command{drscan},
10093 @command{irscan}, and @command{pathmove} commands are the same
10094 as those used in SVF boundary scan documents, except that
10095 SVF uses @sc{idle} instead of @sc{run/idle}.
10096
10097 @itemize @bullet
10098 @item @b{RESET} ... @emph{stable} (with TMS high);
10099 acts as if TRST were pulsed
10100 @item @b{RUN/IDLE} ... @emph{stable}; don't assume this always means IDLE
10101 @item @b{DRSELECT}
10102 @item @b{DRCAPTURE}
10103 @item @b{DRSHIFT} ... @emph{stable}; TDI/TDO shifting
10104 through the data register
10105 @item @b{DREXIT1}
10106 @item @b{DRPAUSE} ... @emph{stable}; data register ready
10107 for update or more shifting
10108 @item @b{DREXIT2}
10109 @item @b{DRUPDATE}
10110 @item @b{IRSELECT}
10111 @item @b{IRCAPTURE}
10112 @item @b{IRSHIFT} ... @emph{stable}; TDI/TDO shifting
10113 through the instruction register
10114 @item @b{IREXIT1}
10115 @item @b{IRPAUSE} ... @emph{stable}; instruction register ready
10116 for update or more shifting
10117 @item @b{IREXIT2}
10118 @item @b{IRUPDATE}
10119 @end itemize
10120
10121 Note that only six of those states are fully ``stable'' in the
10122 face of TMS fixed (low except for @sc{reset})
10123 and a free-running JTAG clock. For all the
10124 others, the next TCK transition changes to a new state.
10125
10126 @itemize @bullet
10127 @item From @sc{drshift} and @sc{irshift}, clock transitions will
10128 produce side effects by changing register contents. The values
10129 to be latched in upcoming @sc{drupdate} or @sc{irupdate} states
10130 may not be as expected.
10131 @item @sc{run/idle}, @sc{drpause}, and @sc{irpause} are reasonable
10132 choices after @command{drscan} or @command{irscan} commands,
10133 since they are free of JTAG side effects.
10134 @item @sc{run/idle} may have side effects that appear at non-JTAG
10135 levels, such as advancing the ARM9E-S instruction pipeline.
10136 Consult the documentation for the TAP(s) you are working with.
10137 @end itemize
10138
10139 @node Boundary Scan Commands
10140 @chapter Boundary Scan Commands
10141
10142 One of the original purposes of JTAG was to support
10143 boundary scan based hardware testing.
10144 Although its primary focus is to support On-Chip Debugging,
10145 OpenOCD also includes some boundary scan commands.
10146
10147 @section SVF: Serial Vector Format
10148 @cindex Serial Vector Format
10149 @cindex SVF
10150
10151 The Serial Vector Format, better known as @dfn{SVF}, is a
10152 way to represent JTAG test patterns in text files.
10153 In a debug session using JTAG for its transport protocol,
10154 OpenOCD supports running such test files.
10155
10156 @deffn Command {svf} @file{filename} [@option{-tap @var{tapname}}] [@option{[-]quiet}] @
10157 [@option{[-]nil}] [@option{[-]progress}] [@option{[-]ignore_error}]
10158 This issues a JTAG reset (Test-Logic-Reset) and then
10159 runs the SVF script from @file{filename}.
10160
10161 Arguments can be specified in any order; the optional dash doesn't
10162 affect their semantics.
10163
10164 Command options:
10165 @itemize @minus
10166 @item @option{-tap @var{tapname}} ignore IR and DR headers and footers
10167 specified by the SVF file with HIR, TIR, HDR and TDR commands;
10168 instead, calculate them automatically according to the current JTAG
10169 chain configuration, targeting @var{tapname};
10170 @item @option{[-]quiet} do not log every command before execution;
10171 @item @option{[-]nil} ``dry run'', i.e., do not perform any operations
10172 on the real interface;
10173 @item @option{[-]progress} enable progress indication;
10174 @item @option{[-]ignore_error} continue execution despite TDO check
10175 errors.
10176 @end itemize
10177 @end deffn
10178
10179 @section XSVF: Xilinx Serial Vector Format
10180 @cindex Xilinx Serial Vector Format
10181 @cindex XSVF
10182
10183 The Xilinx Serial Vector Format, better known as @dfn{XSVF}, is a
10184 binary representation of SVF which is optimized for use with
10185 Xilinx devices.
10186 In a debug session using JTAG for its transport protocol,
10187 OpenOCD supports running such test files.
10188
10189 @quotation Important
10190 Not all XSVF commands are supported.
10191 @end quotation
10192
10193 @deffn Command {xsvf} (tapname|@option{plain}) filename [@option{virt2}] [@option{quiet}]
10194 This issues a JTAG reset (Test-Logic-Reset) and then
10195 runs the XSVF script from @file{filename}.
10196 When a @var{tapname} is specified, the commands are directed at
10197 that TAP.
10198 When @option{virt2} is specified, the @sc{xruntest} command counts
10199 are interpreted as TCK cycles instead of microseconds.
10200 Unless the @option{quiet} option is specified,
10201 messages are logged for comments and some retries.
10202 @end deffn
10203
10204 The OpenOCD sources also include two utility scripts
10205 for working with XSVF; they are not currently installed
10206 after building the software.
10207 You may find them useful:
10208
10209 @itemize
10210 @item @emph{svf2xsvf} ... converts SVF files into the extended XSVF
10211 syntax understood by the @command{xsvf} command; see notes below.
10212 @item @emph{xsvfdump} ... converts XSVF files into a text output format;
10213 understands the OpenOCD extensions.
10214 @end itemize
10215
10216 The input format accepts a handful of non-standard extensions.
10217 These include three opcodes corresponding to SVF extensions
10218 from Lattice Semiconductor (LCOUNT, LDELAY, LDSR), and
10219 two opcodes supporting a more accurate translation of SVF
10220 (XTRST, XWAITSTATE).
10221 If @emph{xsvfdump} shows a file is using those opcodes, it
10222 probably will not be usable with other XSVF tools.
10223
10224
10225 @node Utility Commands
10226 @chapter Utility Commands
10227 @cindex Utility Commands
10228
10229 @section RAM testing
10230 @cindex RAM testing
10231
10232 There is often a need to stress-test random access memory (RAM) for
10233 errors. OpenOCD comes with a Tcl implementation of well-known memory
10234 testing procedures allowing the detection of all sorts of issues with
10235 electrical wiring, defective chips, PCB layout and other common
10236 hardware problems.
10237
10238 To use them, you usually need to initialise your RAM controller first;
10239 consult your SoC's documentation to get the recommended list of
10240 register operations and translate them to the corresponding
10241 @command{mww}/@command{mwb} commands.
10242
10243 Load the memory testing functions with
10244
10245 @example
10246 source [find tools/memtest.tcl]
10247 @end example
10248
10249 to get access to the following facilities:
10250
10251 @deffn Command {memTestDataBus} address
10252 Test the data bus wiring in a memory region by performing a walking
10253 1's test at a fixed address within that region.
10254 @end deffn
10255
10256 @deffn Command {memTestAddressBus} baseaddress size
10257 Perform a walking 1's test on the relevant bits of the address and
10258 check for aliasing. This test will find single-bit address failures
10259 such as stuck-high, stuck-low, and shorted pins.
10260 @end deffn
10261
10262 @deffn Command {memTestDevice} baseaddress size
10263 Test the integrity of a physical memory device by performing an
10264 increment/decrement test over the entire region. In the process every
10265 storage bit in the device is tested as zero and as one.
10266 @end deffn
10267
10268 @deffn Command {runAllMemTests} baseaddress size
10269 Run all of the above tests over a specified memory region.
10270 @end deffn
10271
10272 @section Firmware recovery helpers
10273 @cindex Firmware recovery
10274
10275 OpenOCD includes an easy-to-use script to facilitate mass-market
10276 devices recovery with JTAG.
10277
10278 For quickstart instructions run:
10279 @example
10280 openocd -f tools/firmware-recovery.tcl -c firmware_help
10281 @end example
10282
10283 @node TFTP
10284 @chapter TFTP
10285 @cindex TFTP
10286 If OpenOCD runs on an embedded host (as ZY1000 does), then TFTP can
10287 be used to access files on PCs (either the developer's PC or some other PC).
10288
10289 The way this works on the ZY1000 is to prefix a filename by
10290 "/tftp/ip/" and append the TFTP path on the TFTP
10291 server (tftpd). For example,
10292
10293 @example
10294 load_image /tftp/10.0.0.96/c:\temp\abc.elf
10295 @end example
10296
10297 will load c:\temp\abc.elf from the developer pc (10.0.0.96) into memory as
10298 if the file was hosted on the embedded host.
10299
10300 In order to achieve decent performance, you must choose a TFTP server
10301 that supports a packet size bigger than the default packet size (512 bytes). There
10302 are numerous TFTP servers out there (free and commercial) and you will have to do
10303 a bit of googling to find something that fits your requirements.
10304
10305 @node GDB and OpenOCD
10306 @chapter GDB and OpenOCD
10307 @cindex GDB
10308 OpenOCD complies with the remote gdbserver protocol and, as such, can be used
10309 to debug remote targets.
10310 Setting up GDB to work with OpenOCD can involve several components:
10311
10312 @itemize
10313 @item The OpenOCD server support for GDB may need to be configured.
10314 @xref{gdbconfiguration,,GDB Configuration}.
10315 @item GDB's support for OpenOCD may need configuration,
10316 as shown in this chapter.
10317 @item If you have a GUI environment like Eclipse,
10318 that also will probably need to be configured.
10319 @end itemize
10320
10321 Of course, the version of GDB you use will need to be one which has
10322 been built to know about the target CPU you're using. It's probably
10323 part of the tool chain you're using. For example, if you are doing
10324 cross-development for ARM on an x86 PC, instead of using the native
10325 x86 @command{gdb} command you might use @command{arm-none-eabi-gdb}
10326 if that's the tool chain used to compile your code.
10327
10328 @section Connecting to GDB
10329 @cindex Connecting to GDB
10330 Use GDB 6.7 or newer with OpenOCD if you run into trouble. For
10331 instance GDB 6.3 has a known bug that produces bogus memory access
10332 errors, which has since been fixed; see
10333 @url{http://osdir.com/ml/gdb.bugs.discuss/2004-12/msg00018.html}
10334
10335 OpenOCD can communicate with GDB in two ways:
10336
10337 @enumerate
10338 @item
10339 A socket (TCP/IP) connection is typically started as follows:
10340 @example
10341 target extended-remote localhost:3333
10342 @end example
10343 This would cause GDB to connect to the gdbserver on the local pc using port 3333.
10344
10345 The extended remote protocol is a super-set of the remote protocol and should
10346 be the preferred choice. More details are available in GDB documentation
10347 @url{https://sourceware.org/gdb/onlinedocs/gdb/Connecting.html}
10348
10349 To speed-up typing, any GDB command can be abbreviated, including the extended
10350 remote command above that becomes:
10351 @example
10352 tar ext :3333
10353 @end example
10354
10355 @b{Note:} If any backward compatibility issue requires using the old remote
10356 protocol in place of the extended remote one, the former protocol is still
10357 available through the command:
10358 @example
10359 target remote localhost:3333
10360 @end example
10361
10362 @item
10363 A pipe connection is typically started as follows:
10364 @example
10365 target extended-remote | openocd -c "gdb_port pipe; log_output openocd.log"
10366 @end example
10367 This would cause GDB to run OpenOCD and communicate using pipes (stdin/stdout).
10368 Using this method has the advantage of GDB starting/stopping OpenOCD for the debug
10369 session. log_output sends the log output to a file to ensure that the pipe is
10370 not saturated when using higher debug level outputs.
10371 @end enumerate
10372
10373 To list the available OpenOCD commands type @command{monitor help} on the
10374 GDB command line.
10375
10376 @section Sample GDB session startup
10377
10378 With the remote protocol, GDB sessions start a little differently
10379 than they do when you're debugging locally.
10380 Here's an example showing how to start a debug session with a
10381 small ARM program.
10382 In this case the program was linked to be loaded into SRAM on a Cortex-M3.
10383 Most programs would be written into flash (address 0) and run from there.
10384
10385 @example
10386 $ arm-none-eabi-gdb example.elf
10387 (gdb) target extended-remote localhost:3333
10388 Remote debugging using localhost:3333
10389 ...
10390 (gdb) monitor reset halt
10391 ...
10392 (gdb) load
10393 Loading section .vectors, size 0x100 lma 0x20000000
10394 Loading section .text, size 0x5a0 lma 0x20000100
10395 Loading section .data, size 0x18 lma 0x200006a0
10396 Start address 0x2000061c, load size 1720
10397 Transfer rate: 22 KB/sec, 573 bytes/write.
10398 (gdb) continue
10399 Continuing.
10400 ...
10401 @end example
10402
10403 You could then interrupt the GDB session to make the program break,
10404 type @command{where} to show the stack, @command{list} to show the
10405 code around the program counter, @command{step} through code,
10406 set breakpoints or watchpoints, and so on.
10407
10408 @section Configuring GDB for OpenOCD
10409
10410 OpenOCD supports the gdb @option{qSupported} packet, this enables information
10411 to be sent by the GDB remote server (i.e. OpenOCD) to GDB. Typical information includes
10412 packet size and the device's memory map.
10413 You do not need to configure the packet size by hand,
10414 and the relevant parts of the memory map should be automatically
10415 set up when you declare (NOR) flash banks.
10416
10417 However, there are other things which GDB can't currently query.
10418 You may need to set those up by hand.
10419 As OpenOCD starts up, you will often see a line reporting
10420 something like:
10421
10422 @example
10423 Info : lm3s.cpu: hardware has 6 breakpoints, 4 watchpoints
10424 @end example
10425
10426 You can pass that information to GDB with these commands:
10427
10428 @example
10429 set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit 6
10430 set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit 4
10431 @end example
10432
10433 With that particular hardware (Cortex-M3) the hardware breakpoints
10434 only work for code running from flash memory. Most other ARM systems
10435 do not have such restrictions.
10436
10437 Rather than typing such commands interactively, you may prefer to
10438 save them in a file and have GDB execute them as it starts, perhaps
10439 using a @file{.gdbinit} in your project directory or starting GDB
10440 using @command{gdb -x filename}.
10441
10442 @section Programming using GDB
10443 @cindex Programming using GDB
10444 @anchor{programmingusinggdb}
10445
10446 By default the target memory map is sent to GDB. This can be disabled by
10447 the following OpenOCD configuration option:
10448 @example
10449 gdb_memory_map disable
10450 @end example
10451 For this to function correctly a valid flash configuration must also be set
10452 in OpenOCD. For faster performance you should also configure a valid
10453 working area.
10454
10455 Informing GDB of the memory map of the target will enable GDB to protect any
10456 flash areas of the target and use hardware breakpoints by default. This means
10457 that the OpenOCD option @command{gdb_breakpoint_override} is not required when
10458 using a memory map. @xref{gdbbreakpointoverride,,gdb_breakpoint_override}.
10459
10460 To view the configured memory map in GDB, use the GDB command @option{info mem}.
10461 All other unassigned addresses within GDB are treated as RAM.
10462
10463 GDB 6.8 and higher set any memory area not in the memory map as inaccessible.
10464 This can be changed to the old behaviour by using the following GDB command
10465 @example
10466 set mem inaccessible-by-default off
10467 @end example
10468
10469 If @command{gdb_flash_program enable} is also used, GDB will be able to
10470 program any flash memory using the vFlash interface.
10471
10472 GDB will look at the target memory map when a load command is given, if any
10473 areas to be programmed lie within the target flash area the vFlash packets
10474 will be used.
10475
10476 If the target needs configuring before GDB programming, set target
10477 event gdb-flash-erase-start:
10478 @example
10479 $_TARGETNAME configure -event gdb-flash-erase-start BODY
10480 @end example
10481 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}, for other GDB programming related events.
10482
10483 To verify any flash programming the GDB command @option{compare-sections}
10484 can be used.
10485
10486 @section Using GDB as a non-intrusive memory inspector
10487 @cindex Using GDB as a non-intrusive memory inspector
10488 @anchor{gdbmeminspect}
10489
10490 If your project controls more than a blinking LED, let's say a heavy industrial
10491 robot or an experimental nuclear reactor, stopping the controlling process
10492 just because you want to attach GDB is not a good option.
10493
10494 OpenOCD does not support GDB non-stop mode (might be implemented in the future).
10495 Though there is a possible setup where the target does not get stopped
10496 and GDB treats it as it were running.
10497 If the target supports background access to memory while it is running,
10498 you can use GDB in this mode to inspect memory (mainly global variables)
10499 without any intrusion of the target process.
10500
10501 Remove default setting of gdb-attach event. @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
10502 Place following command after target configuration:
10503 @example
10504 $_TARGETNAME configure -event gdb-attach @{@}
10505 @end example
10506
10507 If any of installed flash banks does not support probe on running target,
10508 switch off gdb_memory_map:
10509 @example
10510 gdb_memory_map disable
10511 @end example
10512
10513 Ensure GDB is configured without interrupt-on-connect.
10514 Some GDB versions set it by default, some does not.
10515 @example
10516 set remote interrupt-on-connect off
10517 @end example
10518
10519 If you switched gdb_memory_map off, you may want to setup GDB memory map
10520 manually or issue @command{set mem inaccessible-by-default off}
10521
10522 Now you can issue GDB command @command{target extended-remote ...} and inspect memory
10523 of a running target. Do not use GDB commands @command{continue},
10524 @command{step} or @command{next} as they synchronize GDB with your target
10525 and GDB would require stopping the target to get the prompt back.
10526
10527 Do not use this mode under an IDE like Eclipse as it caches values of
10528 previously shown varibles.
10529
10530 @section RTOS Support
10531 @cindex RTOS Support
10532 @anchor{gdbrtossupport}
10533
10534 OpenOCD includes RTOS support, this will however need enabling as it defaults to disabled.
10535 It can be enabled by passing @option{-rtos} arg to the target. @xref{rtostype,,RTOS Type}.
10536
10537 @xref{Threads, Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads,
10538 Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads, gdb, GDB manual}, for details about relevant
10539 GDB commands.
10540
10541 @* An example setup is below:
10542
10543 @example
10544 $_TARGETNAME configure -rtos auto
10545 @end example
10546
10547 This will attempt to auto detect the RTOS within your application.
10548
10549 Currently supported rtos's include:
10550 @itemize @bullet
10551 @item @option{eCos}
10552 @item @option{ThreadX}
10553 @item @option{FreeRTOS}
10554 @item @option{linux}
10555 @item @option{ChibiOS}
10556 @item @option{embKernel}
10557 @item @option{mqx}
10558 @item @option{uCOS-III}
10559 @item @option{nuttx}
10560 @item @option{RIOT}
10561 @item @option{hwthread} (This is not an actual RTOS. @xref{usingopenocdsmpwithgdb,,Using OpenOCD SMP with GDB}.)
10562 @end itemize
10563
10564 Before an RTOS can be detected, it must export certain symbols; otherwise, it cannot
10565 be used by OpenOCD. Below is a list of the required symbols for each supported RTOS.
10566
10567 @table @code
10568 @item eCos symbols
10569 Cyg_Thread::thread_list, Cyg_Scheduler_Base::current_thread.
10570 @item ThreadX symbols
10571 _tx_thread_current_ptr, _tx_thread_created_ptr, _tx_thread_created_count.
10572 @item FreeRTOS symbols
10573 @c The following is taken from recent texinfo to provide compatibility
10574 @c with ancient versions that do not support @raggedright
10575 @tex
10576 \begingroup
10577 \rightskip0pt plus2em \spaceskip.3333em \xspaceskip.5em\relax
10578 pxCurrentTCB, pxReadyTasksLists, xDelayedTaskList1, xDelayedTaskList2,
10579 pxDelayedTaskList, pxOverflowDelayedTaskList, xPendingReadyList,
10580 uxCurrentNumberOfTasks, uxTopUsedPriority.
10581 \par
10582 \endgroup
10583 @end tex
10584 @item linux symbols
10585 init_task.
10586 @item ChibiOS symbols
10587 rlist, ch_debug, chSysInit.
10588 @item embKernel symbols
10589 Rtos::sCurrentTask, Rtos::sListReady, Rtos::sListSleep,
10590 Rtos::sListSuspended, Rtos::sMaxPriorities, Rtos::sCurrentTaskCount.
10591 @item mqx symbols
10592 _mqx_kernel_data, MQX_init_struct.
10593 @item uC/OS-III symbols
10594 OSRunning, OSTCBCurPtr, OSTaskDbgListPtr, OSTaskQty
10595 @item nuttx symbols
10596 g_readytorun, g_tasklisttable
10597 @item RIOT symbols
10598 sched_threads, sched_num_threads, sched_active_pid, max_threads, _tcb_name_offset
10599 @end table
10600
10601 For most RTOS supported the above symbols will be exported by default. However for
10602 some, eg. FreeRTOS and uC/OS-III, extra steps must be taken.
10603
10604 These RTOSes may require additional OpenOCD-specific file to be linked
10605 along with the project:
10606
10607 @table @code
10608 @item FreeRTOS
10609 contrib/rtos-helpers/FreeRTOS-openocd.c
10610 @item uC/OS-III
10611 contrib/rtos-helpers/uCOS-III-openocd.c
10612 @end table
10613
10614 @anchor{usingopenocdsmpwithgdb}
10615 @section Using OpenOCD SMP with GDB
10616 @cindex SMP
10617 @cindex RTOS
10618 @cindex hwthread
10619 OpenOCD includes a pseudo RTOS called @emph{hwthread} that presents CPU cores
10620 ("hardware threads") in an SMP system as threads to GDB. With this extension,
10621 GDB can be used to inspect the state of an SMP system in a natural way.
10622 After halting the system, using the GDB command @command{info threads} will
10623 list the context of each active CPU core in the system. GDB's @command{thread}
10624 command can be used to switch the view to a different CPU core.
10625 The @command{step} and @command{stepi} commands can be used to step a specific core
10626 while other cores are free-running or remain halted, depending on the
10627 scheduler-locking mode configured in GDB.
10628
10629 @section Legacy SMP core switching support
10630 @quotation Note
10631 This method is deprecated in favor of the @emph{hwthread} pseudo RTOS.
10632 @end quotation
10633
10634 For SMP support following GDB serial protocol packet have been defined :
10635 @itemize @bullet
10636 @item j - smp status request
10637 @item J - smp set request
10638 @end itemize
10639
10640 OpenOCD implements :
10641 @itemize @bullet
10642 @item @option{jc} packet for reading core id displayed by
10643 GDB connection. Reply is @option{XXXXXXXX} (8 hex digits giving core id) or
10644 @option{E01} for target not smp.
10645 @item @option{JcXXXXXXXX} (8 hex digits) packet for setting core id displayed at next GDB continue
10646 (core id -1 is reserved for returning to normal resume mode). Reply @option{E01}
10647 for target not smp or @option{OK} on success.
10648 @end itemize
10649
10650 Handling of this packet within GDB can be done :
10651 @itemize @bullet
10652 @item by the creation of an internal variable (i.e @option{_core}) by mean
10653 of function allocate_computed_value allowing following GDB command.
10654 @example
10655 set $_core 1
10656 #Jc01 packet is sent
10657 print $_core
10658 #jc packet is sent and result is affected in $
10659 @end example
10660
10661 @item by the usage of GDB maintenance command as described in following example (2 cpus in SMP with
10662 core id 0 and 1 @pxref{definecputargetsworkinginsmp,,Define CPU targets working in SMP}).
10663
10664 @example
10665 # toggle0 : force display of coreid 0
10666 define toggle0
10667 maint packet Jc0
10668 continue
10669 main packet Jc-1
10670 end
10671 # toggle1 : force display of coreid 1
10672 define toggle1
10673 maint packet Jc1
10674 continue
10675 main packet Jc-1
10676 end
10677 @end example
10678 @end itemize
10679
10680 @node Tcl Scripting API
10681 @chapter Tcl Scripting API
10682 @cindex Tcl Scripting API
10683 @cindex Tcl scripts
10684 @section API rules
10685
10686 Tcl commands are stateless; e.g. the @command{telnet} command has
10687 a concept of currently active target, the Tcl API proc's take this sort
10688 of state information as an argument to each proc.
10689
10690 There are three main types of return values: single value, name value
10691 pair list and lists.
10692
10693 Name value pair. The proc 'foo' below returns a name/value pair
10694 list.
10695
10696 @example
10697 > set foo(me) Duane
10698 > set foo(you) Oyvind
10699 > set foo(mouse) Micky
10700 > set foo(duck) Donald
10701 @end example
10702
10703 If one does this:
10704
10705 @example
10706 > set foo
10707 @end example
10708
10709 The result is:
10710
10711 @example
10712 me Duane you Oyvind mouse Micky duck Donald
10713 @end example
10714
10715 Thus, to get the names of the associative array is easy:
10716
10717 @verbatim
10718 foreach { name value } [set foo] {
10719 puts "Name: $name, Value: $value"
10720 }
10721 @end verbatim
10722
10723 Lists returned should be relatively small. Otherwise, a range
10724 should be passed in to the proc in question.
10725
10726 @section Internal low-level Commands
10727
10728 By "low-level," we mean commands that a human would typically not
10729 invoke directly.
10730
10731 @itemize @bullet
10732 @item @b{mem2array} <@var{varname}> <@var{width}> <@var{addr}> <@var{nelems}>
10733
10734 Read memory and return as a Tcl array for script processing
10735 @item @b{array2mem} <@var{varname}> <@var{width}> <@var{addr}> <@var{nelems}>
10736
10737 Convert a Tcl array to memory locations and write the values
10738 @item @b{flash banks} <@var{driver}> <@var{base}> <@var{size}> <@var{chip_width}> <@var{bus_width}> <@var{target}> [@option{driver options} ...]
10739
10740 Return information about the flash banks
10741
10742 @item @b{capture} <@var{command}>
10743
10744 Run <@var{command}> and return full log output that was produced during
10745 its execution. Example:
10746
10747 @example
10748 > capture "reset init"
10749 @end example
10750
10751 @end itemize
10752
10753 OpenOCD commands can consist of two words, e.g. "flash banks". The
10754 @file{startup.tcl} "unknown" proc will translate this into a Tcl proc
10755 called "flash_banks".
10756
10757 @section OpenOCD specific Global Variables
10758
10759 Real Tcl has ::tcl_platform(), and platform::identify, and many other
10760 variables. JimTCL, as implemented in OpenOCD creates $ocd_HOSTOS which
10761 holds one of the following values:
10762
10763 @itemize @bullet
10764 @item @b{cygwin} Running under Cygwin
10765 @item @b{darwin} Darwin (Mac-OS) is the underlying operating system.
10766 @item @b{freebsd} Running under FreeBSD
10767 @item @b{openbsd} Running under OpenBSD
10768 @item @b{netbsd} Running under NetBSD
10769 @item @b{linux} Linux is the underlying operating system
10770 @item @b{mingw32} Running under MingW32
10771 @item @b{winxx} Built using Microsoft Visual Studio
10772 @item @b{ecos} Running under eCos
10773 @item @b{other} Unknown, none of the above.
10774 @end itemize
10775
10776 Note: 'winxx' was chosen because today (March-2009) no distinction is made between Win32 and Win64.
10777
10778 @quotation Note
10779 We should add support for a variable like Tcl variable
10780 @code{tcl_platform(platform)}, it should be called
10781 @code{jim_platform} (because it
10782 is jim, not real tcl).
10783 @end quotation
10784
10785 @section Tcl RPC server
10786 @cindex RPC
10787
10788 OpenOCD provides a simple RPC server that allows to run arbitrary Tcl
10789 commands and receive the results.
10790
10791 To access it, your application needs to connect to a configured TCP port
10792 (see @command{tcl_port}). Then it can pass any string to the
10793 interpreter terminating it with @code{0x1a} and wait for the return
10794 value (it will be terminated with @code{0x1a} as well). This can be
10795 repeated as many times as desired without reopening the connection.
10796
10797 It is not needed anymore to prefix the OpenOCD commands with
10798 @code{ocd_} to get the results back. But sometimes you might need the
10799 @command{capture} command.
10800
10801 See @file{contrib/rpc_examples/} for specific client implementations.
10802
10803 @section Tcl RPC server notifications
10804 @cindex RPC Notifications
10805
10806 Notifications are sent asynchronously to other commands being executed over
10807 the RPC server, so the port must be polled continuously.
10808
10809 Target event, state and reset notifications are emitted as Tcl associative arrays
10810 in the following format.
10811
10812 @verbatim
10813 type target_event event [event-name]
10814 type target_state state [state-name]
10815 type target_reset mode [reset-mode]
10816 @end verbatim
10817
10818 @deffn {Command} tcl_notifications [on/off]
10819 Toggle output of target notifications to the current Tcl RPC server.
10820 Only available from the Tcl RPC server.
10821 Defaults to off.
10822
10823 @end deffn
10824
10825 @section Tcl RPC server trace output
10826 @cindex RPC trace output
10827
10828 Trace data is sent asynchronously to other commands being executed over
10829 the RPC server, so the port must be polled continuously.
10830
10831 Target trace data is emitted as a Tcl associative array in the following format.
10832
10833 @verbatim
10834 type target_trace data [trace-data-hex-encoded]
10835 @end verbatim
10836
10837 @deffn {Command} tcl_trace [on/off]
10838 Toggle output of target trace data to the current Tcl RPC server.
10839 Only available from the Tcl RPC server.
10840 Defaults to off.
10841
10842 See an example application here:
10843 @url{https://github.com/apmorton/OpenOcdTraceUtil} [OpenOcdTraceUtil]
10844
10845 @end deffn
10846
10847 @node FAQ
10848 @chapter FAQ
10849 @cindex faq
10850 @enumerate
10851 @anchor{faqrtck}
10852 @item @b{RTCK, also known as: Adaptive Clocking - What is it?}
10853 @cindex RTCK
10854 @cindex adaptive clocking
10855 @*
10856
10857 In digital circuit design it is often referred to as ``clock
10858 synchronisation'' the JTAG interface uses one clock (TCK or TCLK)
10859 operating at some speed, your CPU target is operating at another.
10860 The two clocks are not synchronised, they are ``asynchronous''
10861
10862 In order for the two to work together they must be synchronised
10863 well enough to work; JTAG can't go ten times faster than the CPU,
10864 for example. There are 2 basic options:
10865 @enumerate
10866 @item
10867 Use a special "adaptive clocking" circuit to change the JTAG
10868 clock rate to match what the CPU currently supports.
10869 @item
10870 The JTAG clock must be fixed at some speed that's enough slower than
10871 the CPU clock that all TMS and TDI transitions can be detected.
10872 @end enumerate
10873
10874 @b{Does this really matter?} For some chips and some situations, this
10875 is a non-issue, like a 500MHz ARM926 with a 5 MHz JTAG link;
10876 the CPU has no difficulty keeping up with JTAG.
10877 Startup sequences are often problematic though, as are other
10878 situations where the CPU clock rate changes (perhaps to save
10879 power).
10880
10881 For example, Atmel AT91SAM chips start operation from reset with
10882 a 32kHz system clock. Boot firmware may activate the main oscillator
10883 and PLL before switching to a faster clock (perhaps that 500 MHz
10884 ARM926 scenario).
10885 If you're using JTAG to debug that startup sequence, you must slow
10886 the JTAG clock to sometimes 1 to 4kHz. After startup completes,
10887 JTAG can use a faster clock.
10888
10889 Consider also debugging a 500MHz ARM926 hand held battery powered
10890 device that enters a low power ``deep sleep'' mode, at 32kHz CPU
10891 clock, between keystrokes unless it has work to do. When would
10892 that 5 MHz JTAG clock be usable?
10893
10894 @b{Solution #1 - A special circuit}
10895
10896 In order to make use of this,
10897 your CPU, board, and JTAG adapter must all support the RTCK
10898 feature. Not all of them support this; keep reading!
10899
10900 The RTCK ("Return TCK") signal in some ARM chips is used to help with
10901 this problem. ARM has a good description of the problem described at
10902 this link: @url{http://www.arm.com/support/faqdev/4170.html} [checked
10903 28/nov/2008]. Link title: ``How does the JTAG synchronisation logic
10904 work? / how does adaptive clocking work?''.
10905
10906 The nice thing about adaptive clocking is that ``battery powered hand
10907 held device example'' - the adaptiveness works perfectly all the
10908 time. One can set a break point or halt the system in the deep power
10909 down code, slow step out until the system speeds up.
10910
10911 Note that adaptive clocking may also need to work at the board level,
10912 when a board-level scan chain has multiple chips.
10913 Parallel clock voting schemes are good way to implement this,
10914 both within and between chips, and can easily be implemented
10915 with a CPLD.
10916 It's not difficult to have logic fan a module's input TCK signal out
10917 to each TAP in the scan chain, and then wait until each TAP's RTCK comes
10918 back with the right polarity before changing the output RTCK signal.
10919 Texas Instruments makes some clock voting logic available
10920 for free (with no support) in VHDL form; see
10921 @url{http://tiexpressdsp.com/index.php/Adaptive_Clocking}
10922
10923 @b{Solution #2 - Always works - but may be slower}
10924
10925 Often this is a perfectly acceptable solution.
10926
10927 In most simple terms: Often the JTAG clock must be 1/10 to 1/12 of
10928 the target clock speed. But what that ``magic division'' is varies
10929 depending on the chips on your board.
10930 @b{ARM rule of thumb} Most ARM based systems require an 6:1 division;
10931 ARM11 cores use an 8:1 division.
10932 @b{Xilinx rule of thumb} is 1/12 the clock speed.
10933
10934 Note: most full speed FT2232 based JTAG adapters are limited to a
10935 maximum of 6MHz. The ones using USB high speed chips (FT2232H)
10936 often support faster clock rates (and adaptive clocking).
10937
10938 You can still debug the 'low power' situations - you just need to
10939 either use a fixed and very slow JTAG clock rate ... or else
10940 manually adjust the clock speed at every step. (Adjusting is painful
10941 and tedious, and is not always practical.)
10942
10943 It is however easy to ``code your way around it'' - i.e.: Cheat a little,
10944 have a special debug mode in your application that does a ``high power
10945 sleep''. If you are careful - 98% of your problems can be debugged
10946 this way.
10947
10948 Note that on ARM you may need to avoid using the @emph{wait for interrupt}
10949 operation in your idle loops even if you don't otherwise change the CPU
10950 clock rate.
10951 That operation gates the CPU clock, and thus the JTAG clock; which
10952 prevents JTAG access. One consequence is not being able to @command{halt}
10953 cores which are executing that @emph{wait for interrupt} operation.
10954
10955 To set the JTAG frequency use the command:
10956
10957 @example
10958 # Example: 1.234MHz
10959 adapter speed 1234
10960 @end example
10961
10962
10963 @item @b{Win32 Pathnames} Why don't backslashes work in Windows paths?
10964
10965 OpenOCD uses Tcl and a backslash is an escape char. Use @{ and @}
10966 around Windows filenames.
10967
10968 @example
10969 > echo \a
10970
10971 > echo @{\a@}
10972 \a
10973 > echo "\a"
10974
10975 >
10976 @end example
10977
10978
10979 @item @b{Missing: cygwin1.dll} OpenOCD complains about a missing cygwin1.dll.
10980
10981 Make sure you have Cygwin installed, or at least a version of OpenOCD that
10982 claims to come with all the necessary DLLs. When using Cygwin, try launching
10983 OpenOCD from the Cygwin shell.
10984
10985 @item @b{Breakpoint Issue} I'm trying to set a breakpoint using GDB (or a front-end like Insight or
10986 Eclipse), but OpenOCD complains that "Info: arm7_9_common.c:213
10987 arm7_9_add_breakpoint(): sw breakpoint requested, but software breakpoints not enabled".
10988
10989 GDB issues software breakpoints when a normal breakpoint is requested, or to implement
10990 source-line single-stepping. On ARMv4T systems, like ARM7TDMI, ARM720T or ARM920T,
10991 software breakpoints consume one of the two available hardware breakpoints.
10992
10993 @item @b{LPC2000 Flash} When erasing or writing LPC2000 on-chip flash, the operation fails at random.
10994
10995 Make sure the core frequency specified in the @option{flash lpc2000} line matches the
10996 clock at the time you're programming the flash. If you've specified the crystal's
10997 frequency, make sure the PLL is disabled. If you've specified the full core speed
10998 (e.g. 60MHz), make sure the PLL is enabled.
10999
11000 @item @b{Amontec Chameleon} When debugging using an Amontec Chameleon in its JTAG Accelerator configuration,
11001 I keep getting "Error: amt_jtagaccel.c:184 amt_wait_scan_busy(): amt_jtagaccel timed
11002 out while waiting for end of scan, rtck was disabled".
11003
11004 Make sure your PC's parallel port operates in EPP mode. You might have to try several
11005 settings in your PC BIOS (ECP, EPP, and different versions of those).
11006
11007 @item @b{Data Aborts} When debugging with OpenOCD and GDB (plain GDB, Insight, or Eclipse),
11008 I get lots of "Error: arm7_9_common.c:1771 arm7_9_read_memory():
11009 memory read caused data abort".
11010
11011 The errors are non-fatal, and are the result of GDB trying to trace stack frames
11012 beyond the last valid frame. It might be possible to prevent this by setting up
11013 a proper "initial" stack frame, if you happen to know what exactly has to
11014 be done, feel free to add this here.
11015
11016 @b{Simple:} In your startup code - push 8 registers of zeros onto the
11017 stack before calling main(). What GDB is doing is ``climbing'' the run
11018 time stack by reading various values on the stack using the standard
11019 call frame for the target. GDB keeps going - until one of 2 things
11020 happen @b{#1} an invalid frame is found, or @b{#2} some huge number of
11021 stackframes have been processed. By pushing zeros on the stack, GDB
11022 gracefully stops.
11023
11024 @b{Debugging Interrupt Service Routines} - In your ISR before you call
11025 your C code, do the same - artificially push some zeros onto the stack,
11026 remember to pop them off when the ISR is done.
11027
11028 @b{Also note:} If you have a multi-threaded operating system, they
11029 often do not @b{in the intrest of saving memory} waste these few
11030 bytes. Painful...
11031
11032
11033 @item @b{JTAG Reset Config} I get the following message in the OpenOCD console (or log file):
11034 "Warning: arm7_9_common.c:679 arm7_9_assert_reset(): srst resets test logic, too".
11035
11036 This warning doesn't indicate any serious problem, as long as you don't want to
11037 debug your core right out of reset. Your .cfg file specified @option{reset_config
11038 trst_and_srst srst_pulls_trst} to tell OpenOCD that either your board,
11039 your debugger or your target uC (e.g. LPC2000) can't assert the two reset signals
11040 independently. With this setup, it's not possible to halt the core right out of
11041 reset, everything else should work fine.
11042
11043 @item @b{USB Power} When using OpenOCD in conjunction with Amontec JTAGkey and the Yagarto
11044 toolchain (Eclipse, arm-elf-gcc, arm-elf-gdb), the debugging seems to be
11045 unstable. When single-stepping over large blocks of code, GDB and OpenOCD
11046 quit with an error message. Is there a stability issue with OpenOCD?
11047
11048 No, this is not a stability issue concerning OpenOCD. Most users have solved
11049 this issue by simply using a self-powered USB hub, which they connect their
11050 Amontec JTAGkey to. Apparently, some computers do not provide a USB power
11051 supply stable enough for the Amontec JTAGkey to be operated.
11052
11053 @b{Laptops running on battery have this problem too...}
11054
11055 @item @b{GDB Disconnects} When using the Amontec JTAGkey, sometimes OpenOCD crashes with the following
11056 error message: "Error: gdb_server.c:101 gdb_get_char(): read: 10054".
11057 What does that mean and what might be the reason for this?
11058
11059 Error code 10054 corresponds to WSAECONNRESET, which means that the debugger (GDB)
11060 has closed the connection to OpenOCD. This might be a GDB issue.
11061
11062 @item @b{LPC2000 Flash} In the configuration file in the section where flash device configurations
11063 are described, there is a parameter for specifying the clock frequency
11064 for LPC2000 internal flash devices (e.g. @option{flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc2000
11065 0x0 0x40000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME lpc2000_v1 14746 calc_checksum}), which must be
11066 specified in kilohertz. However, I do have a quartz crystal of a
11067 frequency that contains fractions of kilohertz (e.g. 14,745,600 Hz,
11068 i.e. 14,745.600 kHz). Is it possible to specify real numbers for the
11069 clock frequency?
11070
11071 No. The clock frequency specified here must be given as an integral number.
11072 However, this clock frequency is used by the In-Application-Programming (IAP)
11073 routines of the LPC2000 family only, which seems to be very tolerant concerning
11074 the given clock frequency, so a slight difference between the specified clock
11075 frequency and the actual clock frequency will not cause any trouble.
11076
11077 @item @b{Command Order} Do I have to keep a specific order for the commands in the configuration file?
11078
11079 Well, yes and no. Commands can be given in arbitrary order, yet the
11080 devices listed for the JTAG scan chain must be given in the right
11081 order (jtag newdevice), with the device closest to the TDO-Pin being
11082 listed first. In general, whenever objects of the same type exist
11083 which require an index number, then these objects must be given in the
11084 right order (jtag newtap, targets and flash banks - a target
11085 references a jtag newtap and a flash bank references a target).
11086
11087 You can use the ``scan_chain'' command to verify and display the tap order.
11088
11089 Also, some commands can't execute until after @command{init} has been
11090 processed. Such commands include @command{nand probe} and everything
11091 else that needs to write to controller registers, perhaps for setting
11092 up DRAM and loading it with code.
11093
11094 @anchor{faqtaporder}
11095 @item @b{JTAG TAP Order} Do I have to declare the TAPS in some
11096 particular order?
11097
11098 Yes; whenever you have more than one, you must declare them in
11099 the same order used by the hardware.
11100
11101 Many newer devices have multiple JTAG TAPs. For example:
11102 STMicroelectronics STM32 chips have two TAPs, a ``boundary scan TAP'' and
11103 ``Cortex-M3'' TAP. Example: The STM32 reference manual, Document ID:
11104 RM0008, Section 26.5, Figure 259, page 651/681, the ``TDI'' pin is
11105 connected to the boundary scan TAP, which then connects to the
11106 Cortex-M3 TAP, which then connects to the TDO pin.
11107
11108 Thus, the proper order for the STM32 chip is: (1) The Cortex-M3, then
11109 (2) The boundary scan TAP. If your board includes an additional JTAG
11110 chip in the scan chain (for example a Xilinx CPLD or FPGA) you could
11111 place it before or after the STM32 chip in the chain. For example:
11112
11113 @itemize @bullet
11114 @item OpenOCD_TDI(output) -> STM32 TDI Pin (BS Input)
11115 @item STM32 BS TDO (output) -> STM32 Cortex-M3 TDI (input)
11116 @item STM32 Cortex-M3 TDO (output) -> SM32 TDO Pin
11117 @item STM32 TDO Pin (output) -> Xilinx TDI Pin (input)
11118 @item Xilinx TDO Pin -> OpenOCD TDO (input)
11119 @end itemize
11120
11121 The ``jtag device'' commands would thus be in the order shown below. Note:
11122
11123 @itemize @bullet
11124 @item jtag newtap Xilinx tap -irlen ...
11125 @item jtag newtap stm32 cpu -irlen ...
11126 @item jtag newtap stm32 bs -irlen ...
11127 @item # Create the debug target and say where it is
11128 @item target create stm32.cpu -chain-position stm32.cpu ...
11129 @end itemize
11130
11131
11132 @item @b{SYSCOMP} Sometimes my debugging session terminates with an error. When I look into the
11133 log file, I can see these error messages: Error: arm7_9_common.c:561
11134 arm7_9_execute_sys_speed(): timeout waiting for SYSCOMP
11135
11136 TODO.
11137
11138 @end enumerate
11139
11140 @node Tcl Crash Course
11141 @chapter Tcl Crash Course
11142 @cindex Tcl
11143
11144 Not everyone knows Tcl - this is not intended to be a replacement for
11145 learning Tcl, the intent of this chapter is to give you some idea of
11146 how the Tcl scripts work.
11147
11148 This chapter is written with two audiences in mind. (1) OpenOCD users
11149 who need to understand a bit more of how Jim-Tcl works so they can do
11150 something useful, and (2) those that want to add a new command to
11151 OpenOCD.
11152
11153 @section Tcl Rule #1
11154 There is a famous joke, it goes like this:
11155 @enumerate
11156 @item Rule #1: The wife is always correct
11157 @item Rule #2: If you think otherwise, See Rule #1
11158 @end enumerate
11159
11160 The Tcl equal is this:
11161
11162 @enumerate
11163 @item Rule #1: Everything is a string
11164 @item Rule #2: If you think otherwise, See Rule #1
11165 @end enumerate
11166
11167 As in the famous joke, the consequences of Rule #1 are profound. Once
11168 you understand Rule #1, you will understand Tcl.
11169
11170 @section Tcl Rule #1b
11171 There is a second pair of rules.
11172 @enumerate
11173 @item Rule #1: Control flow does not exist. Only commands
11174 @* For example: the classic FOR loop or IF statement is not a control
11175 flow item, they are commands, there is no such thing as control flow
11176 in Tcl.
11177 @item Rule #2: If you think otherwise, See Rule #1
11178 @* Actually what happens is this: There are commands that by
11179 convention, act like control flow key words in other languages. One of
11180 those commands is the word ``for'', another command is ``if''.
11181 @end enumerate
11182
11183 @section Per Rule #1 - All Results are strings
11184 Every Tcl command results in a string. The word ``result'' is used
11185 deliberately. No result is just an empty string. Remember: @i{Rule #1 -
11186 Everything is a string}
11187
11188 @section Tcl Quoting Operators
11189 In life of a Tcl script, there are two important periods of time, the
11190 difference is subtle.
11191 @enumerate
11192 @item Parse Time
11193 @item Evaluation Time
11194 @end enumerate
11195
11196 The two key items here are how ``quoted things'' work in Tcl. Tcl has
11197 three primary quoting constructs, the [square-brackets] the
11198 @{curly-braces@} and ``double-quotes''
11199
11200 By now you should know $VARIABLES always start with a $DOLLAR
11201 sign. BTW: To set a variable, you actually use the command ``set'', as
11202 in ``set VARNAME VALUE'' much like the ancient BASIC language ``let x
11203 = 1'' statement, but without the equal sign.
11204
11205 @itemize @bullet
11206 @item @b{[square-brackets]}
11207 @* @b{[square-brackets]} are command substitutions. It operates much
11208 like Unix Shell `back-ticks`. The result of a [square-bracket]
11209 operation is exactly 1 string. @i{Remember Rule #1 - Everything is a
11210 string}. These two statements are roughly identical:
11211 @example
11212 # bash example
11213 X=`date`
11214 echo "The Date is: $X"
11215 # Tcl example
11216 set X [date]
11217 puts "The Date is: $X"
11218 @end example
11219 @item @b{``double-quoted-things''}
11220 @* @b{``double-quoted-things''} are just simply quoted
11221 text. $VARIABLES and [square-brackets] are expanded in place - the
11222 result however is exactly 1 string. @i{Remember Rule #1 - Everything
11223 is a string}
11224 @example
11225 set x "Dinner"
11226 puts "It is now \"[date]\", $x is in 1 hour"
11227 @end example
11228 @item @b{@{Curly-Braces@}}
11229 @*@b{@{Curly-Braces@}} are magic: $VARIABLES and [square-brackets] are
11230 parsed, but are NOT expanded or executed. @{Curly-Braces@} are like
11231 'single-quote' operators in BASH shell scripts, with the added
11232 feature: @{curly-braces@} can be nested, single quotes can not. @{@{@{this is
11233 nested 3 times@}@}@} NOTE: [date] is a bad example;
11234 at this writing, Jim/OpenOCD does not have a date command.
11235 @end itemize
11236
11237 @section Consequences of Rule 1/2/3/4
11238
11239 The consequences of Rule 1 are profound.
11240
11241 @subsection Tokenisation & Execution.
11242
11243 Of course, whitespace, blank lines and #comment lines are handled in
11244 the normal way.
11245
11246 As a script is parsed, each (multi) line in the script file is
11247 tokenised and according to the quoting rules. After tokenisation, that
11248 line is immediately executed.
11249
11250 Multi line statements end with one or more ``still-open''
11251 @{curly-braces@} which - eventually - closes a few lines later.
11252
11253 @subsection Command Execution
11254
11255 Remember earlier: There are no ``control flow''
11256 statements in Tcl. Instead there are COMMANDS that simply act like
11257 control flow operators.
11258
11259 Commands are executed like this:
11260
11261 @enumerate
11262 @item Parse the next line into (argc) and (argv[]).
11263 @item Look up (argv[0]) in a table and call its function.
11264 @item Repeat until End Of File.
11265 @end enumerate
11266
11267 It sort of works like this:
11268 @example
11269 for(;;)@{
11270 ReadAndParse( &argc, &argv );
11271
11272 cmdPtr = LookupCommand( argv[0] );
11273
11274 (*cmdPtr->Execute)( argc, argv );
11275 @}
11276 @end example
11277
11278 When the command ``proc'' is parsed (which creates a procedure
11279 function) it gets 3 parameters on the command line. @b{1} the name of
11280 the proc (function), @b{2} the list of parameters, and @b{3} the body
11281 of the function. Not the choice of words: LIST and BODY. The PROC
11282 command stores these items in a table somewhere so it can be found by
11283 ``LookupCommand()''
11284
11285 @subsection The FOR command
11286
11287 The most interesting command to look at is the FOR command. In Tcl,
11288 the FOR command is normally implemented in C. Remember, FOR is a
11289 command just like any other command.
11290
11291 When the ascii text containing the FOR command is parsed, the parser
11292 produces 5 parameter strings, @i{(If in doubt: Refer to Rule #1)} they
11293 are:
11294
11295 @enumerate 0
11296 @item The ascii text 'for'
11297 @item The start text
11298 @item The test expression
11299 @item The next text
11300 @item The body text
11301 @end enumerate
11302
11303 Sort of reminds you of ``main( int argc, char **argv )'' does it not?
11304 Remember @i{Rule #1 - Everything is a string.} The key point is this:
11305 Often many of those parameters are in @{curly-braces@} - thus the
11306 variables inside are not expanded or replaced until later.
11307
11308 Remember that every Tcl command looks like the classic ``main( argc,
11309 argv )'' function in C. In JimTCL - they actually look like this:
11310
11311 @example
11312 int
11313 MyCommand( Jim_Interp *interp,
11314 int *argc,
11315 Jim_Obj * const *argvs );
11316 @end example
11317
11318 Real Tcl is nearly identical. Although the newer versions have
11319 introduced a byte-code parser and interpreter, but at the core, it
11320 still operates in the same basic way.
11321
11322 @subsection FOR command implementation
11323
11324 To understand Tcl it is perhaps most helpful to see the FOR
11325 command. Remember, it is a COMMAND not a control flow structure.
11326
11327 In Tcl there are two underlying C helper functions.
11328
11329 Remember Rule #1 - You are a string.
11330
11331 The @b{first} helper parses and executes commands found in an ascii
11332 string. Commands can be separated by semicolons, or newlines. While
11333 parsing, variables are expanded via the quoting rules.
11334
11335 The @b{second} helper evaluates an ascii string as a numerical
11336 expression and returns a value.
11337
11338 Here is an example of how the @b{FOR} command could be
11339 implemented. The pseudo code below does not show error handling.
11340 @example
11341 void Execute_AsciiString( void *interp, const char *string );
11342
11343 int Evaluate_AsciiExpression( void *interp, const char *string );
11344
11345 int
11346 MyForCommand( void *interp,
11347 int argc,
11348 char **argv )
11349 @{
11350 if( argc != 5 )@{
11351 SetResult( interp, "WRONG number of parameters");
11352 return ERROR;
11353 @}
11354
11355 // argv[0] = the ascii string just like C
11356
11357 // Execute the start statement.
11358 Execute_AsciiString( interp, argv[1] );
11359
11360 // Top of loop test
11361 for(;;)@{
11362 i = Evaluate_AsciiExpression(interp, argv[2]);
11363 if( i == 0 )
11364 break;
11365
11366 // Execute the body
11367 Execute_AsciiString( interp, argv[3] );
11368
11369 // Execute the LOOP part
11370 Execute_AsciiString( interp, argv[4] );
11371 @}
11372
11373 // Return no error
11374 SetResult( interp, "" );
11375 return SUCCESS;
11376 @}
11377 @end example
11378
11379 Every other command IF, WHILE, FORMAT, PUTS, EXPR, everything works
11380 in the same basic way.
11381
11382 @section OpenOCD Tcl Usage
11383
11384 @subsection source and find commands
11385 @b{Where:} In many configuration files
11386 @* Example: @b{ source [find FILENAME] }
11387 @*Remember the parsing rules
11388 @enumerate
11389 @item The @command{find} command is in square brackets,
11390 and is executed with the parameter FILENAME. It should find and return
11391 the full path to a file with that name; it uses an internal search path.
11392 The RESULT is a string, which is substituted into the command line in
11393 place of the bracketed @command{find} command.
11394 (Don't try to use a FILENAME which includes the "#" character.
11395 That character begins Tcl comments.)
11396 @item The @command{source} command is executed with the resulting filename;
11397 it reads a file and executes as a script.
11398 @end enumerate
11399 @subsection format command
11400 @b{Where:} Generally occurs in numerous places.
11401 @* Tcl has no command like @b{printf()}, instead it has @b{format}, which is really more like
11402 @b{sprintf()}.
11403 @b{Example}
11404 @example
11405 set x 6
11406 set y 7
11407 puts [format "The answer: %d" [expr $x * $y]]
11408 @end example
11409 @enumerate
11410 @item The SET command creates 2 variables, X and Y.
11411 @item The double [nested] EXPR command performs math
11412 @* The EXPR command produces numerical result as a string.
11413 @* Refer to Rule #1
11414 @item The format command is executed, producing a single string
11415 @* Refer to Rule #1.
11416 @item The PUTS command outputs the text.
11417 @end enumerate
11418 @subsection Body or Inlined Text
11419 @b{Where:} Various TARGET scripts.
11420 @example
11421 #1 Good
11422 proc someproc @{@} @{
11423 ... multiple lines of stuff ...
11424 @}
11425 $_TARGETNAME configure -event FOO someproc
11426 #2 Good - no variables
11427 $_TARGETNAME configure -event foo "this ; that;"
11428 #3 Good Curly Braces
11429 $_TARGETNAME configure -event FOO @{
11430 puts "Time: [date]"
11431 @}
11432 #4 DANGER DANGER DANGER
11433 $_TARGETNAME configure -event foo "puts \"Time: [date]\""
11434 @end example
11435 @enumerate
11436 @item The $_TARGETNAME is an OpenOCD variable convention.
11437 @*@b{$_TARGETNAME} represents the last target created, the value changes
11438 each time a new target is created. Remember the parsing rules. When
11439 the ascii text is parsed, the @b{$_TARGETNAME} becomes a simple string,
11440 the name of the target which happens to be a TARGET (object)
11441 command.
11442 @item The 2nd parameter to the @option{-event} parameter is a TCBODY
11443 @*There are 4 examples:
11444 @enumerate
11445 @item The TCLBODY is a simple string that happens to be a proc name
11446 @item The TCLBODY is several simple commands separated by semicolons
11447 @item The TCLBODY is a multi-line @{curly-brace@} quoted string
11448 @item The TCLBODY is a string with variables that get expanded.
11449 @end enumerate
11450
11451 In the end, when the target event FOO occurs the TCLBODY is
11452 evaluated. Method @b{#1} and @b{#2} are functionally identical. For
11453 Method @b{#3} and @b{#4} it is more interesting. What is the TCLBODY?
11454
11455 Remember the parsing rules. In case #3, @{curly-braces@} mean the
11456 $VARS and [square-brackets] are expanded later, when the EVENT occurs,
11457 and the text is evaluated. In case #4, they are replaced before the
11458 ``Target Object Command'' is executed. This occurs at the same time
11459 $_TARGETNAME is replaced. In case #4 the date will never
11460 change. @{BTW: [date] is a bad example; at this writing,
11461 Jim/OpenOCD does not have a date command@}
11462 @end enumerate
11463 @subsection Global Variables
11464 @b{Where:} You might discover this when writing your own procs @* In
11465 simple terms: Inside a PROC, if you need to access a global variable
11466 you must say so. See also ``upvar''. Example:
11467 @example
11468 proc myproc @{ @} @{
11469 set y 0 #Local variable Y
11470 global x #Global variable X
11471 puts [format "X=%d, Y=%d" $x $y]
11472 @}
11473 @end example
11474 @section Other Tcl Hacks
11475 @b{Dynamic variable creation}
11476 @example
11477 # Dynamically create a bunch of variables.
11478 for @{ set x 0 @} @{ $x < 32 @} @{ set x [expr $x + 1]@} @{
11479 # Create var name
11480 set vn [format "BIT%d" $x]
11481 # Make it a global
11482 global $vn
11483 # Set it.
11484 set $vn [expr (1 << $x)]
11485 @}
11486 @end example
11487 @b{Dynamic proc/command creation}
11488 @example
11489 # One "X" function - 5 uart functions.
11490 foreach who @{A B C D E@}
11491 proc [format "show_uart%c" $who] @{ @} "show_UARTx $who"
11492 @}
11493 @end example
11494
11495 @include fdl.texi
11496
11497 @node OpenOCD Concept Index
11498 @comment DO NOT use the plain word ``Index'', reason: CYGWIN filename
11499 @comment case issue with ``Index.html'' and ``index.html''
11500 @comment Occurs when creating ``--html --no-split'' output
11501 @comment This fix is based on: http://sourceware.org/ml/binutils/2006-05/msg00215.html
11502 @unnumbered OpenOCD Concept Index
11503
11504 @printindex cp
11505
11506 @node Command and Driver Index
11507 @unnumbered Command and Driver Index
11508 @printindex fn
11509
11510 @bye

Linking to existing account procedure

If you already have an account and want to add another login method you MUST first sign in with your existing account and then change URL to read https://review.openocd.org/login/?link to get to this page again but this time it'll work for linking. Thank you.

SSH host keys fingerprints

1024 SHA256:YKx8b7u5ZWdcbp7/4AeXNaqElP49m6QrwfXaqQGJAOk gerrit-code-review@openocd.zylin.com (DSA)
384 SHA256:jHIbSQa4REvwCFG4cq5LBlBLxmxSqelQPem/EXIrxjk gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ECDSA)
521 SHA256:UAOPYkU9Fjtcao0Ul/Rrlnj/OsQvt+pgdYSZ4jOYdgs gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ECDSA)
256 SHA256:A13M5QlnozFOvTllybRZH6vm7iSt0XLxbA48yfc2yfY gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ECDSA)
256 SHA256:spYMBqEYoAOtK7yZBrcwE8ZpYt6b68Cfh9yEVetvbXg gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ED25519)
+--[ED25519 256]--+
|=..              |
|+o..   .         |
|*.o   . .        |
|+B . . .         |
|Bo. = o S        |
|Oo.+ + =         |
|oB=.* = . o      |
| =+=.+   + E     |
|. .=o   . o      |
+----[SHA256]-----+
2048 SHA256:0Onrb7/PHjpo6iVZ7xQX2riKN83FJ3KGU0TvI0TaFG4 gerrit-code-review@openocd.zylin.com (RSA)